2023
Annual Report
H O L D I N G C O R P O R AT I O N
Dear Shareholders:
Although 2023 presented unique challenges and disruptions to the banking industry, I am proud of how Investar responded and
remained focused on meeting the needs of our clients and communities through extraordinary customer service. We spent the
year focusing on strategic initiatives to position Investar to add long-term value for our shareholders, and we are pleased with
the progress we have made.
As the Federal Reserve continued its tightening cycle in 2023, we pivoted our near-term strategy from primarily a growth strategy
to a focus on consistent, quality earnings through the optimization of our balance sheet. In an effort to improve the composition
of our loan portfolio, we purchased variable-rate, commercial and industrial lines of credit totaling $163 million, or approximately
8% of the loan portfolio, and proactively exited the consumer mortgage origination business to transition away from longer
duration assets with a lower risk-adjusted return profile. Our credit quality remained exceptional at 0.26% of total loans at the
end of 2023 as we continued to originate high quality loans and allowed higher risk credit relationships to run off.
Due to our diligent workout process, we reached resolution on two key relationships. During 2023, we recognized net recoveries
of $2.3 million primarily attributable to one loan relationship that became impaired in the third quarter of 2021 as a result of
Hurricane Ida. Additionally, we recognized interest recoveries of $1.5 million, the majority of which were attributable to one
commercial and industrial oil and gas relationship.
Our 2023 financial results are highlighted by net income of $16.7 million, diluted earnings per share of $1.69, return on average
assets of 0.60% and return on average equity of 7.63%. We controlled noninterest expense and continued to make progress
towards our strategic priorities including optimization of our physical branch and ATM footprint and our digital transformation.
We sold two branches in our south Texas market, closed one branch in our Louisiana market, and ceased the operation of 14
automated teller machines. As we strategically transition into a more digital banking environment, we are evaluating more
opportunities to improve our branch network efficiency, further reduce costs, and improve our core metrics. Our Annual Report
on Form 10-K, which follows this letter, provides a detailed discussion of our financial performance for 2023.
We continued our strong track record of returning capital to shareholders. Investar has an uninterrupted history of paying
quarterly dividends to common shareholders since 2011. Due to our strong financial performance, we returned approximately
$3.8 million to shareholders through quarterly cash dividends totaling $0.395 per share for 2023, an 8% increase from total
quarterly cash dividends in 2022, and repurchased 222,448 shares of our common stock during 2023 at an average price of $13.47
per share. As of December 31, 2023, we had repurchased 2,535,734 shares of our common stock at an average price of $18.82
per share since the inception of our stock repurchase program in 2015, and we had 514,266 remaining shares authorized for
repurchase under our current stock repurchase plan.
Our goal is to build a fortress balance sheet that is less interest rate sensitive and responsibly build capital levels through organic
earnings growth and a disciplined pace of share repurchases. As we move into 2024, we believe the strategic achievements noted
above have positioned us to continue to withstand further economic uncertainty while remaining poised to capitalize on future
easing in the interest rate environment.
To our loyal customers and dedicated employees – thank you for working together to overcome the adversity we faced and
making 2023 another successful year. To our shareholders – thank you for your support of and investment in Investar.
Sincerely,
John J. D’Angelo
President & Chief Executive Officer
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
_____________________________________
FORM 10-K
_____________________________________
(Mark One)
☑
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
☐
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2023
or
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition period from to
Commission File Number: 001-36522
____________________________________________________
Investar Holding Corporation
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
____________________________________________________
Louisiana
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)
27-1560715
(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)
10500 Coursey Blvd., Baton Rouge, Louisiana 70816
(Address of principal executive offices, including zip code)
(225) 227-2222
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Title of each class
Common stock, $1.00 par value per share
Trading Symbol(s)
ISTR
Name of each exchange on which registered
The Nasdaq Global Market
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes ☐ No ☑
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. Yes ☐ No ☑
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during
the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for
the past 90 days. Yes ☑ No ☐
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation
S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit such files). Yes ☑ No ☐
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, smaller reporting company, or an emerging
growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-
2 of the Exchange Act:
Large accelerated filer
Non-accelerated filer
☐
☐
Accelerated filer
Smaller reporting company
Emerging growth company
☑
☑
☐
If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or
revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. ☐
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its internal control over
financial reporting under Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U.S.C. 7262(b)) by the registered public accounting firm that prepared or issued its audit
report. ☑
If securities are registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act, indicate by check mark whether the financial statements of the registrant included in the filing
reflect the correction of an error to previously issued financial statements. ☐
Indicate by check mark whether any of those error corrections are restatements that required a recovery analysis of incentive-based compensation received by
any of the registrant’s executive officers during the relevant recovery period pursuant to §240.10D-1(b). ☐
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). Yes ☐ No ☑
The aggregate market value of the voting stock held by non-affiliates of the registrant, computed by reference to the closing price of the common stock as of
June 30, 2023, was approximately $112.0 million.
The number of shares outstanding of each of the registrant’s classes of common stock, as of the latest practicable date, is as follows: Common stock, $1.00 par
value per share, 9,781,946 shares outstanding as of March 4, 2024.
DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE
Portions of the Definitive Proxy Statement relating to the 2024 Annual Meeting of Shareholders of Investar Holding Corporation are incorporated by reference
into Part III of the Form 10-K. Such Definitive Proxy Statement will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission within 120 days after the end of the
registrant’s fiscal year ended December 31, 2023.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
PART I
Item 1.
Business ............................................................................................................................................................
Item 1A. Risk Factors ......................................................................................................................................................
Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments ............................................................................................................................
Item 1C. Cybersecurity ...................................................................................................................................................
Properties ..........................................................................................................................................................
Item 2.
Legal Proceedings ............................................................................................................................................
Item 3.
Item 4. Mine Safety Disclosures ...................................................................................................................................
PART II
Item 5. Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity
Securities ......................................................................................................................................................
Item 6.
[Reserved] ........................................................................................................................................................
Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations ...........................
Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk ...........................................................................
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data ................................................................................................
Item 8.
Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure ..........................
Item 9.
Item 9A. Controls and Procedures ...................................................................................................................................
Item 9B. Other Information .............................................................................................................................................
Item 9C. Disclosure Regarding Foreign Jurisdictions that Prevent Inspections ..............................................................
PART III
Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance ...............................................................................
Item 11. Executive Compensation ..................................................................................................................................
Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters .........
Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Directors Independence ................................................
Item 14. Principal Accountant Fees and Services ...........................................................................................................
Item 15. Exhibit and Financial Statement Schedules ......................................................................................................
Item 16. Form 10-K Summary........................................................................................................................................
PART IV
Page
1
15
29
29
30
31
31
32
34
35
68
69
130
130
130
130
131
131
131
132
132
132
135
i
This page intentionally left blank
Item 1. Business
General
PART I
Investar Holding Corporation, a Louisiana corporation incorporated in 2009, is a financial holding company headquartered in
Baton Rouge, Louisiana that conducts its operations primarily through its wholly-owned subsidiary, Investar Bank, National
Association (the “Bank,” together with Investar Holding Corporation, the “Company,” “we,” “our,” or “us,”), a national bank
chartered by the Office of the Comptroller of Currency (“OCC”). The Bank was originally chartered as a Louisiana commercial
bank in 2006 and converted to a national bank in July 2019. Through the Bank, the Company offers a wide range of commercial
banking products tailored to meet the needs of individuals, professionals, and small to medium-sized businesses. Our primary
areas of operation are south Louisiana, including Baton Rouge, New Orleans, Lafayette, Lake Charles, and their surrounding
areas; southeast Texas, primarily Houston and its surrounding area; and Alabama, including York and Oxford and their
surrounding areas. These markets are served from our executive and operations center located in Baton Rouge and from 28 full
service branches located throughout our market areas. We have experienced significant growth since the Bank was chartered,
completing seven whole-bank acquisitions and establishing additional branches in our market areas.
As of December 31, 2023, on a consolidated basis, the Company had total assets of $2.8 billion, net loans of $2.2 billion, total
deposits of $2.3 billion, and stockholders’ equity of $226.8 million.
During 2023, we pivoted our near-term strategy from primarily a growth strategy to primarily a focus on consistent, quality
earnings through the optimization of our balance sheet. Our long-term strategy includes organic growth through high quality
loans and growth through acquisitions, including whole-bank acquisitions, strategic branch acquisitions and asset acquisitions.
In order to improve efficiencies and leverage our digital initiatives, during the last three fiscal years we closed five branches,
sold three tracts of land held for future branch locations, and completed the sale of two branches. In January 2024, we closed a
branch in our Alabama market. Consistent with our current strategy, we exited the consumer mortgage origination business in
the third quarter of 2023. Over time, management believes that we have significant opportunities for growth and franchise
expansion, both organically and through strategic acquisitions. Although the financial services industry is rapidly changing and
intensely competitive, and likely to remain so, we believe that the Bank competes effectively as a local community bank and
possesses the availability of local access and responsive customer service, coupled with competitively-priced products and
services, necessary to successfully compete with other financial institutions for individual and small to medium-sized business
customers.
All cross-references to the “Notes” in this Form 10-K refer to the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained in
Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.
The information set forth in this Annual Report on Form 10-K is as of March 7, 2024, unless otherwise indicated herein.
Operations
General. We offer a full range of commercial and retail lending products throughout our market areas, including business loans
to small to medium-sized businesses as well as loans to individuals. Our business lending products include owner-occupied
commercial real estate loans, construction loans and commercial and industrial loans, such as term loans, equipment financing
and lines of credit, while our loans to individuals include first and second mortgage loans, installment loans, and lines of credit.
For business customers, we target small to medium-sized businesses and professional organizations such as law firms, accounting
firms and medical practices.
Management considers all of our operations to be aggregated in one reportable operating segment, and accordingly, no separate
segment disclosures are presented in this report.
Lending Activities. Income generated by our lending activities represents a substantial portion of our total revenue. For the years
ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, income from our lending activities comprised 84%, 76%, and 84%, respectively, of
our total revenue. Over the last three fiscal years, we have increased our focus on commercial real estate loans and commercial
and industrial loans.
1
Lending to Businesses. Our lending to small to medium-sized businesses falls into three general categories:
• Commercial real estate loans. Approximately 48% of our total loans at December 31, 2023 were commercial real estate
loans, which include multifamily, farmland and commercial real estate loans, with owner-occupied loans comprising
approximately 43% of the commercial real estate loan portfolio. Commercial real estate loan terms generally are 10
years or less, although payments may be structured on a longer amortization basis. Interest rates may be fixed or
adjustable, although rates typically will not be fixed for a period exceeding 120 months, and we generally charge an
origination fee. Risks associated with commercial real estate loans include, among other things, fluctuations in the
value of real estate, new job creation trends, tenant vacancy rates, and the quality of the borrower’s management. We
attempt to limit risk by analyzing a borrower’s cash flow and collateral value on an ongoing basis. The loans are
primarily secured by commercial real estate. Also, we typically require personal guarantees from the principal owners
of the property, supported by a review of their personal financial statements, as an additional means of mitigating our
risk. We also manage risk by avoiding concentrations in any one business or industry.
• Commercial and industrial loans. Commercial and industrial loans primarily consist of working capital lines of credit
and equipment loans. The terms of these loans vary by purpose and by type of underlying collateral. We make
equipment loans for a term of five years or less at fixed or variable rates, with the loan fully amortized over the term
and secured by the relevant piece of equipment. Loans to support working capital typically have terms not exceeding
one year, and such loans are secured by accounts receivable or inventory. Fixed rate loans are priced based on collateral,
term and amortization. The interest rate for floating rate loans is typically tied to the prime rate published in The Wall
Street Journal. Commercial and Industrial loans include variable-rate loans to consumer finance lending companies.
Loans to consumer finance lending companies accounted for approximately 8% of our total loans at December 31,
2023. Commercial and industrial loans also include public finance loans made to governmental entities, which can be
taxable or tax-exempt, for purposes including debt refinancing, economic development, quality of life projects, short-
term cash-flow needs, and infrastructure enhancements, among other things. Public finance loans are generally repaid
using pledged revenue sources including income tax, property tax, sales tax, and utility revenue, among other
sources. Public finance loans comprise less than 5% of our loan portfolio at December 31, 2023. Commercial and
industrial loans accounted for approximately 25% of our total loans at December 31, 2023.
Commercial lending generally involves different risks from those associated with commercial real estate lending or
construction lending. Although commercial loans may be collateralized by equipment or other business assets (including
real estate, if available as collateral), the repayment of these types of loans depends primarily on the creditworthiness
and projected cash flow of the borrower (and any guarantors). Thus, the general business conditions of the local
economy and the borrower’s ability to sell its products and services, thereby generating sufficient operating revenue to
repay us under the agreed upon terms and conditions, are the chief considerations when assessing the risk of a
commercial loan. The liquidation of collateral, if any, is considered a secondary source of repayment because equipment
and other business assets may, among other things, be obsolete or of limited resale value. We actively monitor certain
financial measures of the borrower, including advance rate, cash flow, collateral value and other appropriate credit
factors. We also manage risk by avoiding concentrations in any one business or industry.
• Construction and development loans. Construction and development loans, which consist of loans for the construction
of commercial projects, single family residential properties and multifamily properties, accounted for
approximately 9% of our total loans at December 31, 2023. Our construction and development loans are made on both
a “pre-sold” basis and on a “speculative” basis. Construction and development loans are generally made with a term of
6 to 18 months, with interest accruing at either a fixed or floating rate and paid monthly. These loans are secured by
the underlying project being built. For construction loans, loan to value ratios range from 70% to 80% of the
developed/completed value, while for development loans our loan to value ratios typically will not exceed 70% to 75%
of such value. Speculative loans are based on the borrower’s financial strength and cash flow position, and we disburse
funds in installments based on the percentage of completion and only after the project has been inspected by an
experienced construction lender or third-party inspector.
Construction lending entails significant additional risks compared to commercial real estate or residential real estate
lending due to the dynamics of construction projects, changes in interest rates, the long-term financing market, and state
and local government regulations. One such risk is that loan funds are advanced upon the security of the property under
construction, which is of uncertain value prior to the completion of construction. Thus, it is more difficult to accurately
evaluate the total loan funds required to complete a project and to calculate related loan-to-value ratios. We attempt to
minimize the risks associated with construction lending by limiting loan-to-value ratios as described above. In addition,
as to speculative development loans, we generally make such loans only to borrowers that have a positive pre-existing
relationship with us. We also manage risk by using specific underwriting policies and procedures for these types of
loans and by avoiding excessive concentrations in any one business or industry.
2
Lending to Individuals. We make the following types of loans to our individual customers:
• Residential real estate. 1-4 family residential real estate loans, including second mortgage loans, comprised
approximately 19% of our total loans at December 31, 2023. Second mortgage loans in this category include only loans
we make to cover the gap between the purchase price of a residence and the amount of the first mortgage; all other
second mortgage loans are considered consumer loans. Loan to value ratios do not typically exceed 80%, although
some of the mortgage loans that we retain in our portfolio may have higher loan to value ratios. We use an independent
appraiser to establish collateral values. We generate residential real estate mortgage loans through Bank referrals and
contacts with real estate agents in our markets. We do not originate subprime residential real estate loans. In the third
quarter of 2023, we exited the consumer mortgage origination business. At December 31, 2023, the consumer mortgage
portfolio was approximately $261.6 million, substantially all of which is included in the 1-4 family residential real
estate loan category. The remaining loans in the category consisted primarily of second mortgages, home equity loans,
home equity lines of credit, and business purpose loans secured by 1-4 family residential real estate.
• Consumer loans. Consumer loans represented less than 1% of our total loans at December 31, 2023. We make these
loans (which are normally fixed-rate loans) to individuals for a variety of personal, family and household purposes, and
secured and unsecured installment and term loans. Because many consumer loans are secured by depreciable assets
such as cars, boats and trailers, the loans are amortized over the useful life of the asset. The amortization of second
mortgages generally does not exceed 15 years and the rates generally are not fixed for more than 60 months. As a
general matter, in underwriting these loans, our credit analysts review a borrower’s past credit history, credit scores,
past income level, debt history and, when applicable, cash flow, debt to income ratio, and payment to income, and
determine the impact of all these factors on the ability of the borrower to make future payments as agreed. A comparison
of the value of the collateral, if any, to the proposed loan amount, is also a consideration in the underwriting process.
Repayment of consumer loans depends upon key consumer economic measures and upon the borrower’s financial
stability and is more likely to be adversely affected by divorce, job loss, illness and personal hardships than repayment
of other loans. A shortfall in the value of any collateral also may pose a risk of loss to us for these types of loans.
Deposits. We offer a broad base of deposit products and services to our individual and business clients, including savings,
checking, and money market accounts, as well as a variety of certificates of deposit and individual retirement accounts. We also
offer a reciprocal deposit product, Assured Checking, that allows customers to deposit funds in excess of the Federal Deposit
Insurance Corporation’s (“FDIC”) $250,000 insurance limit and have the funds insured by the FDIC. We offer debit cards,
internet banking, mobile banking with smartphone deposit capability as well as debit card protection settings. For our business
clients, we offer a competitive suite of treasury management products which include, but are not limited to, remote deposit
capture, lockbox payment processing, virtual vaults, positive pay, ACH origination, credit card processing, wire transfer,
investment sweep accounts, and enhanced business internet banking.
Other Banking Services. The Bank’s other banking services include cashiers’ checks, direct deposit of payroll and Social
Security checks, night depository, bank-by-mail, automated teller machines with deposit automation, debit cards, corporate credit
cards, mobile wallet payment options, electronic statements, electronic banking for consumer and business customers, and Zelle®
for consumers, a fast and easy way to send money directly between almost any bank account in the United States (“U.S.”). In
addition, the Bank has options for contactless banking including interactive teller machines (“ITMs”), online account opening,
and video banking. ITMs are an upgrade on traditional automated teller machine (“ATM”) technology that allow customers to
virtually interact directly with Bank staff. Online account opening allows a consumer to open a number of available checking,
savings, and certificate of deposit accounts online. Video banking lets customers communicate with Bank staff from a mobile
device or computer without visiting a branch. The Bank does not offer trust services or insurance products.
Acquisition Activity
General. From time to time we evaluate potential acquisition opportunities including whole-bank acquisitions and strategic
branch acquisitions. We believe there are many banking institutions that continue to face credit challenges, capital constraints
and liquidity issues and that lack the scale and management expertise to manage the increasing regulatory burden. Our
management team has a long history of identifying targets, assessing and pricing risk and executing acquisitions in a creative,
yet disciplined, manner. We seek acquisitions that provide meaningful financial benefits, long-term organic growth opportunities
and expense reductions, without compromising our risk profile. Additionally, we seek banking markets with favorable
competitive dynamics and potential consolidation opportunities.
Recent Acquisitions. All of our acquisition activity is evaluated and overseen by a standing Mergers and Acquisitions Committee
of our board of directors. A discussion of acquisitions completed since January 1, 2020, is set forth under the heading “Certain
Events That Affect Year-over-Year Comparability – Acquisitions” in Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations.
3
Divestiture and Sale or Closure Activity
Sale of two branches to First Community Bank. On January 27, 2023, the Bank sold certain assets, deposits and other liabilities
associated with its Alice and Victoria, Texas locations to First Community Bank, a Texas state bank located in Corpus Christi,
Texas. The Bank sold approximately $13.9 million in loans and $14.5 million in deposits.
Branch closures and land sales. During the last three fiscal years, we closed five branches and sold three tracts of land held for
future branch locations. Three of the branches had been acquired, and the closures involved anticipated synergies that resulted
in significant cost savings. In January 2024, we closed a branch in our Alabama market. We continue to evaluate opportunities
to reduce our physical branch footprint and further improve efficiency through digital initiatives.
De Novo Branches or Conversion Activity
During our last three fiscal years, we have not opened any de novo branches. In the third quarter of 2023, we converted an
existing loan and deposit production office in our Alabama market to a cashless branch designed to provide a digital banking
experience. We do not expect to open de novo branches in 2024.
Competition
We face competition in all major product and geographic areas in which we conduct our operations. Through the Bank, we
compete for available loans and deposits with state, regional and national banks, as well as savings and loan associations, credit
unions, finance companies, mortgage companies, insurance companies, brokerage firms and investment companies. All of these
institutions compete in the delivery of services and products through availability, quality and pricing, both with respect to interest
rates on loans and deposits and fees charged for banking services. Many of our competitors are larger and have substantially
greater resources than we do, including higher total assets and capitalization, greater access to capital markets, and a broader
offering of financial services. As larger institutions, many of our competitors can offer more attractive pricing than we can offer
and have more extensive branch networks from which they can offer their financial services products.
While we continually strive to offer competitive pricing for our banking products, we believe that our community bank approach
to customers, focusing on quality customer service, and maintaining strong customer relationships affords us the best opportunity
to successfully compete with other institutions. In addition, as a smaller institution, we think we can be flexible in developing
and implementing new products and services. Further, in recent years there has been consolidation activity involving banks with
a presence in our markets. In our view, mergers and other business combinations within our markets provide us with growth
opportunities. Many acquisitions, especially when local institutions are acquired by institutions based outside our markets, result
not only in customer disruption, but also in a loss of market knowledge and relationships that we believe provide us the
opportunity to acquire customers seeking a personalized approach to banking. Furthermore, acquisition activity typically creates
opportunities to hire talented personnel from the combining institutions.
The following table sets forth certain information about our total deposits, and our share of total deposits, in specified locations,
and is shown as of June 30, 2023, which is the latest date for which such information is available.
Location
Baton Rouge, Louisiana
New Orleans, Louisiana
Lafayette, Louisiana
Evangeline Parish, Louisiana(1)
East and West Feliciana Parishes, Louisiana(1)
Calcasieu Parish, Louisiana(1)
Houston, Texas
Sumter County, Alabama(1)
Calhoun County, Alabama(1)
Investar Total
Deposits
(in millions)
Investar Share
of Deposits
$
979
280
279
165
129
27
127
92
231
3.7%
0.6
3.3
22.1
20.9
0.5
0.0
33.8
9.3
(1) Evangeline Parish, East and West Feliciana Parishes, Calcasieu Parish, Sumter County, and Calhoun County are not included
in Metropolitan Statistical Areas but are included in this table to reflect the deposit balances of our branches in these parishes
and counties.
4
Supervision and Regulation
General. Banking is highly regulated under federal and state law. The following is a brief summary of certain aspects of that
regulation which are material to us and does not purport to be a complete description of all regulations that affect us or all aspects
of those regulations. To the extent particular statutory and regulatory provisions are described, the description is qualified in its
entirety by reference to the particular statute or regulation.
We are a financial holding company registered under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended, and are subject to
supervision, regulation and examination by the Federal Reserve. The Bank is a national bank chartered under the laws of the U.S.
by the OCC and is subject to supervision, regulation and examination by the OCC. This system of supervision and regulation
establishes a comprehensive framework for our operations and, consequently, can have a material impact on our growth and
earnings performance.
The primary goals of the bank regulatory scheme are to maintain a safe and sound banking system and to facilitate the conduct
of sound monetary policy. This system is intended primarily for the protection of the FDIC’s deposit insurance funds, bank
depositors, and the public, rather than our shareholders and creditors. The banking agencies have broad enforcement power over
bank holding companies and banks, including the authority, among other things, to enjoin “unsafe or unsound” practices, require
affirmative action to correct any violation or practice, issue administrative orders that can be judicially enforced, direct increases
in capital, direct the sale of subsidiaries or other assets, limit dividends and distributions, restrict growth, assess civil monetary
penalties, remove officers and directors, and, with respect to banks, terminate deposit insurance or place the bank into
conservatorship or receivership. In general, these enforcement actions may be initiated for violations of laws and regulations or
unsafe or unsound practices.
The Dodd-Frank Act. The Dodd-Frank Act, enacted on July 21, 2010, aims to restore responsibility and accountability to the
financial system by significantly altering the regulation of financial institutions and the financial services industry. Full
implementation of the Dodd-Frank Act has required many new rules to be issued by federal regulatory agencies, and it will
continue to profoundly affect how financial institutions will be regulated in the future.
The Dodd-Frank Act, among other things:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
established the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (“CFPB” or “Bureau”), an independent bureau within the
Federal Reserve System with centralized responsibility for promulgating and enforcing federal consumer protection
laws applicable to all entities offering consumer financial products or services;
established the Financial Stability Oversight Council, tasked with the authority to identify and monitor institutions and
systems that pose a systemic risk to the financial system;
changed the assessment base for federal deposit insurance from the amount of insured deposits held by the depository
institution to the institution’s average total consolidated assets less tangible equity;
increased the minimum reserve ratio for the Deposit Insurance Fund from 1.15% to 1.35%;
permanently increased the deposit insurance coverage amount from $100,000 to $250,000;
required the federal banking agencies to make their capital requirements for insured depository institutions
countercyclical, so that capital requirements increase in times of economic expansion and decrease in times of economic
contraction;
directed the Federal Reserve to establish interchange fees for debit cards under a restrictive “reasonable and
proportional cost” per transaction standard;
limited the ability of banking organizations to sponsor or invest in private equity and hedge funds and to engage in
proprietary trading;
increased regulation of consumer protections regarding mortgage originations, including originator compensation,
minimum repayment standards, prepayment consideration, and mortgage servicing;
restricted the preemption of select state laws by federal banking law applicable to national banks and disallowed
subsidiaries and affiliates of national banks from availing themselves of such preemption;
authorized national and state banks to establish de novo branches in any state that would permit a bank chartered in
that state to open a branch at that location; and
repealed the federal prohibition on the payment of interest on commercial demand deposits, thereby permitting
depository institutions to pay interest on business transaction and other accounts.
5
Some of these provisions have had and may continue to have the consequence of increasing our expenses, decreasing our
revenues, and changing the activities in which we choose to engage. Many aspects of the Dodd-Frank Act are subject to ongoing
implementation (such as the recent final rulemaking discussed below on small business lending data collection); further, in the
past certain provisions implemented by federal agencies have been legislatively revised or rescinded. Currently, the U.S. Supreme
Court is considering a case challenging the constitutionality of the CFPB’s funding mechanism. If the Court rules that the CFPB’s
funding mechanism is unconstitutional, it will likely have significant consequences for the regulations and decisions rendered by
the CFPB. While we cannot predict what effect any presently contemplated or future changes in the laws or regulations or their
interpretations would have on us, these changes could be materially adverse to our financial condition and results of operations.
Small Business Lending Data Collection and Reporting. On March 30, 2023, the CFPB issued a final rule implementing Section
1071 of the Dodd-Frank Act. The final rule requires financial institutions to collect and report data to the CFPB on small business
loan applicants, including demographic data, lending decisions and the price and terms of credit. The purpose of the rulemaking
is to increase transparency and combat discrimination in small business lending. As of the date of this report, implementation
and enforcement of the rule has been enjoined until the U.S. Supreme Court renders its decision on the constitutionality of the
CFPB’s funding mechanism.
Interchange Fees. As noted above, the Dodd-Frank Act directed the Federal Reserve to establish interchange fees for debit cards
under a restrictive “reasonable and proportional cost” per transaction standard (known as the “Durbin Amendment”). The Federal
Reserve issued final rules implementing the Durbin Amendment in 2011, which capped interchange fees on debit cards. In
October 2023, the Federal Reserve requested comment on a proposal to significantly lower the maximum interchange fee that a
debit card issuer can receive for a debit card transaction. The proposed rule also includes a process that would result in automatic
revisions to the interchange fee cap every two years without public comment. While the current interchange fee cap on debit
cards are, and the proposed rules would be only applicable to banks with over $10 billion in total assets, banks with under $10
billion in total assets such as the Bank could potentially indirectly face fee pressure in operating debit card programs should the
proposal be adopted in its current form.
The Volcker Rule. On December 10, 2013, the Federal Reserve and the other federal banking regulators as well as the SEC each
adopted a final rule implementing Section 619 of the Dodd-Frank Act, commonly referred to as the “Volcker Rule.” Generally
speaking, the final rule prohibited a bank and its affiliates from engaging in proprietary trading and from sponsoring certain
“covered funds” or from acquiring or retaining any ownership interest in such covered funds. Most private equity, venture capital
and hedge funds are considered “covered funds” as are bank trust preferred collateralized debt obligations. The final rule
required banking entities to divest disallowed securities by July 21, 2015, subject to extension upon application. The Economic
Growth, Regulatory Relief, and Consumer Protection Act which was enacted in 2018 amended Section 619 of the Dodd-Frank
Act to exempt from the Volcker Rule any insured depository institution that has $10.0 billion or less in total consolidated assets
and whose total trading assets and trading liabilities are 5.0% or less of total consolidated assets; therefore, the Bank is currently
exempt from the Volcker Rule.
Regulatory Capital Requirements
Capital Adequacy. The Federal Reserve Board monitors the capital adequacy of the Company, on a consolidated basis, and the
OCC monitors the capital adequacy of the Bank. The regulatory agencies use a combination of risk-based guidelines and a
leverage ratio to evaluate capital adequacy and consider these capital levels when taking action on various types of applications
and when conducting supervisory activities related to safety and soundness. The risk-based capital standards are designed to
make regulatory capital requirements more sensitive to differences in risk profiles among financial institutions and their holding
companies, to account for off-balance sheet exposure, and to minimize disincentives for holding liquid assets. A financial
institution’s assets and off-balance sheet items, such as letters of credit and unfunded loan commitments, are assigned to broad
risk categories, each with appropriate risk weights. Regulatory capital, in turn, is classified in one of two tiers. “Tier 1” capital
includes two components: (1) common equity Tier 1 capital and (2) additional Tier 1 capital. Common equity Tier 1 capital
consists solely of common stock (plus related surplus), retained earnings and limited amounts of minority interests that are in the
form of common stock. Additional Tier 1 capital includes other perpetual instruments historically included in Tier 1 capital, such
as non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock. “Tier 2” capital includes, among other things, qualifying subordinated debt and
allowances for credit losses, subject to limitations. The resulting capital ratios represent capital as a percentage of total risk-
weighted assets and off-balance sheet items. Pursuant to the regulatory capital rules, the Company has made an election not to
include unrealized gains and losses in the investment securities portfolio for purposes of calculating “Tier 1” capital and “Tier
2” capital.
6
Under the current regulatory framework, we are required to maintain the following minimum regulatory capital ratios:
• A ratio of common equity Tier 1 capital to total risk-weighted assets of at least 4.5%;
• A ratio of Tier 1 capital to total risk-weighted assets of at least 6.0%;
• A ratio of Tier 1 capital plus Tier 2 capital to total risk-weighted assets of at least 8.0%; and
• A leverage ratio (Tier 1 capital to adjusted total assets) of at least 4.0%.
In addition to these minimum regulatory capital ratios, the regulations establish a capital conservation buffer with respect to the
first three capital ratios listed above. Specifically, banking organizations must hold common equity Tier 1 capital in excess of
their minimum risk-based capital ratios by at least 2.5% of risk-weighted assets in order to avoid limits on capital distributions
(including dividend payments, discretionary payments on Tier 1 instruments, and stock buybacks) and certain discretionary bonus
payments to executive officers. Thus, when including the 2.5% capital conservation buffer, a bank holding company and bank’s
minimum ratio of common equity Tier 1 capital to total risk-weighted assets becomes 7%, its minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to
total risk-weighted assets becomes 8.5%, and its minimum ratio of total capital to total risk-weighted assets becomes 10.5%.
We were in compliance with all applicable minimum regulatory capital requirements, including the capital conservation buffer, as
of December 31, 2023.
The required capital ratios set forth above are minimums, and the Federal Reserve and the OCC may determine that a banking
organization, based on its size, complexity or risk profile, must maintain a higher level of capital in order to operate in a safe and
sound manner. Risks such as concentration of credit risks and the risk arising from non-traditional activities, as well as the
institution’s exposure to a decline in the economic value of its capital due to changes in interest rates, and an institution’s ability
to manage those risks are important factors that are to be taken into account by the federal banking agencies in assessing an
institution’s overall capital adequacy.
The federal banking agencies finalized a rule in 2019 that allows bank holding companies and banks with less than $10.0 billion
in total consolidated assets, limited amounts of certain assets and off-balance sheet exposures, and a leverage ratio of greater than
9% to elect to use the Community Bank Leverage Ratio (“CBLR”) framework. A community banking organization electing to
use the CBLR framework would have a simplified capital regime and would be considered well capitalized as long as it had a
leverage ratio of greater than 9%. We have not elected to use the CBLR framework, and it is uncertain if we will elect to use the
CBLR framework in the future.
Furthermore, the U.S. federal banking agencies have finalized rules that permit bank holding companies and banks to phase-in,
for regulatory capital purposes, the day-one impact of the new current expected credit loss accounting rule in retained earnings
over a period of three years commencing with time of adoption of the new standard. We did not make the election to phase in
the impact of CECL on our regulatory capital calculations because the adoption of CECL did not have a significant impact on
our regulatory capital ratios. For further discussion of the new current expected credit loss accounting rule, see Note 1. Summary
of Significant Accounting Policies – Accounting Standards Adopted in 2023, and also see “Our allowance for credit losses may
prove to be insufficient to absorb losses inherent in our loan portfolio, and we may be required to further increase our provision
for credit losses. This risk may be heightened by our adoption of the Current Expected Credit Loss accounting standard effective
January 1, 2023. If our actual credit losses exceed our allowance for credit losses, our net income will decrease.” in Item 1A. Risk
Factors.
Prompt Corrective Action Regulations. Under the prompt corrective action regulations, the OCC is required and authorized to
take supervisory actions against undercapitalized banks. For this purpose, a bank is placed in one of the following five categories
based on its capital: well capitalized, adequately capitalized, undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized, and critically
undercapitalized. Under the prompt corrective action regulations, as currently in effect, to be well capitalized, a bank must have
a leverage capital ratio of at least 5%, a common equity Tier 1 capital ratio of at least 6.5%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of at
least 8%, and a total risk-based capital ratio of at least 10%, and must not be subject to any order or written agreement or directive
by a federal banking agency to meet and maintain a specific capital level for any capital measure.
Federal banking regulators are required to take various mandatory supervisory actions and are authorized to take other
discretionary actions with respect to banks in the three undercapitalized categories that, if undertaken, could have a material
adverse effect on the bank's operations or financial condition. The severity of the action depends upon the capital category in
which the bank is placed. Generally, subject to a narrow exception, banking regulators must appoint a receiver or conservator for
a bank that is critically undercapitalized. The federal banking agencies have specified by regulation the relevant capital level for
each category. A bank that is categorized as undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized, or critically undercapitalized is
required to submit an acceptable capital restoration plan to its appropriate federal banking agency. An undercapitalized bank also
7
is generally prohibited from increasing its average total assets, making acquisitions, establishing any branches or engaging in
any new line of business, except under an accepted capital restoration plan or with OCC approval. The regulations also establish
procedures for downgrading a bank to a lower capital category based on supervisory factors other than capital. Additionally, only
a well-capitalized depository bank may accept or renew brokered deposits without prior regulatory approval.
Furthermore, a bank holding company must guarantee that a subsidiary depository institution meets its capital restoration plan,
subject to various limitations. The controlling holding company’s obligation to fund a capital restoration plan is limited to the
lesser of 5% of an undercapitalized subsidiary’s assets at the time it became undercapitalized or the amount required to meet
regulatory capital requirements.
The capital classification of a bank affects the frequency of regulatory examinations, the bank’s ability to engage in certain
activities, and the deposit insurance premiums paid by the bank. As of December 31, 2023, the Bank met the requirements to be
categorized as well capitalized under the prompt corrective action framework as currently in effect.
Acquisitions by Bank Holding Companies
Federal laws, including the Bank Holding Company Act and the Change in Bank Control Act, impose additional prior notice or
approval requirements and ongoing regulatory requirements on any investor that seeks to acquire direct or indirect “control” of
an FDIC-insured depository institution or bank holding company. We must obtain the prior approval of the Federal Reserve
before (1) acquiring more than 5% of the voting stock of any bank or other bank holding company, (2) acquiring all or
substantially all of the assets of any bank or bank holding company, or (3) merging or consolidating with any other bank holding
company. The Federal Reserve may determine not to approve any of these transactions if it would result in or tend to create a
monopoly or substantially lessen competition or otherwise function as a restraint of trade, unless the anti-competitive effects of
the proposed transaction are clearly outweighed by the public interest in meeting the convenience and needs of the community
to be served. The Federal Reserve is also required to consider the financial and managerial resources and future prospects of the
bank holding companies and banks concerned, the convenience and needs of the community to be served, and the record of a
bank holding company and its subsidiary bank(s) in combating money laundering activities. In addition, a failure to implement
and maintain adequate compliance programs could cause the Federal Reserve or other banking regulators not to approve an
acquisition when regulatory approval is required or to prohibit an acquisition even if approval is not required.
If the Bank seeks to acquire another depository institution or branches of another depository institution, it is required to obtain
the prior approval of the OCC. In reviewing the application, the OCC will consider, among other things, the Bank’s capital level,
its financial and managerial resources and future prospects, the impact of the transaction on the Bank’s safety and soundness, the
impact of the transaction on competition in the relevant geographic market, its record in combating money laundering activities,
the impact on the convenience and needs of the communities served, and the Bank’s record of Community Reinvestment Act
performance.
Scope of Permissible Bank Holding Company Activities
In general, the Bank Holding Company Act limits the activities permissible for bank holding companies to the business of
banking, managing or controlling banks, and such other activities as the Federal Reserve has determined to be so closely related
to banking as to be properly incident thereto.
A bank holding company may elect to be treated as a financial holding company and receive expanded powers if it and its
depository institution subsidiaries are “well capitalized” and “well managed,” and its subsidiary banks controlled by it have at
least a “satisfactory” Community Reinvestment Act rating. We have elected for the Company to be treated as a financial holding
company. As a financial holding company, we may engage in a range of activities that are (1) financial in nature or incidental to
such financial activity or (2) complementary to a financial activity and which do not pose a substantial risk to the safety and
soundness of a depository institution or to the financial system generally. These activities include securities dealing, underwriting
and market making, insurance underwriting and agency activities, merchant banking and insurance company portfolio
investments. Expanded financial activities of financial holding companies generally will be regulated according to the type of
such financial activity: banking activities by banking regulators; securities activities by securities regulators; and insurance
activities by insurance regulators.
The Bank Holding Company Act does not place territorial limitations on permissible non-banking activities of bank holding
companies. The Federal Reserve has the power to order any bank holding company or its subsidiaries to terminate any activity
or to terminate its ownership or control of any subsidiary when the Federal Reserve has reasonable grounds to believe that
continuation of such activity or such ownership or control constitutes a serious risk to the financial soundness, safety or stability
of any bank subsidiary of the bank holding company.
8
Source of Strength Doctrine for Bank Holding Companies
Under longstanding Federal Reserve policy which has been codified by the Dodd-Frank Act, we are expected to act as a source
of financial strength to, and to commit resources to support, the Bank. This support may be required at times when we may not
be inclined to provide it. In addition, any capital loans that we make to the Bank are subordinate in right of payment to deposits
and to certain other indebtedness of the Bank. In the event of our bankruptcy, any commitment by us to a federal bank regulatory
agency to maintain the capital of the Bank will be assumed by the bankruptcy trustee and entitled to a priority of payment.
Dividends
As a bank holding company, we are subject to certain restrictions on dividends under applicable banking laws and regulations.
The Federal Reserve has issued a policy statement that provides that a bank holding company should not pay dividends unless:
(1) its net income over the last four quarters (net of dividends paid) has been sufficient to fully fund the dividends; (2) the
prospective rate of earnings retention appears to be consistent with the capital needs, asset quality and overall financial condition
of the bank holding company and its subsidiaries; and (3) the bank holding company will continue to meet minimum required
capital adequacy ratios. Accordingly, a bank holding company should not pay cash dividends that exceed its net income or that
can only be funded in ways that weaken the bank holding company’s financial health, such as by borrowing. The Dodd-Frank
Act imposes, and Basel III effected, additional restrictions on the ability of banking institutions to pay dividends (including
failure to maintain capital above the Basel III capital conservation buffer). The Federal Reserve may further restrict the payment
of dividends by engaging in supervisory action to restrict dividends or by requiring us to maintain a higher level of capital than
would otherwise be required under any applicable minimum capital requirements.
Our ability to pay dividends depends in part upon the receipt of dividends from the Bank. The Bank is also subject to certain
restrictions on dividends under federal laws, regulations and policies. In general, under OCC regulations, the Bank may pay
dividends to us without the approval of the OCC only so long as the amount of the dividend does not exceed the Bank’s net
income earned during the current year (net of dividends paid) combined with its retained net income (net of dividends paid) of
the immediately preceding two years. The Bank must obtain the approval of the OCC for any amount in excess of this threshold.
Further, a national bank may not pay a dividend in excess of its undivided profits. In addition, under federal law, the Bank may
not pay any dividend to us if it is undercapitalized or the payment of the dividend would cause it to become undercapitalized.
The OCC may further restrict the payment of dividends by requiring the Bank to maintain a higher level of capital than would
otherwise be required to be adequately capitalized for regulatory purposes. Moreover, if, in the opinion of the OCC, the Bank is
engaged in an unsound practice (which could include the payment of dividends even within the legal requirements noted above),
the OCC may require the Bank to cease such practice. The OCC has indicated that paying dividends that deplete a depository
institution’s capital base to an inadequate level would be an unsafe banking practice.
Restrictions on Transactions with Affiliates and Loans to Insiders
Federal law strictly limits the ability of banks to engage in transactions with their affiliates, including their parent bank holding
companies. Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act, and Federal Reserve Regulation W, impose quantitative limits,
qualitative standards, and collateral requirements on certain transactions by a bank with, or for the benefit of, its affiliates, and
generally require those transactions to be on terms at least as favorable to the bank as transactions with non-affiliates and to be
consistent with safe and sound practices. The Dodd-Frank Act significantly expanded the coverage and scope of the limitations
on affiliate transactions within a banking organization, including an expansion of the types of transactions that are covered
transactions to include credit exposures related to derivatives, repurchase agreements and securities lending arrangements and an
increase in the amount of time for which collateral requirements regarding covered transactions must be satisfied.
Federal law also limits a bank’s authority to extend credit to its directors, executive officers and 10% shareholders, as well as to
entities controlled by such persons. Among other things, extensions of credit to insiders are required to be made on terms that
are substantially the same as and follow credit underwriting procedures that are not less stringent than those prevailing for
comparable transactions with unaffiliated persons. Also, the terms of such extensions of credit may not involve more than the
normal risk of repayment or present other unfavorable features and may not exceed certain limitations on the amount of credit
extended to such persons, individually and in the aggregate, which limits are based, in part, on the amount of the bank’s capital.
9
Incentive Compensation Guidance
The federal banking agencies have issued comprehensive guidance on incentive compensation policies. This guidance is designed
to ensure that a financial institution’s incentive compensation structure does not encourage imprudent risk taking, which may
undermine the safety and soundness of the institution. The guidance, which applies to all employees that have the ability to
materially affect an institution’s risk profile, either individually or as part of a group, is based upon three primary principles: (1)
balanced risk taking incentives; (2) compatibility with effective controls and risk management; and (3) strong corporate
governance.
An institution’s supervisory ratings will incorporate any identified deficiencies in an institution’s compensation practices, and it
may be subject to an enforcement action if the incentive compensation arrangements pose a risk to the safety and soundness of
the institution. Further, regulations may limit discretionary bonus payments to bank executives if the institution’s regulatory
capital ratios fail to exceed certain thresholds.
Deposit Insurance Assessments
FDIC insured banks are required to pay deposit insurance assessments to the FDIC. The amount of the assessment is based on
the size of the bank’s assessment base, which is equal to its average consolidated total assets less its average tangible equity, and
its risk classification under an FDIC risk-based assessment system. Institutions assigned to higher risk classifications (that is,
institutions that pose a higher risk of loss to the Deposit Insurance Fund) pay assessments at higher rates than institutions that
pose a lower risk. An institution’s risk classification is assigned based on certain financial data and the level of supervisory
concern that the institution poses to the regulators. In addition, the FDIC can impose special assessments in certain instances. As
noted above, the Dodd-Frank Act changed the way that deposit insurance premiums are calculated. Action by the FDIC to
replenish the Deposit Insurance Fund when needed could result in higher assessment rates, which could reduce our profitability
or otherwise negatively impact our operations. The FDIC issued a final rule in October 2022 increasing deposit insurance
assessments beginning in the first quarterly assessment period of 2023. On November 16, 2023, the FDIC Board of Directors
approved a final rule to implement a special assessment on banks with over $5 billion in total assets to recover the loss to the
Deposit Insurance Fund associated with protecting uninsured depositors following the closures of Silicon Valley Bank and
Signature Bank. The Federal Deposit Insurance Act requires the FDIC to take this action in connection with the systemic risk
determination announced on March 12, 2023. While we are not subject to this special assessment, we may be required to pay
higher FDIC insurance premiums in the future if there are additional bank or financial institution failures or if the FDIC otherwise
determines to increase assessment rates.
Branching and Interstate Banking
Under federal law, the Bank is permitted to establish additional branch offices within Louisiana, subject to the approval of the
OCC. As a result of the Dodd-Frank Act, the Bank may also establish additional branch offices outside of Louisiana, subject to
prior regulatory approval, so long as the laws of the state where the branch is to be located would permit a state bank chartered
in that state to establish a branch. The Bank may also establish offices in other states by merging with banks or by purchasing
branches of other banks in other states, subject to certain restrictions.
Community Reinvestment Act
The Bank is required under the Community Reinvestment Act, or CRA, and related OCC regulations to help meet the credit
needs of its communities, including low and moderate-income borrowers. In connection with its examination of the Bank, the
OCC assesses our record of compliance with the CRA. The Bank’s failure to comply with the provisions of the CRA could, at a
minimum, result in denial of certain corporate applications, such as branches or mergers, or in restrictions on its or the Company’s
activities. The Bank received a “Satisfactory” CRA rating on its most recent CRA Performance Evaluation. The CRA requires
all FDIC-insured institutions to publicly disclose their rating.
On October 24, 2023, the federal banking agencies adopted a final rule to modernize the CRA regulations. Under the final rule,
(1) the federal banking agencies will evaluate bank performance across the varied activities they conduct and communities in
which they operate in order to encourage banks to expand access to credit, investment, and banking services in low- and
moderate-income communities, (2) the CRA regulations are updated to evaluate lending outside traditional assessment areas
generated by the growth of non-branch delivery systems, such as online and mobile banking, branchless banking, and hybrid
models, (3) a new metrics-based approach was adopted to evaluate bank retail lending and community development financing,
using benchmarks based on peer and demographic data and (4) CRA evaluations and data collection are tailored according to
bank size and type. In addition, the final rule exempts small and intermediate banks from new data requirements that apply to
banks with assets of at least $2 billion and limits certain new data requirements to large banks with assets greater than $10 billion.
Most of the rule’s requirements will be applicable beginning January 1, 2026. The remaining requirements, including the data
10
reporting requirements, will be applicable on January 1, 2027. We continue to evaluate the new rule and its effects on our
operations going forward. The new rules are complex and likely to increase our costs.
Concentrated Commercial Real Estate Lending Regulations
The federal bank regulatory agencies have promulgated guidance governing financial institutions with concentrations in
commercial real estate lending. The guidance provides that a bank has a concentration in commercial real estate lending if (i) total
reported loans for construction, land development, and other land represent 100% or more of total capital or (ii) total reported
loans secured by multifamily and nonfarm nonresidential properties and loans for construction, land development, and other land
represent 300% or more of total capital and the bank’s commercial real estate loan portfolio has increased 50% or more during
the prior 36 months. Owner-occupied loans are excluded from this second category. If a concentration is present, management
must employ heightened risk management practices that address, among other things, board and management oversight and
strategic planning, portfolio management, development of underwriting standards, risk assessment and monitoring through
market analysis and stress testing, and maintenance of increased capital levels as needed to support the level of commercial real
estate lending. At December 31, 2023, the Company did not have a concentration in commercial real estate as defined by the
regulatory guidance.
Financial Privacy and Cybersecurity Requirements
Federal law and regulations limit a financial institution’s ability to share consumer financial information with unaffiliated third
parties. Specifically, these provisions require all financial institutions offering financial products or services to retail customers
to provide such customers with the financial institution’s privacy policy and provide such customers the opportunity to “opt out”
of the sharing of personal financial information with unaffiliated third parties. The sharing of information for marketing purposes
is also subject to limitations. The Bank currently has a privacy protection policy in place.
Federal law and regulations also establish certain information security guidelines that require each financial institution, under the
supervision and ongoing oversight of its board of directors or an appropriate committee thereof, to develop, implement, and
maintain a comprehensive written information security program designed to ensure the security and confidentiality of customer
information, to protect against anticipated threats or hazards to the security or integrity of such information, and to protect against
unauthorized access to or use of such information that could result in substantial harm or inconvenience to any customer. These
federal guidelines require a financial institution to (i) identify reasonably foreseeable internal and external threats that could
result in unauthorized disclosure, misuse, alteration, or destruction of customer information or customer information systems,
(ii) assess the likelihood and potential damage of these threats, taking into consideration the sensitivity of customer information,
and (iii) assess the sufficiency of policies, procedures, customer information systems, and other arrangements in place to control
risks. Under the federal guidelines, financial institutions have to provide notice to affected customers of a data breach under
certain circumstances.
The federal guidelines also impose requirements on financial institutions with respect to overseeing their service providers,
including (i) exercising appropriate due diligence in selecting its service providers; (ii) requiring its service providers by contract
to implement appropriate measures designed to meet the objectives of the federal guidelines; and (iii) where indicated by its risk
assessment, monitor its service providers to confirm that they have satisfied their obligations as required by the guidelines. The
federal banking regulations also require a bank to notify its primary Federal regulator within 36 hours of the occurrence of a
computer-security incident that rises to the level of a “notification incident.” A “notification incident” is defined as a computer-
security incident that has materially disrupted or degraded, or is reasonably likely to materially disrupt or degrade, a banking
organization’s (1) ability to carry out banking operations, activities, or processes, or deliver banking products and services to a
material portion of its customer base, in the ordinary course of business; (2) business line(s), including associated operations,
services, functions, and support, that upon failure would result in a material loss of revenue, profit, or franchise value; or (3)
operations, including associated services, functions and support, as applicable, the failure or discontinuance of which would pose
a threat to the financial stability of the U.S. A “computer-security incident” is defined as is an occurrence that results in actual
harm to the confidentiality, integrity, or availability of an information system or the information that the system processes, stores,
or transmits.
Federal banking regulators regularly issue guidance regarding cybersecurity intended to enhance cyber risk management. A
financial institution is expected to implement multiple lines of defense against cyberattacks. Financial institutions are also
expected to implement procedures designed to address the risks posed by potential cyber threats, and to allow the institution to
respond and recover effectively after a cyberattack. The Company has adopted procedures designed to comply with the regulatory
cybersecurity guidance.
11
Consumer Laws and Regulations
The Bank is subject to numerous laws and regulations intended to protect consumers in transactions with the Bank, including,
among others, laws regarding unfair, deceptive and abusive acts and practices, usury laws, and other federal consumer protection
statutes. These federal laws include the Equal Credit Opportunity Act (the “ECOA”), the Electronic Fund Transfer Act, the Fair
Credit Reporting Act, the Fair Debt Collection Practices Act, the Real Estate Settlement Procedures Act of 1974, the S.A.F.E.
Mortgage Licensing Act of 2008, the Truth in Lending Act and the Truth in Savings Act, among others. Many states and local
jurisdictions have consumer protection laws analogous, and in addition, to those enacted under federal law. These laws and
regulations mandate certain disclosure requirements and regulate the manner in which financial institutions must deal with
customers when taking deposits, making loans and conducting other types of transactions. Failure to comply with these laws and
regulations could give rise to regulatory sanctions, customer rescission rights, action by state and local attorneys general and civil
or criminal liability.
In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act created the CFPB that has broad authority to regulate and supervise retail financial services
activities of banks and various non-bank providers. The Bureau has authority to promulgate regulations, issue orders, guidance
and policy statements, conduct examinations and bring enforcement actions with regard to consumer financial products and
services. In general, however, banks with assets of $10 billion or less, such as the Bank, will continue to be examined for
consumer compliance by their primary federal bank regulator. In October 2022, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the 5th Circuit
issued a decision ruling that the CFPB’s funding mechanism violates the separation-of-powers principles embodied in the U.S.
Constitution’s Appropriations Clause. This ruling essentially called into question the validity of the Bureau’s authority to issue
regulations and pursue enforcement actions. The U.S. Supreme Court agreed to review the case and held oral argument on
October 3, 2023. The Court has not yet issued its decision. We believe that the banking industry generally will continue
complying with the Bureau’s regulations until clarity is provided.
There has been an enhanced focus by federal bank regulatory agencies with respect to industry practices relating to overdraft
fees and non-sufficient funds fees. For example, the CFPB issued a Request for Information in January 2022 seeking public input
with respect to financial institution practices relating to, among other areas, credit card fees, overdraft fees and non-sufficient
funds fees and stated its intent to reduce these types of fees through crafting rules, issuing industry guidance and focusing
supervision and enforcement resources to achieve this goal. In October 2022, the Bureau issued guidance with respect to certain
practices relating to overdraft fees and bounced check fees. The FDIC issued guidance in August 2022 with respect to bank
practices involving charging multiple non-sufficient funds fees on the representment of items on a deposit account. In February
2023, the Bureau issued a proposed rule that would restrict certain practices relating to credit card late fees. On April 26, 2023,
the OCC issued guidance addressing risks associated with bank overdraft protection programs. On January 17, 2024, the Bureau
issued a proposed rule that would require financial institutions with over $10 billion in total assets to treat overdraft loans like
credit cards and other loans as well as to provide clear disclosures and other protections. On January 24, 2024, the Bureau issued
a proposed rule that would prohibit non-sufficient funds fees on transactions that financial institutions decline in real time. These
types of transactions include declined debit card purchases and ATM withdrawals, as well as some declined peer-to-peer
payments.
Mortgage Lending Rules
The Dodd-Frank Act authorized the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau to establish certain minimum standards for the
origination of residential mortgages, including a determination of the borrower’s ability to repay. Under the Dodd-Frank Act,
financial institutions may not make a residential mortgage loan unless they make a “reasonable and good faith determination”
that the consumer has a “reasonable ability” to repay the loan. The Dodd-Frank Act allows borrowers to raise certain defenses to
foreclosure but provides a full or partial safe harbor from such defenses for loans that are “qualified mortgages.” The Bureau’s
rules, among other things, specify the types of income and assets that may be considered in the ability-to-repay determination,
the permissible sources for verification, and the required methods of calculating the loan’s monthly payments. The rules extend
the requirement that creditors verify and document a borrower’s income and assets to include all information that creditors rely
on in determining repayment ability. The rules also provide further examples of third-party documents that may be relied on for
such verification, such as government records and check cashing or funds transfer service receipts. The rules also define
“qualified mortgages,” imposing both underwriting standards and limits on the terms of their loans. Points and fees are subject
to a relatively stringent cap, and the terms include a wide array of payments that may be made in the course of closing a loan.
Certain loans, including interest-only loans and negative amortization loans, cannot be qualified mortgages.
12
Anti-Money Laundering and OFAC
Under federal law (including the Bank Secrecy Act and the USA PATRIOT Act), financial institutions must maintain anti-money
laundering programs that include: established internal policies, procedures and controls; a designated compliance officer; an
ongoing employee training program; and testing of the program by an independent audit function. Financial institutions are also
prohibited from entering into specified financial transactions and account relationships and must meet enhanced standards for
due diligence and customer identification in their dealings with foreign financial institutions and foreign customers. Financial
institutions must take reasonable steps to conduct enhanced scrutiny of account relationships to guard against money laundering
and to report any suspicious transactions, and law enforcement authorities have been granted increased access to financial
information maintained by financial institutions.
The Office of Foreign Assets Control, or OFAC, is responsible for helping to ensure that U.S. entities do not engage in
transactions with certain prohibited parties, as defined by various Executive Orders and Acts of Congress. OFAC publishes lists
of persons and organizations suspected of aiding, harboring or engaging in terrorist acts, known as Specially Designated Nationals
and Blocked Persons. Generally, if the Bank identifies a transaction, account or wire transfer relating to a person or entity on an
OFAC list, it must freeze the account or block the transaction, file a suspicious activity report and notify the appropriate
authorities.
Bank regulators routinely examine institutions for compliance with these obligations and they must consider an institution’s
compliance in connection with the regulatory review of applications, including applications for banking mergers and acquisitions.
Failure of a financial institution to maintain and implement adequate programs to combat money laundering and terrorist
financing and comply with OFAC sanctions, or to comply with relevant laws and regulations, could have serious legal,
reputational and financial consequences for the institution.
Safety and Soundness Standards
Federal bank regulatory agencies have adopted guidelines that establish general standards relating to internal controls and
information systems, internal audit systems, loan documentation, credit underwriting, interest rate exposure, asset growth and
compensation, fees and benefits. Additionally, the agencies have adopted regulations that provide the authority to order an
institution that has been given notice by an agency that it is not satisfying any of these safety and soundness standards to submit
a compliance plan. If, after being so notified, an institution fails to submit an acceptable compliance plan or fails in any material
respect to implement an acceptable compliance plan, the agency must issue an order directing action to correct the deficiency
and may issue an order directing other actions of the types to which an undercapitalized institution is subject under the “prompt
corrective action” provisions of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act. If an institution fails to comply with such an order, the agency
may seek to enforce such order in judicial proceedings and to impose civil money penalties.
Bank holding companies are also not permitted to engage in unsound banking practices. For example, the Federal Reserve’s
Regulation Y requires a holding company to give the Federal Reserve prior notice of any redemption or repurchase of its own
equity securities, if the consideration to be paid, together with the consideration paid for any repurchases in the preceding year,
is equal to 10% or more of the company’s consolidated net worth. The Federal Reserve may oppose the transaction if it believes
that the transaction would constitute an unsafe or unsound practice or would violate any law or regulation. As another example,
a holding company could not impair its subsidiary bank’s soundness by causing it to make funds available to non-banking
subsidiaries or their customers if the Federal Reserve believed it not prudent to do so. The Federal Reserve has broad authority
to prohibit activities of bank holding companies and their nonbanking subsidiaries that represent unsafe and unsound banking
practices or that constitute violations of laws or regulations.
Effect of Governmental Monetary Policies
The commercial banking business is affected not only by general economic conditions but also by U.S. fiscal policy and the
monetary policies of the Federal Reserve. Some of the instruments of monetary policy available to the Federal Reserve include
changes in the discount rate on member bank borrowings, the fluctuating availability of borrowings at the “discount window,”
open market operations, the imposition of and changes in reserve requirements against member banks’ deposits and assets of
foreign branches, and the imposition of and changes in reserve requirements against certain borrowings by banks and their
affiliates. These policies influence to a significant extent the overall growth of bank loans, investments, and deposits and the
interest rates charged on loans or paid on deposits. For example, during 2022 and in 2023 the Federal Open Market Committee
of the Federal Reserve increased the target rate range for trading in the federal funds market (known as the federal funds target
rate or the federal funds rate) multiple times, increasing market interest rates. The federal funds rate is the rate at which
commercial banks borrow and lend their excess reserves to each other overnight. We cannot predict the nature of future fiscal
and monetary policies and the effect of these policies on our future business and earnings.
13
Future Legislation and Regulatory Reform
The OCC announced on September 28, 2023 that its key areas of supervisory strategies for 2024 will include: asset and liability
management; credit risk management and allowance for credit losses; cybersecurity; operations; digital ledger technology
activities; change management; payments; Bank Secrecy Act/anti-money laundering/countering the financing of terrorism/Office
of Foreign Assets Control; consumer compliance, fair lending risk and CRA performance; and climate-related financial risk
management.
New laws, regulations and policies are regularly proposed that contain wide-ranging proposals for altering the structures,
regulations and competitive relationships of financial institutions operating in the U.S. In addition, existing laws, regulations and
policies are continually subject to modification or changes in interpretation. We cannot predict whether or in what form any law,
regulation or policy will be adopted or modified or the extent to which our operations and activities, financial condition, results
of operations, strategic plans or future prospects may be affected by its adoption or modification.
The cumulative effect of these laws and regulations adds significantly to the cost of our operations and thus has a negative impact
on profitability. There has also been a tremendous expansion in recent years of financial service providers that are not subject to
the same level of regulation, examination and oversight as we are. Those providers, because they are not so highly regulated,
may have a competitive advantage over us and may continue to draw large amounts of funds away from traditional banking
institutions, with a continuing adverse effect on the banking industry in general.
Human Capital Resources
Our business is built on relationships with our customers, our community, and most of all, our employees. We are committed to
providing quality service and products to the consumers and businesses within the markets we serve. We strive to create superior
shareholder value by attracting and retaining exceptional employees who are highly motivated and well trained.
Our compensation strategy provides a total rewards structure that reflects position responsibilities, is competitive with the
external market, and is capable of attracting, retaining, and motivating our employees. We provide a comprehensive benefits
package for eligible employees which includes group health (medical, dental, and vision) insurance including a health savings
account option, paid time off, short and long term disability insurance, life insurance and a 401(k) plan in which we provide a
matching contribution. We also offer eligible employees participation in our Employee Stock Ownership Plan (“ESOP”) as well
as our Long Term Incentive Plan (“LTIP”) in order to better align employee and shareholder interests.
We provide employees with robust training programs that promote employee development and effectiveness by providing high-
quality curriculums designed to meet individual, departmental and Bank-wide objectives. This includes mentorships, 1-on-1 job
shadowing, classroom training, internships, and computer-based training.
We believe employing a diverse and inclusive workforce strengthens our ability to serve our customers and our communities,
which is a key component of our success. To that end, we are a proud equal opportunity employer committed to attracting,
retaining and promoting employees regardless of sex, sexual orientation, gender identity, race, color, national origin, age, religion
and physical ability. We do not tolerate illegal discrimination or harassment and encourage employees to immediately report any
violations to management and human resources.
As of December 31, 2023, we had 320 full-time and 11 part-time employees. None of our employees are represented by any
collective bargaining unit or are parties to a collective bargaining agreement. We believe that our relations with our employees
are good.
Available Information
Our filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”), including annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports
on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K and all amendments thereto, are available on our website as soon as reasonably
practicable after the reports are filed with or furnished to the SEC. Copies can be obtained free of charge in the “Investor
Relations” section of our website at www.investarbank.com. Our SEC filings are also available through the SEC’s website
www.sec.gov. Copies of these filings are also available by writing to us at the following address:
Investar Holding Corporation
P.O. Box 84207
Baton Rouge, Louisiana 70884-4207
14
Item 1A. Risk Factors
Our business is subject to risk. In addition to the other information contained in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, including
management’s discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations and our financial statements and the notes
thereto, investors should consider the following risks when evaluating whether to invest in our common stock. If any of the
following risks occur, whether alone or in combination, our business, financial condition, results of operations, cash flows and
long-term growth prospects could be materially and adversely affected. Additional risks that we do not presently know of or
currently deem immaterial may also adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations, cash flows and long-
term growth prospects.
Risks Related to our Business
As a business operating in the financial services industry, our business and operations may be adversely affected by prevailing
economic conditions and geopolitical matters.
Our financial performance generally, and in particular the ability of borrowers to pay interest on and repay principal of
outstanding loans and the value of collateral securing those loans, as well as demand for loans and other products and services
we offer, is highly dependent upon the business environment in the primary markets where we operate and in the U.S. as a
whole. For example, high inflation in 2021 through 2023 resulted in the Federal Reserve raising target interest rates, on a
cumulative basis, by 525 basis points since March 2022, causing increases in the costs of credit, capital and deposits and
limitations on the availability of credit and capital. Our business may also be adversely affected by declines in economic growth,
business activity, investor or business confidence; declines in real estate values; rising unemployment; rising domestic political
tensions; risks of government shutdowns; natural disasters; the emergence or worsening of widespread public health challenges
or pandemics such as the COVID-19 pandemic; or a combination of these or other economic, political and business factors.
In addition, new or rising geopolitical tensions including those resulting from the wars and violence in Ukraine and Israel and
surrounding areas, along with other instances of violence, acts of terrorism and political unrest, can result in disruptions in or
volatility in the economy and in financial and commodity markets in the U.S. and globally, disruptions in international trade
patterns, and slow growth or declines in economic sectors of the global and U.S. economies.
Economic uncertainty and negative events in the economy or in domestic political or geopolitical matters could have a material
adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition, including our liquidity position. Among other things,
they may result in higher than expected loan delinquencies, a decline in the value of collateral securing our loans, instability in
our deposit base, further increases in our costs of capital and deposits, disruptions in our ability to complete acquisitions, and a
decline in demand for our products and services. They may cause us to incur losses, including losses on loans beyond those
provided for in our allowance for credit losses, and losses in our investment securities portfolio, impairments of assets including
goodwill, and may adversely impact our regulatory capital.
Increasing and high interest rates in 2022 and 2023 caused interest expense on both deposits and borrowings to increase
significantly in 2023; further increases in interest rates could continue to have an adverse effect on our profitability.
The majority of our assets and liabilities are monetary in nature and, as a result, we are subject to significant risk from changes
in interest rates. Changes in interest rates may affect our net interest income as well as the valuation of our assets and liabilities.
We cannot predict with certainty changes in interest rates, which are affected by many factors beyond our control, including
inflation, recession, unemployment, money supply, competition for loans and deposits, domestic and international events,
changes in the U.S. and other financial markets, and the policies of the Federal Reserve. Inflation increased rapidly during 2021
through June 2022. Since June 2022, the rate of inflation generally has declined; however, it has remained at high levels compared
to the Federal Reserve’s target rate of inflation of two percent. In response, the Federal Reserve raised the federal funds target
rate multiple times from March 2022 through July 2023, by 525 basis points on a cumulative basis.
Our earnings depend significantly on our net interest income, which is the difference between interest income on interest-earning
assets, such as loans and securities, and interest expense on interest-bearing liabilities, such as deposits and borrowings. We
expect to periodically experience “gaps” in the interest rate sensitivities of our assets and liabilities, meaning that either our
interest-bearing liabilities will be more sensitive to changes in market interest rates than our interest-earning assets, or vice versa.
In either event, if market interest rates move contrary to our position, this “gap” may work against us, and our earnings may be
adversely affected. When interest-bearing liabilities mature or reprice more quickly, or to a greater degree than interest-earning
assets in a period, an increase in interest rates could reduce net interest income. Similarly, when interest-earning assets mature
or reprice more quickly, or to a greater degree than interest-bearing liabilities, falling interest rates could reduce net interest
income.
15
Additionally, an increase in the general level of interest rates may also, among other things, adversely affect our current
borrowers’ ability to repay variable rate loans, the demand for and our ability to originate loans, negatively affect the value of
our investment securities portfolio, and decrease loan prepayment rates, or could increase the cost of the Company’s deposits
and borrowings.
Rising and high interest rates in 2022 and 2023 caused interest expense on both deposits and borrowings to increase significantly
in 2023, putting pressure on our net interest margin. Our cost of interest-bearing deposits rose to 2.49% in 2023 from 0.42% in
2022, an increase of 207 basis points. Our costs of short-term borrowings rose to 4.93% in 2023 from 3.05% in 2022, an increase
of 188 basis points.
We may experience additional pressure on our net interest margin during 2024 if our cost of funds increases faster than the yield
on our interest-earning assets. Additionally, due in large part to higher interest rates and market volatility during 2022 and 2023,
gross unrealized losses in our investment portfolio totaled $57.7 million at December 31, 2023 and $62.5 million at December
31, 2022. These losses may continue or worsen during 2024, and we may experience realized losses in our portfolio.
A continued high general level of interest rates or any additional increases in such rates could result in increased loan defaults,
foreclosures and charge-offs, and also necessitate further increases to the allowance for credit losses. At the same time, the
marketability and value of the property securing a loan may be adversely affected by any reduced demand resulting from
sustained higher or increased interest rates. Further, when we place a loan on nonaccrual status, we reverse any accrued but
unpaid interest receivable, which decreases interest income, but we continue to have a cost to fund the loan, which is reflected
as interest expense, without any interest income to offset the associated funding expense. Thus, an increase in the amount of
nonperforming assets would have an adverse impact on net interest income.
Conversely, a decrease in the general level of interest rates may lead to, among other things, prepayments on our loan and
mortgage-backed securities portfolios as borrowers refinance their loans at lower rates, lower rates on new loans, lower rates on
existing variable rate loans, and lower yields on investment securities, which could result in decreased yields on earning assets.
Although our asset-liability management strategy is designed to control and mitigate exposure to the risks related to changes in
the general level of market interest rates, we may not be able to accurately predict the likelihood, nature and magnitude of those
changes or how and to what extent they may affect our business. We also may not be able to adequately prepare for or compensate
for the consequences of such changes. Significant increases in interest rates, as has occurred during the last two fiscal years,
makes our business and our balance sheet more challenging to manage. Any failure to predict and prepare for changes in interest
rates or adjust for the consequences of these changes may adversely affect our earnings and capital levels. For additional
information, see Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Risk
Management – Interest Rate Risk.
A lack of liquidity, including due to events outside our control or ineffective liquidity management, could adversely affect our
ability to fund operations and meet our obligations as they become due.
Liquidity is essential to our business. Liquidity risk is the potential that we will be unable to meet our obligations as they come
due because of an inability to liquidate assets or obtain adequate funding. The primary source of the Bank’s funds are customer
deposits, loan repayments and investment securities maturities or sales, while borrowings are a secondary source of liquidity.
We also use brokered deposits from time to time and our use of brokered deposits increased during 2023. Brokered deposits tend
to be more sensitive to changes in interest rates than other types of deposits and therefore can be a more expensive and uncertain
source of funds. The Bank’s liquidity could be adversely impacted if rates offered by the Bank were less than those offered by
other institutions seeking brokered deposits, or if such depositors were to perceive a decline in the Bank’s safety or soundness.
Additionally, we must maintain our well-capitalized status in order to accept brokered deposits without prior regulatory approval.
Our access to deposits and other funding sources in adequate amounts and on acceptable terms is affected by a number of factors,
including rates paid by competitors, returns available to customers on alternative investments, customer confidence in the safety
of uninsured deposits and general economic conditions. Any decline in available funding could adversely impact our ability to
originate loans, invest in securities, meet our expenses, pay dividends to our shareholders, or to fulfill obligations such as repaying
our borrowings or meeting deposit withdrawal demands, any of which could have a material adverse impact on our business,
financial condition, results of operations and long-term growth prospects.
The highly-publicized failures of Silicon Valley Bank, Signature Bank and First Republic Bank during the first half of 2023
caused significant disruptions in the banking industry. These industry developments negatively impacted overall customer
confidence in the safety of their deposits, particularly uninsured deposits, at some regional banks. As a result, some customers
moved deposits to, or maintained deposits with, larger financial institutions or moved funds to investment alternatives outside
the banking industry. The rapid failures of these large banks highlighted risks associated with advances in technology that
increase the speed at which information, concerns and rumors can spread through traditional and new media and increase the
16
speed at which deposits can be moved from bank to bank or outside the banking system, heightening liquidity concerns of
traditional banks. Regulators and the largest U.S. banks took steps designed to increase liquidity at regional banks and strengthen
depositor confidence in the broader banking industry, including the Bank Term Funding Program discussed elsewhere in this
report and measures to protect uninsured deposits from loss; however, there are no guarantees that such steps would be
implemented in the future if a similar disruption in the industry were to occur. For more information on the Company’s deposits
and liquidity position, see Part I. Item 2. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations under the headings “Certain Events That Affect Period-over-Period Comparability,” “Discussion and Analysis of
Financial Condition – Deposits” and “Liquidity and Capital Resources.” Concerns about liquidity in the banking industry and
the safety of uninsured deposits that may result from similar events in the future may materially adversely impact our liquidity,
cost of funds, loan funding capacity, net interest margin, capital and results of operations.
Inflation and rising prices may continue to adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition.
As noted above, inflation increased rapidly during 2021 and continued rising through June 2022. Since June 2022, the rate of
inflation generally has declined; however, it has remained at high levels compared to the Federal Reserve’s target rate of inflation
of two percent. Inflation increases our borrowers’ costs of living and costs of doing business, which may make it more difficult
for them to repay their loans, increasing our credit risk. Inflation also increases many of our operating costs, including the costs
of goods and services we purchase and the costs of salaries and benefits. We believe that higher rates resulting from inflation
and related factors led to constrained loan demand during 2023. When the rate of inflation accelerates, there is an erosion of
consumer and customer purchasing power. Accordingly, if the rate of inflation accelerates in the future, this could impact our
business by reducing our tolerance for extending credit, and our customer’s desire to obtain credit, or causing us to incur
additional provisions for credit losses resulting from a possible increased default rate. Inflation and related higher rates have led
and may continue to lead to lower loan re-financings. In addition, inflation has led to the Federal Reserve raising interest rates
during 2022 and 2023, as discussed above.
Our allowance for credit losses may prove to be insufficient to absorb losses inherent in our loan portfolio, and we may be
required to further increase our provision for credit losses. This risk may be heightened by our adoption of the Current
Expected Credit Loss accounting standard effective January 1, 2023. If our actual credit losses exceed our allowance for
credit losses, our net income will decrease.
Our business depends on our ability to successfully measure and manage credit risk. As a lender, we are exposed to the risk that
the principal of and interest on a loan will not be paid timely or at all, and that the value of any collateral supporting a loan will
be insufficient to cover any exposure to loss on a loan. Management maintains an allowance for credit losses, which is a reserve
established through a provision for credit losses charged to expense, to absorb credit losses in the loan portfolio. The
determination of the appropriate level of the allowance is inherently subjective, involves a high degree of judgment and
complexity, and requires us to make significant estimates, all of which are subject to material changes.
In June 2016, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued a new accounting standard (Accounting Standards
Update “ASU” 2016-13), referred to as Current Expected Credit Loss (“CECL”) that requires that the measurement of all
expected credit losses for financial assets held at the reporting date be based on historical experience, current conditions, and
reasonable and supportable forecasts, and requires enhanced disclosures related to the significant estimates and judgments used
in estimating credit losses, as well as the credit quality and underwriting standards of an organization’s portfolio. In addition, the
new standard amends the accounting for credit losses on purchased financial assets with credit deterioration. ASU 2016-13
became effective for us, as a smaller reporting company, on January 1, 2023. Please refer to Note 1. Summary of Significant
Accounting Policies – Recent Accounting Pronouncements, for additional discussion.
The CECL methodology requires that lifetime “expected credit losses” be recorded at the time the financial asset is originated or
acquired, and be adjusted each quarter for changes in expected lifetime credit losses. The CECL methodology replaces multiple
prior impairment models under U.S. GAAP that generally required that a loss be “incurred” before it was recognized, and
represents a significant change from prior U.S. GAAP. Our ongoing estimates of expected credit losses will depend upon our
models and assumptions, existing and forecasted macroeconomic conditions and the credit quality, composition and other
characteristics of our loan and other applicable portfolios. We believe these factors are likely to cause variability in our expected
credit losses under CECL compared to previous GAAP, and therefore an increase in the variability of our period-to-period net
income. We believe that CECL is also likely to reduce comparability across financial services companies due to the ability to
adopt different measurement approaches for expected credit losses and different economic assumptions used in each of the
companies’ models.
17
Commercial and industrial and commercial real estate loans generally are viewed as having more risk of default than residential
real estate loans or other loans or investments. These types of loans are also typically larger than residential real estate loans and
other consumer loans. Because our loan portfolio contains a significant number of commercial and industrial and commercial
real estate loans with relatively large balances, the deterioration of a material amount of these loans may cause a significant
increase in our allowance for credit losses, non-performing assets, and/or past due loans. An increase in our allowance for credit
losses, non-performing assets, and/or past due loans could result in a loss of earnings, or an increase in loan charge-offs, which
would have an adverse impact on our results of operations and financial condition.
Inaccurate management assumptions, including with respect to economic conditions affecting borrowers, new information
regarding existing loans, identification of additional problem loans and other factors, both within and outside of our control, may
require us to increase our allowance for credit losses. In addition, bank regulatory agencies periodically review the allowance for
credit losses and may require an increase in the provision for credit losses or the recognition of further loan charge-offs, based
on judgments different than those of management. Finally, if actual charge-offs in future periods exceed the allowance for credit
losses, we will need additional provisions to increase the allowance for credit losses. Any increases in the allowance for credit
losses will result in a decrease in net income and, possibly, capital and may have a material adverse effect on our business,
financial condition, and results of operations. If our actual credit losses exceed our allowance for credit losses, our net income
will decrease.
Our pivot during 2023 from primarily a growth strategy to a near-term strategy focused primarily on consistent, quality
earnings through the optimization of our balance sheet may not be successful in increasing our profitability.
During 2023, we pivoted our near-term strategy from primarily a growth strategy to primarily a focus on consistent, quality
earnings through the optimization of our balance sheet, as described elsewhere in this report. Our new strategy may not be
successful in increasing our profitability.
Our long-term business strategy includes the continuation of our multi-state growth plans, and our financial condition and
results of operations could be negatively affected if we fail to grow or fail to manage our growth effectively.
In addition to organic growth, we have grown our business through de novo branching and through the acquisition of other
financial institutions and branch locations. We have completed seven whole-bank acquisitions since 2011 and regularly review
acquisition opportunities. We have also expanded our operations outside our historical south Louisiana base and into Texas and
Alabama. Over the long-term, we intend to pursue a multi-state growth strategy for our business primarily through attractive
acquisition opportunities as well as continue to pursue organic growth throughout our franchise. Our long-term growth prospects
must be considered in light of the risks, expenses and difficulties frequently encountered by companies when expanding their
franchise, including the following:
• De Novo Branching; Branch Acquisitions. There are considerable costs involved in opening or acquiring branches,
and de novo branches generally do not generate sufficient revenues to offset their costs until they have been in operation
for at least a year or more. We have not opened a de novo branch since 2020, except that in the third quarter of 2023
we converted an existing loan and deposit production office in Tuscaloosa, Alabama to a cashless branch designed to
provide a digital banking experience. We do not expect to open de novo branches in 2024.
• Expansion into New Markets. We operated exclusively in Louisiana until we acquired financial institutions in Texas
and Alabama in 2019. The financial services industry in these areas is highly competitive, and the challenges of
continuing to operate in new markets and multiple states may be greater than we anticipate. During 2023, we completed
the sale of certain assets, deposits and other liabilities associated with two branches that we previously acquired in
Texas, in order to focus more on our core markets. Of our Bank’s branch network, these two locations were
geographically the most distant from our Louisiana headquarters.
• Acquisition and Integration Risks. An acquisition strategy involves substantial risks and uncertainties including:
◦
◦
◦
the time and costs of evaluating potential acquisition candidates and new markets, negotiating transactions, and
related diversion of management’s attention from day-to-day operations;
our ability to continue to finance acquisitions and possible dilution to our existing shareholders;
potential for acquisition agreements, once signed, not to be completed due to inability to obtain required regulatory
approvals, third-party litigation, lack of shareholder approval if required, failure of other conditions to closing,
agreement of the parties, or other reasons;
18
◦
◦
unanticipated difficulties in integrating acquired businesses, including potential losses of customers and
employees, higher than expected integration costs, and inability to maintain and increase market share at new
locations; and
potential differences between management’s expectations regarding how an acquired business will perform and
actual results once acquired, which may result in lower than expected revenues, inability to achieve expected cost
savings and synergies, higher than expected liabilities and costs, impairments of goodwill, and losses.
• Organic Growth Risks. As we continue to pursue organic growth at our existing and new or acquired locations, we
may be unable to successfully maintain loan quality, obtain deposits at attractive rates, attract and retain personnel to
implement and oversee such growth, or maintain an efficient overhead cost structure. We may also introduce new
products and services that do not produce projected profits and may result in losses.
Failure to successfully address these issues relating to our long-term growth strategy could have a material adverse effect on our
financial condition and results of operations. Also, if our long-term growth occurs more slowly than anticipated or declines, our
operating results could be materially adversely affected.
Changes in retail distribution strategies and consumer behavior may adversely impact our business, financial condition and
results of operations.
We have significant investments in our physical branch network, including in bank premises and equipment as well as in our
branch work force. Advances in technology as well as changing customer preferences for remote methods of accessing our
products and services could decrease the value of our branch network and may cause us to further change our retail distribution
strategy, and close, consolidate or sell certain branches or parcels of land held for future branch locations. These actions could
lead to losses on these assets or adversely impact the carrying value of long-lived assets and may lead to expenditures to
reconfigure remaining branches. Any changes in our branch network strategy could adversely impact our business if it results in
the loss of customers.
In recent periods, we have focused on enhancing our online banking platform and plan to continue to introduce new technologies,
with the goal of delivering products and services more efficiently with fewer branches and people. We closed five branches
during our last three fiscal years. Three of the branches had been acquired, and the closures involved anticipated synergies that
resulted in significant cost savings. In 2022, we sold five former branch locations and three tracts of land that were being held
for future branch locations. In January 2023, we completed the sale of certain assets, deposits and other liabilities associated with
two of our Texas branches in order to focus more on our core markets. Of the Bank’s entire branch network, these two locations
were geographically the most distant from our Louisiana headquarters. During the third quarter of 2023, we ceased operation of
14 ATMs and in January 2024 we closed a branch in our Alabama market. We could incur material losses in the future due to
the closure or consolidation of branches or sale of land held for future branch locations.
Our business is concentrated in southern Louisiana, southeast Texas, and Alabama, and an economic downturn affecting
these areas may magnify the adverse effects and consequences to us.
We currently conduct our operations primarily in southern Louisiana, and more specifically, in the Baton Rouge, New Orleans,
Lafayette and Lake Charles metropolitan areas, in the greater Houston, Texas area, and in Alabama. As of December 31, 2023,
our primary markets were south Louisiana (approximately 80% of our total deposits of $2.3 billion), southeast Texas
(approximately 5% of our total deposits) and Alabama (approximately 15% of our total deposits). At December 31, 2023,
approximately 60%, 5%, and 5% of the secured loans in our total loan portfolio were secured by properties and other collateral
located in Louisiana, Texas and Alabama, respectively.
This geographic concentration imposes a greater risk to us than to our competitors in the area who maintain significant operations
outside of our selected markets. Accordingly, any regional or local economic downturn, or natural or man-made disaster, that
affects southern Louisiana, southeast Texas, Alabama, or existing or prospective property or borrowers in such areas may affect
us and our profitability more significantly and more adversely than our more geographically diversified competitors.
Much of our business development and marketing strategy is directed toward fulfilling the banking and financial services needs
of small to medium-sized businesses. Such businesses generally have fewer financial resources in terms of capital or borrowing
capacity than larger entities. If economic conditions negatively impact our selected markets and these businesses are adversely
affected, our financial condition and results of operations may be negatively affected.
19
Adverse economic factors affecting particular industries could have a negative effect on our customers and their ability to
make payments to us.
Certain industry-specific economic factors may also adversely affect us. For example, the energy sector, which is historically
cyclical, has experienced significant volatility in oil and gas prices. While we consider our direct exposure to the energy sector
not to be significant, comprising approximately 2.0% of total loans at December 31, 2023, continued oil price volatility could
have further negative impacts on general economic conditions, particularly in our south Louisiana and southeast Texas markets,
which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, and results of operations.
We have a significant number of loans secured by real estate, and a downturn in the real estate market could result in losses
and negatively impact our profitability.
At December 31, 2023, approximately 75% of our total loan portfolio had real estate as a primary or secondary component of
the collateral securing the loan. The real estate provides an alternate source of repayment in the event of a default by the borrower,
but its value may deteriorate during the time the credit is extended. Declines in real estate values in our markets could significantly
impair the value of the particular collateral securing our loans and our ability to sell the collateral upon foreclosure for an amount
necessary to satisfy the borrower’s obligations to us. Furthermore, in a declining real estate market, we often will need to further
increase our allowance for credit losses to address the deterioration in the value of the real estate securing our loans. Any of the
foregoing could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations, and cash flows.
Commercial real estate loans may expose us to greater risks than our other real estate loans.
Our loan portfolio includes commercial real estate loans, which are secured by owner-occupied and nonowner-occupied
commercial properties. As of December 31, 2023, our owner-occupied commercial real estate loans totaled $449.6 million,
or 20.3% of our total loan portfolio and our nonowner-occupied commercial real estate loans totaled $488.1 million, or 22.1% of
our total loan portfolio.
Commercial real estate loans typically depend on the successful operation and management of the businesses that occupy these
properties or the financial stability of tenants occupying the properties. Nonowner-occupied commercial real estate loans
typically are dependent, in large part, on the owner’s ability to rent the property and the ability of the tenants to pay rent, whereas
owner-occupied commercial real estate loans typically are dependent, in large part, on the success of the owner’s business. Cash
flows, which may include proceeds from sales of commercial real estate, may be affected significantly by general economic
conditions. Weak economic conditions may impair the borrower’s business operations and typically slow the execution of new
leases. Such economic conditions may also lead to existing lease turnover. As a result of these factors, vacancy rates for retail,
office and industrial space may increase. High vacancy rates could also result in rents falling. The combination of these factors
could result in deterioration in the fundamentals underlying the commercial real estate market and the deterioration in value of
some of our loans. These loans expose a lender to greater credit risk than loans secured by residential real estate because the
collateral securing these loans typically cannot be liquidated as easily as residential real estate. If we foreclose on these loans,
our holding period for the collateral typically is longer than for a 1-4 family residential property because there are fewer potential
purchasers of the collateral. Additionally, nonowner-occupied commercial real estate loans generally involve relatively large
balances to single borrowers or related groups of borrowers. Accordingly, charge-offs on nonowner-occupied commercial real
estate loans may be larger on a per loan basis than those incurred with our residential or consumer loan portfolios. Unexpected
deterioration in the credit quality of our commercial real estate loan portfolio would require us to increase our provision for loan
losses, which would reduce our profitability and could materially adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of
operations, and cash flows.
Commercial and industrial loans may expose us to greater risk than other loans.
Commercial and industrial loans primarily consist of working capital lines of credit and equipment loans, typically secured by
accounts receivable or inventory, or the relevant equipment. Repayment of these loans generally comes from the generation of
cash flow as the result of the borrower’s business operations. Commercial lending generally involves different risks from those
associated with commercial real estate lending or construction lending. Although commercial loans may be collateralized by
business assets (including real estate, if available as collateral), the repayment of these types of loans depends primarily on the
creditworthiness and projected cash flow of the borrower (and any guarantors). Thus, the general business conditions of the local
economy and the borrower’s ability to sell its products and services, thereby generating sufficient operating revenue to repay us
under the agreed upon terms and conditions, are the chief considerations when assessing the risk of a commercial and industrial
loan. The liquidation of collateral, if any, is considered a secondary source of repayment because equipment and other business
assets may, among other things, be obsolete or of limited resale value. Additionally, as of December 31, 2023 52% of our
commercial and industrial loans were variable rate loans; rising interest rates increase interest payments due on such loans and
may increase the risk of default by the borrower.
20
We have been increasing the proportion of commercial and industrial loans in our loan portfolio. Our commercial and industrial
loans represented 16.6%, 20.7% and 24.6% of total loans as of December 31, 2021, 2022 and 2023, respectively. The increase
from year-end 2022 to year-end 2023 was caused primarily by our purchase of commercial and industrial revolving lines of credit
which, at the time of the loan purchase agreement, had an unpaid principal balance of approximately $163 million and total
commitments of approximately $238 million, as described in more detail elsewhere in this report. The acquired loans are to
consumer finance lending companies. The repayment of consumer finance loans depends primarily on the creditworthiness and
projected cash flow of the borrower (and any guarantors). Thus, the primary risks associated with these types of loans are the
general business conditions of the local economy, and the ability to generate sufficient operating revenue to repay us under the
agreed upon terms and conditions. Loans to consumer finance lending companies accounted for approximately 8% of our total
loans at December 31, 2023. The increase from year-end 2021 to year-end 2022 was driven primarily by an increase in public
finance loans and loan production by our Commercial and Industrial Division.
Commercial and industrial loans include public finance loans made to governmental entities, which can be taxable or tax-exempt,
for purposes including debt refinancing, economic development, quality of life projects, short-term cash-flow needs,
and infrastructure enhancements, among other things. Public finance loans generally are repaid using pledged revenue sources
including income tax, property tax, sales tax, and utility revenue, among other sources. Accordingly, repayment depends upon
the financial stability and tax or revenue generating capacity of the particular revenue source. Public finance loans comprise less
than 5% of our loan portfolio as of December 31, 2023.
Loss of our senior executive officers or other key employees and our inability to recruit or retain suitable replacements could
adversely affect our business, results of operations and ability to successfully execute our business strategy.
Our success depends significantly on the continued service and skills of our executive management team. The implementation
of our business strategies also depends significantly on our ability to retain employees with experience and business relationships
within their respective market areas, as well as on our ability to attract, motivate and retain highly qualified senior and middle
management. Competition for employees is intense. We could have difficulty replacing key employees with personnel with the
combination of skills and attributes required to execute our business strategies and who have ties to the communities within our
market areas. The loss of any of our key personnel could therefore have a material adverse effect on our business, financial
condition, results of operations and ability to successfully execute our business strategy.
Hurricanes or other adverse weather conditions, as well as man-made disasters, could negatively affect our local markets or
disrupt our operations, which may adversely affect our business and results of operations.
Our business is concentrated in southern Louisiana, in southeast Texas, and in Alabama. Our selected markets are susceptible to
major hurricanes, floods, tropical storms, tornadoes and other natural disasters and adverse weather, the nature and severity of
which can be difficult to predict. These natural disasters can disrupt our operations, cause widespread property damage, and
severely depress the local economies in which we operate. For example, the historic flooding of Baton Rouge and surrounding
areas in August 2016 had significant impacts in several markets in which we conduct business. Hurricane Harvey caused
significant damage and flooding in Texas when it made landfall in August 2017. Hurricane Ida, which made landfall as a category
4 hurricane in Louisiana in August 2021, caused significant damage in the southern part of the state and also disrupted operations
for certain of our customers. We recognized a material impairment related to a lending relationship with a group of related
borrowers (the “Borrower”), collateralized by commercial real estate, inventory, and equipment. As a result of Hurricane Ida,
the Borrower’s business operations were disrupted, and due to this impact on the Borrower’s operations, certain of the collateral
supporting the loan relationship experienced a significant reduction in value. The severity and impact of future severe weather
events are difficult to predict and may be exacerbated by global climate change. The 2010 Deepwater Horizon oil spill in the
Gulf of Mexico illustrated that man-made disasters can also adversely affect economic activity in the markets in which we
operate. Any economic decline as a result of a natural disaster, adverse weather, oil spill or other man-made disaster can reduce
the demand for loans and our other products and services.
Such events could also affect the stability of our deposit base, impair the ability of borrowers to repay outstanding loans (resulting
in increased delinquencies, foreclosures and loan losses), impair the value of collateral securing such loans, cause significant
property damage, result in loss of revenue and/or cause us to incur additional expenses. The occurrence of any such event could,
therefore, result in decreased revenue and loan losses that have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition,
results of operations and ability to successfully execute our business strategy.
21
Climate related events and legislative and societal responses regarding climate change present risks to our business.
Climate change may intensify severe weather events such as hurricanes and rainstorms that recur in our market areas, which may
adversely impact our locations and business and those of our customers and suppliers. In addition, there has been an increased
focus among businesses, consumers and investors regarding transitioning to renewable energy and a net zero economy. If we fail
to adequately anticipate and address these changing preferences, our business could be adversely impacted. We are also subject
to risks relating to potential new climate change-related legislation or regulations, which could increase our and our customers’
costs. The risks associated with these matters are continuing to evolve rapidly and the ultimate impact on our business is difficult
to predict with any certainty.
Our failure to effectively implement new technologies could adversely affect our operations and financial condition.
Our industry is undergoing rapid technological changes with frequent introductions of new technology-driven products and
services, including those using artificial intelligence. Our ability to compete successfully to some extent depends on whether we
can implement new technologies to provide products and services to our customers more efficiently while avoiding significant
operational challenges that increase our costs or delay full implementation, especially relative to our peers, many of which have
greater resources to devote to technological improvements.
We rely on information technology and telecommunications systems, many of which are provided by third-party vendors.
The successful and uninterrupted functioning of our information technology and telecommunications systems is critical to our
business. We outsource many of our major systems, such as data processing and deposit processing. If one of these third-party
service providers terminates their relationship with us or fails to provide services to us for any reason or provides such services
poorly, our business may be materially and adversely affected. In addition, we may be forced to replace such vendors, which
could interrupt our operations and result in a higher cost to us.
Cyberattacks or other security breaches could adversely affect our operations, net income or reputation.
The financial services industry is particularly at risk for cybersecurity concerns because of the proliferation of new and emerging
technologies, and the use of the internet and telecommunications technologies to conduct financial transactions. Additionally,
increased use of internet and mobile banking products, and applications and plans to use or develop additional remote
connectivity solutions increase our cybersecurity risks and exposure. In recent years we have increased our offerings of online
and mobile banking services, including on-line bill payment, on-line funds transfers, mobile deposits, mobile wallets, video
banking and Zelle®. These risks are heightened when customers use near real-time money transfer solutions such as Zelle®,
where fraudulent and scam transactions can be more difficult to detect, prevent and recover. Additionally, as part of our banking
business, we and certain of our third-party vendors collect, use and hold sensitive data concerning individuals and businesses
with whom we have a banking relationship. Threats to data security, including unauthorized access and cyberattacks, rapidly
emerge and change and are becoming increasingly sophisticated, exposing us to additional costs to secure our data in accordance
with customer expectations and statutory and regulatory requirements. We could also experience a breach by intentional or
negligent conduct on the part of our employees or other internal sources or by merchants using our customers’ debit and credit
cards, software bugs, other technical malfunctions, or other causes. As a result of any of these threats, our computer systems
and/or our customer accounts could become vulnerable to misappropriation of confidential information, account takeover
schemes, ransomware, or cyberfraud. A ransomware attack could potentially shut down our data processing system and prevent
us from accessing critical information. Our systems and those of our third-party vendors may become vulnerable to damage or
disruption due to circumstances beyond our or their control, such as from catastrophic events, power anomalies or outages,
natural disasters, network failures, and viruses and malware. Events may occur that increase our and other companies’
vulnerability with respect to cybersecurity risks, such as a sudden and substantial increase in remote work by employees as
occurred during the early stages of the pandemic or may occur during adverse weather events, and as a result of increased
cyberattacks by foreign actors, including in connection with the wars and violence in Ukraine and Israel and surrounding areas.
A breach of security that results in unauthorized access to our data could result in violations of applicable privacy and other laws
and expose us to disruptions in our daily operations as well as to data loss, litigation, damages, fines and penalties, regulatory
sanctions, customer notification requirements, significant increases in compliance and insurance costs, increases in costs for
measures to minimize and remediate these risks and breaches, loss of confidence in our security measures, and reputational
damage, any of which could individually or in the aggregate have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations,
financial condition, prospects, and shareholder value.
22
We have attempted to address these concerns by backing up our systems as well as retaining qualified third-party vendors to test
and audit our network. However, there can be no guarantees that our efforts and those of our third-party vendors will be successful
in avoiding material problems with our information technology and telecommunications systems. We may not be able to
anticipate all cyber security breaches or implement effective preventative measures against such breaches.
Changes in deposit mix have increased our funding costs, which could continue, and loss of deposits could also increase our
funding costs.
Deposits have historically been a low cost and stable source of funding. We compete with banks and other financial institutions
for deposits. Funding costs could increase if the Company loses deposits and replaces them with more expensive sources of
funding, if customers shift their deposits into higher cost products, or if the Company needs to raise its interest rates to avoid
losing deposits. Higher funding costs reduce the Company’s net interest margin, net interest income and net income. As interest
rates began to rise significantly during 2022, competition for deposits increased, and the Bank raised rates it offered on deposits
to remain competitive in its markets. During 2023, as interest rates continued to rise and remain high, customers continued to
shift into interest-bearing deposit products and we also utilized brokered time deposits, which increased our total costs of deposits
by 207 basis points from 2022 to 2023. Disruptions in the banking industry during the first half of 2023 discussed elsewhere in
this report highlighted the speed at which deposits can be moved from bank to bank or outside the banking system, heightening
liquidity concerns of traditional banks. Any further increases in interest rates, sustained high interest rates or any new events
producing concerns among customers about the safety of uninsured deposits could further increase our cost of deposits or cause
us to lose deposits, which would increase our costs of funds and reduce net income.
We may need to raise additional capital in the future to execute our long-term business strategy or to comply with regulatory
requirements.
In addition to the liquidity that we require to conduct our day-to-day operations, the Company, on a consolidated basis, and the
Bank, on a stand-alone basis, must meet regulatory requirements. Also, we may need capital to finance our long-term growth,
including through acquisitions. For example, in 2019, we sold $25.0 million of subordinated notes structured to qualify as Tier
2 capital, and $30.0 million of common stock, in part to fund acquisitions. If the Bank’s regulators deemed its capital levels to
be too low for safety and soundness reasons or if the Bank were to be designated as “undercapitalized” or in a lower capitalization
category than “undercapitalized,” it could be required to raise additional capital. For additional information, see Item 1. Business
- Regulatory Capital Requirements - Prompt Corrective Action Regulations.
Our ability to raise additional capital depends on conditions in the capital markets, economic conditions and a number of other
factors, including investor perceptions regarding the banking industry, market conditions and governmental activities, and on our
financial condition and performance. Rising interest rates as experienced during 2022 and 2023 increased our costs of short-term
borrowings and long-term debt. Further increases in interest rates would increase the costs of our variable rate borrowings. There
can be no assurances that we will be able to raise additional capital if needed or on terms acceptable to us. If we fail to maintain
capital to meet regulatory requirements, our business, financial condition, results of operations and long-term growth prospects
could be materially and adversely affected.
Competition in our industry is intense, which could adversely affect our profitability and long-term growth.
We face substantial competition in all areas of our operations from a variety of different competitors, many of which are larger
and have substantially greater resources than we have, including higher total assets and capitalization, a more extensive and
established branch network, greater access to capital markets and a broader offering of financial services. Such competitors
primarily include national, regional and community banks within the various markets in which we operate. Because of their scale,
many of these competitors can be more aggressive than we can on loan and deposit pricing. We also face competition from many
other types of financial institutions, including savings and loans, credit unions, finance companies, brokerage firms, insurance
companies, factoring companies and other financial intermediaries. Many of these entities have fewer regulatory constraints and
may have lower cost structures than we do. There has been an increasing trend of credit unions acquiring banks. Credit unions
are tax-exempt entities which provides an advantage when pricing loans and deposits. The acquisition of banks by credit unions
may increase competition for customers and acquisitions.
Our industry could become even more competitive as a result of legislative and regulatory changes, as well as continued
consolidation. Finally, technology has lowered barriers to entry and made it possible for non-banks to offer products and services
traditionally provided by banks, such as automatic transfer and automatic payment systems, including Venmo and PayPal, and
such as bitcoin and other types of cryptocurrencies. The process of eliminating banks as intermediaries, known as
“disintermediation,” could result in the loss of fee income, as well as the loss of customer deposits and related income from those
deposits. Disintermediation can also impact our lending business because of the growth of fintech companies delivering lending
and other financial services. We may also lose employees to these competitors. Our ability to compete successfully depends on
23
a number of factors, including customer convenience, quality of service, personal contacts, pricing and range of products. If we
are unable to successfully compete, our business, financial condition, and results of operations will be materially adversely
affected.
If the goodwill that we record in connection with a business acquisition becomes impaired, it could require charges to
earnings, which would have a negative impact on our financial condition and results of operations.
Goodwill represents the amount by which the cost of an acquisition exceeded the fair value of net assets we acquired in connection
with the purchase of another financial institution. We review goodwill for impairment at least annually, or more frequently if
events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value of the asset might be impaired.
We determine impairment by comparing the implied fair value of the reporting unit goodwill with the carrying amount of that
goodwill. If the carrying amount of the reporting unit goodwill exceeds the implied fair value of that goodwill, an impairment
loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess. Any such adjustments are reflected in our results of operations in the periods
in which they become known. As of December 31, 2023, our goodwill totaled $40.1 million. While we have not recorded any
such impairment charges since we initially recorded the goodwill, there can be no assurance that our future evaluations of
goodwill will not result in findings of impairment and related write-downs, which may have a material adverse effect on our
financial condition and results of operations.
The value of the securities in our investment portfolio may decline in the future, and we may incur losses with respect to our
investment securities.
Our investment securities portfolio may be impacted by market conditions beyond our control, including fluctuations in interest
rates, rating agency downgrades of the securities, credit deterioration or default of issuers of the securities, and inactivity or
instability in the credit markets. For example, during 2022, increases in interest rates had a negative effect, particularly on the
value of our available for sale investment securities portfolio, which we carry at fair value on our consolidated balance sheets.
As of December 31, 2023, gross unrealized losses in our investment portfolio, primarily reflected in accumulated other
comprehensive loss on the consolidated balance sheets, totaled $57.7 million. If investment securities in an unrealized loss
position are sold, such losses would become realized, which would adversely affect our results of operations. We evaluate our
investment securities on at least a quarterly basis, and more frequently if economic and market conditions warrant, to determine
whether any decline in fair value below amortized cost is the result of an other-than-temporary impairment. The process for
determining impairment and any credit losses with respect to our investment securities often requires complex, subjective
judgments about the future financial performance. In addition, market volatility may make it difficult to value certain securities.
Subsequent valuations, in light of factors prevailing at that time, may result in significant changes in the values of these securities
in future periods. Any of these factors could require us to recognize losses or impairments in the value of our securities portfolio,
which may have an adverse effect on our results of operations in future periods.
We face significant fraud, operational and other risks related to our activities, which could expose us to negative publicity,
litigation and/or regulatory action.
We are exposed to many types of operational risks, including, particularly as a financial institution, fraud risks and human error.
Our fraud risks include fraud committed by external parties against the Company or our customers, fraud committed internally
by our associates and fraud committed by customers. Certain fraud risks, including identity theft and account takeover, may
increase as a result of customers’ accounts or personally identifiable information being obtained through breaches of retailers’
or other third parties’ networks. Fraud attacks against us and other companies in the financial services industry, and against our
customers when engaged in financial transactions, have increased in recent years and have become more sophisticated and more
difficult to detect. We expect that detecting and preventing fraud, and remediating losses caused by fraud, will continue to require
ongoing and potentially increased attention and investment. There are inherent limitations to our risk management strategies, as
there may exist, or develop in the future, risks that we have not appropriately anticipated, monitored or identified. If our risk
management framework proves ineffective, we could suffer unexpected losses, we may have to expend resources detecting and
correcting the failure in our systems and we may be subject to potential claims from third parties and government agencies. We
may also suffer severe reputational damage. Any of these consequences could materially and adversely affect our business,
financial condition or results of operations.
Because the nature of the financial services industry involves a high volume of transactions, certain systems or human errors
may be repeated or compounded before they are discovered and successfully rectified. The Company’s necessary dependence
upon automated systems to record and process our transaction volume may further increase the risk that technical flaws or
associate tampering or manipulation of those systems will result in losses that are difficult to detect. The Company is further
exposed to the risk that our third-party vendors may be unable to fulfill their contractual obligations or will be subject to the same
risk of fraud or systems or human errors as we are. These risks include the cybersecurity risks discussed above.
24
Risks Related to Our Industry
We operate in a highly regulated environment, which could restrain our growth and profitability.
We are subject to extensive regulation and supervision under federal and state banking laws and regulations that govern almost
all aspects of our operations, including, among other things, our lending practices, deposit-taking practices, capital structure,
investment practices, dividend policy, operations and growth. The level of regulatory scrutiny that we are subject to may fluctuate
over time, based on numerous factors, including as a result of changes in the political administrations. These laws and regulations,
and the supervisory framework that oversees the administration of these laws and regulations, are primarily intended to protect
consumers, depositors, the Deposit Insurance Fund and the banking system as a whole, and not shareholders and counterparties.
Furthermore, new proposals for legislation continue to be introduced in the U.S. Congress that could further substantially increase
regulation of the financial services industry, and impose restrictions on our operations and our ability to conduct business
consistent with historical practices, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of
operations and growth prospects. Our efforts to comply with new laws, regulations and standards typically result in increased
expenses and a diversion of management time and attention. The information under the heading “Supervision and Regulation”
in Item 1. Business, provides more information regarding the regulatory environment in which we and the Bank operate.
Federal regulators periodically examine our business, and we may be required to remediate adverse examination findings.
The financial services industry is subject to intense scrutiny from bank supervisors in the examination process and aggressive
enforcement of regulations on both the federal and state levels. The Federal Reserve and the OCC periodically examine our
business, including our compliance with laws and regulations. If, as a result of an examination, a federal banking agency were
to determine that our financial condition, capital resources, asset quality, earnings prospects, management, liquidity, or other
aspects of any of our operations had become unsatisfactory, or that we were in violation of any law or regulation, it may take a
number of different remedial actions as it deems appropriate. These actions include the power to enjoin “unsafe or unsound”
practices, to require affirmative action to correct any conditions resulting from any violation or practice, to issue an administrative
order that can be judicially enforced, to direct an increase in our capital, to restrict our growth, to assess civil monetary penalties
against our officers or directors, to remove officers and directors and, if it is concluded that such conditions cannot be corrected
or there is an imminent risk of loss to depositors, to terminate our deposit insurance and place us into receivership or
conservatorship. If we become subject to any regulatory actions, it could have a material adverse effect on our business, results
of operations, financial condition and growth prospects. Failure to comply with any applicable regulations and supervisory
expectations related thereto could result in fines, penalties, lawsuits, regulatory sanctions, damage to our reputation or restrictions
on business.
We are subject to numerous laws designed to protect consumers, including the Community Reinvestment Act and fair lending
laws, and failure to comply with these laws could lead to a wide variety of sanctions.
The ECOA, the Fair Housing Act and other fair lending laws and regulations impose nondiscriminatory lending requirements on
financial institutions. The Department of Justice and other federal agencies enforce these laws and regulations, but private parties
may also have the ability to challenge an institution’s performance under fair lending laws in private class action litigation. If an
institution’s performance under the fair lending laws and regulations is found to be deficient, the institution could be subject to
damages and civil money penalties, injunctive relief, restrictions on mergers and acquisitions activity, restrictions on expansion,
and restrictions on entering new business lines, among other sanctions. In addition, the OCC’s assessment of our compliance
with the Community Reinvestment Act (“CRA”) is taken into account when evaluating any application we submit for, among
other things, approval of the acquisition or establishment of a branch or other deposit facility, an office relocation, a merger or
the acquisition of another financial institution. Our failure to satisfy our CRA obligations could, at a minimum, result in the
denial of such applications and limit our growth.
We face a risk of noncompliance and enforcement action with the Bank Secrecy Act and other anti-money laundering statutes
and regulations.
The Bank Secrecy Act, the USA PATRIOT Act of 2001, and other laws and regulations require financial institutions, among
other duties, to institute and maintain an effective anti-money laundering program and file suspicious activity and currency
transaction reports as appropriate. The federal Financial Crimes Enforcement Network is authorized to impose significant civil
money penalties for violations of those requirements and has recently engaged in coordinated enforcement efforts with the
individual federal banking regulators, as well as the U.S. Department of Justice, Drug Enforcement Administration and Internal
Revenue Service. We are also subject to increased scrutiny of compliance with the rules enforced by the Office of Foreign Assets
Control. If our policies, procedures and systems are deemed deficient, we would be subject to liability, including fines and
regulatory actions, which may include restrictions on our ability to pay dividends and the necessity to obtain regulatory approvals
to proceed with certain aspects of our business plan, including our acquisition plans. Failure to maintain and implement adequate
25
programs to combat money laundering and terrorist financing could also have serious reputational consequences for us. Any of
these results could materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and growth prospects.
In addition, bank regulatory agencies consider the effectiveness of a financial institution’s anti-money laundering activities and
other regulatory compliance matters when reviewing bank mergers and bank holding company acquisitions. Accordingly, non-
compliance with the applicable regulations could materially impair the Company’s ability to enter into or complete mergers and
acquisitions.
Our success depends on our ability to respond to the threats and opportunities of fintech innovation.
Fintech developments, such as bitcoin or other types of cryptocurrency and the development of alternative payment systems such
as Venmo and PayPal, have the potential to disrupt the financial industry and change the way banks do business. Our success
depends on our ability to adapt to the pace of the rapidly changing technological environment, which is crucial to retention and
acquisition of customers. On July 31, 2018, the OCC announced it would grant limited-purpose national bank charters to fintech
companies that offer bank products and services. The federal charter would allow fintech companies to operate nationwide under
a single set of national standards, without needing to seek state-by-state licenses or joining with brick-and-mortar banks, which
could have the effect of allowing fintech companies to more easily compete with us for financial products and services in the
communities we serve. At present, the future of the OCC limited-purpose fintech charter is unclear. To date, the OCC has not
approved any such charters and each application for a charter has been met with a lawsuit challenging the OCC’s authority to
issue such charters.
We may be required to pay significantly higher FDIC deposit insurance premiums in the future.
The deposits of Investar Bank are insured by the FDIC up to legal limits and, accordingly, subject it to the payment of FDIC
deposit insurance assessments. We are generally unable to control the amount of premiums that we are required to pay for FDIC
deposit insurance. A bank’s regular assessments are determined by its risk classification, which is based on certain financial
information and the level of supervisory concern that it poses. In order to maintain a strong funding position and restore the
reserve ratios of the Deposit Insurance Fund, the FDIC has, in the past, increased deposit insurance assessment rates and charged
a special assessment to all FDIC-insured financial institutions. While the FDIC’s special assessment in 2023 generally only
applied to banks with over $5 billion in total assets, further increases in assessment rates or special assessments that apply to all
banks may occur in the future, especially if there are significant financial institution failures. Any future special assessments,
increases in assessment rates or required prepayments in FDIC insurance premiums could reduce our profitability or limit our
ability to pursue certain business opportunities, which could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and
results of operations.
Our use of third-party vendors and our other ongoing third-party business relationships are subject to increasing regulatory
requirements and attention.
We regularly use third-party vendors as part of our business. We also have substantial ongoing business relationships with other
third parties. These types of third-party relationships are subject to increasingly demanding regulatory requirements and attention
by our federal bank regulators. Regulation requires us to perform due diligence and ongoing monitoring and control over our
third-party vendors and other ongoing third-party business relationships. In certain cases, we may be required to renegotiate our
agreements with these vendors to meet these requirements, which could increase our costs. We expect that our regulators will
hold us responsible for deficiencies in our oversight and control of our third-party relationships and in the performance of the
parties with which we have these relationships. As a result, if our regulators conclude that we have not exercised adequate
oversight and control over our third-party vendors or other ongoing third-party business relationships or that such third parties
have not performed appropriately, we could be subject to enforcement actions, including civil money penalties or other
administrative or judicial penalties or fines as well as requirements for customer remediation, any of which could have a material
adverse effect our business, financial condition or results of operations.
26
Risks Related to an Investment in our Common Stock
The market price of our common stock may be volatile, which may make it difficult for investors to sell their shares at the
volume, prices and times desired.
The market price of our common stock may fluctuate substantially due to a variety of factors, many of which are beyond our
control, including, without limitation:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
actual, anticipated, or unanticipated variations in our quarterly and annual operating results, financial condition or asset
quality;
changes in general economic or business conditions, both domestically and internationally;
the effects of, and changes in, trade, monetary and fiscal policies, including the interest rate policies of the Federal
Reserve, or in laws and regulations affecting us;
changes in the credit, mortgage and real estate markets;
the number of securities analysts covering us;
our creditworthiness;
publication of research reports about us, our competitors, or the financial services industry generally, or changes in, or
failure to meet, securities analysts’ estimates of our financial and operating performance, or lack of research reports by
industry analysts or ceasing of coverage;
changes in market valuations or earnings of companies that investors deemed comparable to us;
the average daily trading volume of our common stock;
future issuances of our common stock or other securities;
changes in dividends on our common stock;
additions or departures of key personnel;
perceptions in the marketplace regarding our competitors and/or us;
significant acquisitions or business combinations, strategic partnerships, joint ventures or capital commitments by or
involving our competitors or us; and
other news, announcements or disclosures (whether by us or others) related to us, our competitors, our markets or the
financial services industry.
The stock market and, in particular, the market for financial institution stocks have experienced significant fluctuations in recent
years. In addition, significant fluctuations in the trading volume in our common stock may cause significant price variations to
occur. Increased market volatility may materially and adversely affect the market price of our common stock, which may make
it difficult for investors to sell their shares at the volume, prices and times desired.
Shares eligible for future sale and shares we may issue in the future could adversely affect market prices of our common
stock.
Shares of our common stock eligible for future sale, including those that may be issued in any private or public offering of our
common stock, as consideration in acquisition transactions, or as incentives under incentive plans, could adversely affect market
prices for our common stock. As of December 31, 2023, we had 9,748,067 shares outstanding and 326,605 shares subject to
options granted under our incentive plan. Because our outstanding shares of common stock either were issued in an offering
registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”) or have been held for more than one year, such
shares are freely tradable, except for shares held by our affiliates (approximately 6% of shares outstanding as of December 31,
2023) and 336,749 shares that represent unvested restricted shares under our incentive plan. Shares issued under our incentive
plan will be available for sale into the public market, except for shares held by our affiliates. Shares held by our affiliates may
be resold subject to the restrictions in Rule 144 of the Securities Act. In the future, we may issue additional shares of common
stock to raise capital for growth or as consideration in acquisition transactions or for other purposes, and such shares may be
registered under the Securities Act and freely tradable or may be issued in a private placement and registered for resale under the
Securities Act.
27
Our dividend policy may change without notice, and our future ability to pay dividends is subject to restrictions.
Holders of our common stock are entitled to receive only such cash dividends as our board of directors may declare out of funds
legally available for the payment of dividends. We have no obligation to continue paying dividends, and we may change our
dividend policy at any time without notice to our shareholders. In addition, our existing and future debt agreements limit, or may
limit, our ability to pay dividends. Under the terms of our 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 2029, we may
not pay a dividend if either our parent company or the Bank, both immediately prior to the declaration of the dividend and after
giving effect to the payment of the dividend, would not maintain regulatory capital ratios that are as “well capitalized” levels for
regulatory capital purposes. We are also prohibited from paying dividends upon and during the continuance of any Event of
Default under such notes. Under the terms of our 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 2032, we are prohibited
from paying dividends upon and during the continuance of any Event of Default under such notes. Our ability to pay dividends
may be limited on account of the junior subordinated debentures that we assumed through acquisitions. We must make payments
on the junior subordinated debentures before any dividends can be paid on our common stock.
Since the Company’s primary asset is its stock of Investar Bank, we are dependent upon dividends from the Bank to pay our
operating expenses, satisfy our obligations and to pay dividends on the Company’s common stock. Accordingly, any declaration
and payment of dividends on common stock will substantially depend upon the Bank’s earnings and financial condition, liquidity
and capital requirements, the general economic and regulatory climate and other factors deemed relevant by our board of
directors. Furthermore, consistent with our strategic plans, capital availability, projected liquidity needs, and other factors, we
have made, and will continue to make, capital management decisions and policies that could adversely impact the amount of
dividends, if any, paid to our common shareholders.
In addition, there are numerous laws and banking regulations that limit our and Investar Bank’s ability to pay
dividends. For further discussion of the regulatory restrictions on our ability to pay dividends, see Item 1. Business – Supervision
and Regulation – Dividends.
Our Restated Articles of Incorporation and By-laws, and certain banking laws applicable to us, could have an anti-takeover
effect that decreases our chances of being acquired, even if our acquisition is in our shareholders’ best interests.
Certain provisions of our restated articles of incorporation and our by-laws, as amended, and federal banking laws, including
regulatory approval requirements, could make it more difficult for a third party to acquire control of our organization or conduct
a proxy contest, even if those events were perceived by many of our shareholders as beneficial to their interests. These provisions,
and the corporate and banking laws and regulations applicable to us:
•
•
•
•
•
enable our board of directors to issue additional shares of authorized, but unissued capital stock. In particular, our board
may issue “blank check” preferred stock with such designations, rights and preferences as may be determined from
time to time by the board;
enable our board of directors to increase the size of the board and fill the vacancies created by the increase;
enable our board of directors to amend our by-laws without shareholder approval;
require advance notice for director nominations and other shareholder proposals; and
require prior regulatory application and approval of any transaction involving control of our organization.
These provisions may discourage potential acquisition proposals and could delay or prevent a change in control, including
circumstances in which our shareholders might otherwise receive a premium over the market price of our shares.
Our issuance of preferred stock could adversely affect holders of our common stock and discourage a takeover.
Our shareholders authorized our board of directors to issue up to 5,000,000 shares of preferred stock without any further action
on the part of our shareholders. The board also has the power, without shareholder approval, to set the terms of any series of
preferred stock that may be issued, including voting rights, dividend rights, preferences over our common stock with respect to
dividends or in the event of a dissolution, liquidation or winding up and other terms. In the event that we issue preferred stock in
the future that has preference over our common stock with respect to payment of dividends or upon our liquidation, dissolution
or winding up, or if we issue preferred stock with voting rights that dilute the voting power of our common stock, the rights of
the holders of our common stock or the market price of our common stock could be adversely affected. In addition, the ability of
our board of directors to issue shares of preferred stock without any action on the part of our shareholders may impede a takeover
of us and prevent a transaction perceived to be favorable to our shareholders.
28
An investment in our common stock is not an insured deposit and is subject to risk of loss.
Our common stock is not a bank deposit and, therefore, is not insured against loss by the FDIC, any deposit insurance fund or by
any other public or private entity. Investment in our common stock is inherently risky for the reasons described in this “Risk
Factors” section and elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K and is subject to the same market forces that affect the price
of common stock in any company. As a result, an investor may lose some or all of his or her investment in our common stock.
Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments
Not applicable.
Item 1C. Cybersecurity
Risk Management and Strategy
As a financial institution, we believe that the risk of cybersecurity incidents is a significant, increasing, and always evolving risk
for our business. Federal law and regulations require us to maintain a comprehensive written information security program, and
federal banking regulators regularly issue guidance regarding cybersecurity threats intended to enhance our cybersecurity risk
management. Accordingly, we have developed and implemented processes for assessing, identifying and managing material risks
from cybersecurity threats designed to comply with federal law and regulations and protect against cybersecurity threats to our
business. Our program is supported by management and the Company’s Board of Directors (the “Board of Directors”). The
Company maintains an active cyber insurance policy to enhance protections against material data intrusions or loss of
privacy. For an overview of the federal banking laws and regulations that govern our management and oversight of cybersecurity
risks, refer to Item 1. Business – Supervision and Regulation – “Financial Privacy and Cybersecurity Requirements,”
incorporated by reference into this Item 1C.
The Company’s Information Security Program (the “Program”) is comprised of five pillars: the Information Security Policy, the
Enterprise Information Security Risk Assessment, the Incident Response Plan, a formalized Security Awareness Campaign, and
an enterprise monitoring and reporting program.
•
•
•
•
•
the same
The Information Security Policy contains numerous distinct administrative and technical controls that govern data
security for the organization and is based on the National Institute of Standards and Technology (“NIST”)
Cybersecurity Framework. The policy is reviewed and approved by the Board of Directors annually.
impact
The Enterprise Information Security Risk Assessment quantifies risk criteria utilizing
measures, including financial, strategic, operational, and reputational, set forth by the Enterprise Risk Committee. The
risk assessment is reviewed and approved by the Board of Directors annually. The Enterprise Risk Committee includes
members of management from various departments and members of the Board of Directors and oversees the overall
risk management of the Company. The Enterprise Risk Committee meets as often as appropriate to perform its
responsibilities, but no less than once per calendar quarter and reports findings and provides recommendations to
the Board of Directors on a routine basis.
The Incident Response Plan (“IRP”) includes procedures for responding to actual or potential cybersecurity incidents,
including providing timely notice to customers and our bank regulatory agencies when appropriate. The IRP is based
on the NIST Cybersecurity Framework. The plan is tested annually through tabletop exercises.
The Security Awareness Campaign is designed with the goal that employees are educated on policy, threats, and best
practices from onboarding and throughout their tenure at the Company. This effort includes an onboarding training
program, annual attestation and training, and weekly communication designed to help instill in employees a security
mindset through repetition.
The Company maintains an enterprise monitoring and reporting program, which identifies key risk indicators for
tracking and identifying trends. The key risk indicators are presented to the Company’s Information Technology
Committee (“IT Committee”) and the Board of Directors on a monthly basis.
29
The Program is monitored each year through various internal and external audits, as well as OCC regulatory exams. Vulnerability
and penetration testing are also conducted at least annually by an independent third party to supplement the vulnerability and
patching program routinely performed by internal staff. Third-party vendors supplement the Company’s internal patching
program as necessary. The Company also utilizes a third-party “SOC as a Service” to monitor extended detection and
response logs and network traffic.
Third-party service provider risk is evaluated prior to and throughout the relationship. Third-party service providers must meet
a minimum set of baseline security standards prior to being onboarded. During onboarding, the third party and the services they
provide are added to the Information Security Risk Assessment, including consideration of inherent risk factors and mitigating
controls. Alternative vendors and the effort to transition between vendors are identified during onboarding as well as in the event
that the selected provider may fail in providing contracted services at any time. After a third party is onboarded, they are subject
to the annual third-party risk management program, specific to their assigned risk criticality. This effort includes the review of
service organization controls reports, business continuity and disaster recovery efforts, insurance certificates, and other
compliance related concerns when applicable.
During the last three years we have not experienced any cybersecurity incidents that have materially affected our Company,
including our business, strategy, results of operations or financial condition. For a discussion of how risks from cybersecurity
threats may be reasonably likely to materially affect us, refer to Item 1A. Risk Factors – Risks Related to our Business – “We
rely on information technology and telecommunications systems, many of which are provided by third-party vendors” and –
“Cyberattacks or other security breaches could adversely affect our operations, net income or reputation,” incorporated by
reference into this Item 1C.
Governance
The Board of Directors is responsible for oversight of risks from cybersecurity threats. Oversight of cybersecurity risk
management is performed primarily by the Board of Directors and the IT Committee. The IT Committee consists of members of
the Board of Directors and key members of management. The IT Committee’s primary purpose is to assist the Board of Directors
in its oversight of technology and innovation strategies, plans and operations related to cybersecurity, data privacy, and third-
party technology risk management. The Chief Information Security Officer (“CISO”) provides monthly information security
reports on cybersecurity programs, policies and controls, key risk indicators and trends including responses to any cybersecurity
events, and efforts to improve security. Annually, the CISO provides security training to the Board of Directors. The CISO also
provides the Board of Directors with an annual Information Security Program Summary Report in compliance with federal
banking guidelines.
The program is managed by the CISO who reports to the Chief Operations Officer and is reviewed by regulators as well as
internal auditors. The Chief Information Officer (“CIO”) and information technology staff support the CISO in cybersecurity
operations as necessary to mitigate risks to the Company's technology infrastructure. The CISO holds two cybersecurity industry
leading certifications (CISSP, CCSP) and has more than 20 years of technology experience. Information technology staff are
generally subject to professional education, experience, and certification requirements, and receive education and mentoring
from the CISO and CIO.
Item 2. Properties
Our main office, which serves as our executive and operations center, is located at 10500 Coursey Boulevard in Baton Rouge,
Louisiana. In addition, we operate 28 full-service branches. Our 20 branches in Louisiana are located in Ascension (1), East
Baton Rouge (3), West Baton Rouge (1), Jefferson (2), Lafayette (2), Livingston (1), Orleans (1), St. Tammany (1), Tangipahoa
(1), East Feliciana (2), West Feliciana (1), Evangeline (3) and Calcasieu (1) Parishes. Our two branches in Texas are located in
Galveston (1) and Harris (1) Counties, and one loan and deposit production office is located in Montgomery County. Our six
branches in Alabama are located in Calhoun (3), Sumter (2), and Tuscaloosa (1) Counties. We also have one stand-alone ITM in
Morgan City, Louisiana.
We own the building, known as Investar Tower, in which our main office is located, and all of our branch offices, with the
exception of two leased branch locations in Louisiana, and two leased branch locations and one loan and deposit production
office in Texas. As lessor, we lease space on the first floor of our main office building to multiple tenants, and we also lease a
portion of one of our branch locations. Each of our owned branch facilities is a stand-alone building with on-site parking and
drive-up access, the majority of which are equipped with an ATM or ITM. We believe that our facilities are in good condition
and are adequate to meet our operating needs for the foreseeable future.
30
We also own a tract of land in each of the following Louisiana parishes: East Baton Rouge Parish; St. Mary Parish; and Ascension
Parish. Each tract of land has been designated as either a future branch or stand-alone ITM location. The timing of the
development of these tracts of land is uncertain.
Item 3. Legal Proceedings
From time to time we are party to ordinary routine litigation matters incidental to the conduct of our business. We are not presently
party to, and none of our property is the subject of, any legal proceedings, the resolution of which we believe would have a
material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations, cash flows, growth prospects or capital levels,
nor were any such proceedings terminated during the fourth quarter of 2023.
Item 4. Mine Safety Disclosures
Not applicable.
31
PART II
Item 5. Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
Market Information
Our common stock is listed on the Nasdaq Global Market (the “Nasdaq”) under the symbol “ISTR.” As of March 4, 2024, there
were approximately 712 holders of record of our common stock including participants in security position listings.
Dividend Policy
The Company has paid a quarterly dividend since 2011 and intends to continue to declare dividends on a quarterly basis. The
declaration of dividends is at the discretion of our board of directors and will depend on our financial performance, future
prospects, regulatory requirements and other factors deemed relevant by the board of directors.
Since we are a holding company with no material business activities, our ability to pay dividends is substantially dependent upon
the ability of Investar Bank to transfer funds to us in the form of dividends, loans and advances. The Bank’s ability to pay
dividends and make other distributions and payments to us depends upon the Bank’s earnings, financial condition, general
economic conditions, compliance with regulatory requirements and other factors. In addition, the Bank’s ability to pay dividends
to us is itself subject to various legal, regulatory and other restrictions. See Item 1. Business – Supervision and Regulation –
Dividends, above for a discussion of the restrictions on dividends under federal banking laws and regulations. In addition, as a
Louisiana corporation, we are subject to certain restrictions on dividends under the Louisiana Business Corporation Act.
Generally, a Louisiana corporation may pay dividends to its shareholders unless, after giving effect to the dividend, either (1) the
corporation would not be able to pay its debts as they come due in the usual course of business or (2) the corporations’ total
assets are less than the sum of its total liabilities and the amount that would be needed, if the corporation were to be dissolved at
the time of the payment of the dividend, to satisfy the preferential rights of shareholders whose preferential rights are superior to
those receiving the dividend. In addition, our existing and future debt agreements limit, or may limit, our ability to pay dividends.
Under the terms of our 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 2029, we may not pay a dividend if either our
parent company or the Bank, both immediately prior to the declaration of the dividend and after giving effect to the payment of
the dividend, would not maintain regulatory capital ratios that are at “well capitalized” levels for regulatory capital purposes. We
are also prohibited from paying dividends upon and during the continuance of any Event of Default under such notes. Under the
terms of our 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 2032, we are prohibited from paying dividends upon and
during the continuance of any Event of Default under such notes. Finally, our ability to pay dividends may be limited on account
of the junior subordinated debentures that we assumed through acquisitions. We must make payments on the junior subordinated
debentures before any dividends can be paid on our common stock.
These restrictions do not, and are not expected in the future to, materially limit the Company’s ability to pay dividends to its
shareholders in an amount consistent with the Company’s history of paying dividends.
32
Stock Performance Graph
The above graph compares the cumulative total shareholder return on the Company’s common stock over a measurement period
beginning at the market close on the last trading day of 2018, with (i) the cumulative total return on the stocks included in the
Russell 3000 Index and (ii) the cumulative total return on the stocks included in the S&P United States SmallCap Banks Index,
which includes banks with market capitalizations of $250 million to $1 billion. The performance graph assumes that the value of
the investment in our common stock, the Russell 3000 Index and the S&P United States SmallCap Banks Index was $100 at
December 31, 2018 and that all dividends were reinvested.
Index
Investar Holding Corporation
Russell 3000
S&P US SmallCap Banks
Investar Holding Corporation
Russell 3000
S&P US SmallCap Banks
Investar Holding Corporation
Russell 3000
S&P US SmallCap Banks
97.72 $
131.02
125.46
96.39 $
118.71
114.88
100.00 $
100.00
100.00
12/31/2018 6/30/2019 12/31/2019 6/30/2020
59.36
$
126.47
85.84
12/31/2020 6/30/2021 12/31/2021 6/30/2022
93.00
$
157.04
133.49
77.51 $
199.03
158.62
12/31/2022 6/30/2023 12/31/2023
65.91
$
202.54
140.55
95.61 $
182.32
144.29
68.61 $
158.39
113.94
92.27 $
160.80
139.85
52.68 $
186.80
108.62
There can be no assurance that our common stock performance will continue in the future with the same or similar trends depicted
in the performance graph above. We will not make or endorse any predictions as to future stock performance.
The information provided under the heading “Stock Performance Graph” shall not be deemed to be “soliciting material” or to
be “filed” with the SEC or subject to its proxy regulations or to the liabilities of Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of
1934, as amended, other than as provided in Item 201 of Regulation S-K. The information provided in this section shall not be
deemed to be incorporated by reference into any filing under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or the Securities Exchange
Act of 1934, as amended.
33
Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities
Not applicable.
Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
(a) Total Number of
Shares (or Units)
Purchased(1)
(b) Average Price
Paid per Share (or
Unit)(2)
(c ) Total Number
of Shares (or Units)
Purchased as Part
of Publicly
Announced Plans or
Programs
(d) Maximum
Number (or
Approximate Dollar
Value) of Shares (or
Units) That May Be
Purchased Under
the Plans or
Programs(3)
22,000 $
9,794
—
31,794 $
10.67
9.89
—
10.43
22,000
9,766
—
31,766
524,032
514,266
514,266
514,266
Period
October 1, 2023 to
October 31, 2023
November 1, 2023 to
November 30, 2023
December 1, 2023 to
December 31, 2023
Includes 28 shares surrendered to cover the payroll taxes due upon the vesting of restricted stock.
(1)
(2) The average price paid per share does not include the effect of excise tax expense incurred on net stock repurchases.
(3) The Company has had a stock repurchase program since 2015. On July 19, 2023, the Company announced that its
board of directors authorized the repurchase of an additional 350,000 shares of the Company’s common stock under
its stock repurchase plan. As of December 31, 2023, the Company had 514,266 shares remaining available under the
program.
Securities Authorized for Issuance under Equity Compensation Plans
Please refer to the information under the heading “Securities Authorized for Issuance under Equity Compensation Plans” in Item
12, Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters, for a discussion of the
securities authorized for issuance under the Company’s equity compensation plans.
Item 6. [Reserved]
34
Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
This section presents management’s perspective on the financial condition and results of operations of Investar Holding
Corporation and its wholly-owned subsidiary, Investar Bank, National Association (the “Bank,” together with Investar Holding
Corporation, the “Company,” “we,” “our,” or “us”). The following discussion and analysis should be read in conjunction with
the Company’s consolidated financial statements and related notes and other supplemental information included herein. Certain
risks, uncertainties and other factors, including those set forth under Item 1A. Risk Factors in Part I, and elsewhere in this Annual
Report on Form 10-K, may cause actual results to differ materially from those projected results discussed in the forward-looking
statement appearing in this discussion and analysis.
CAUTIONARY NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
This annual report on Form 10-K, both in Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations, and elsewhere, contains forward-looking statements within the meaning of Section 27A of the Securities Act and
Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”). These forward-looking statements
include statements relating to our projected growth, anticipated future financial performance, changes in our allowance for credit
losses including due to the adoption of ASU 2016-13, anticipated future credit quality and our potential ability to achieve
performance and strategic goals, as well as statements relating to the anticipated effects of these factors on our business, financial
condition and results of operations. These statements can typically be identified through the use of words or phrases such as
“may,” “should,” “could,” “predict,” “potential,” “believe,” “think,” “will likely result,” “expect,” “continue,” “will,”
“anticipate,” “seek,” “estimate,” “intend,” “plan,” “projection,” “would” and “outlook,” or the negative version of those words
or other comparable words or phrases of a future or forward-looking nature.
Our forward-looking statements contained herein are based on assumptions and estimates that management believes to be
reasonable in light of the information available at this time. However, many of these statements are inherently uncertain and
beyond our control and could be affected by many factors. Factors that could have a material effect on our business, financial
condition, results of operations, cash flows and future growth prospects can be found in Item 1A. Risk Factors. These factors
include, but are not limited to, the following, any one or more of which could materially affect the outcome of future events:
•
the significant risks and uncertainties for our business, results of operations and financial condition, as well as our
regulatory capital and liquidity ratios and other regulatory requirements caused by business and economic conditions
generally and in the financial services industry in particular, whether nationally, regionally or in the markets in which we
operate;
• changes in inflation, interest rates, yield curves and interest rate spread relationships that affect our loan and deposit
pricing;
• our ability to continue to successfully execute the pivot of our near-term strategy from primarily a growth strategy to a
strategy primarily focused on consistent, quality earnings through the optimization of our balance sheet, and our ability to
successfully execute a long-term growth strategy;
• our ability to achieve organic loan and deposit growth, and the composition of that growth;
• a reduction in liquidity, including as a result of a reduction in the amount of deposits we hold or other sources of liquidity,
which may be caused by, among other things, disruptions in the banking industry similar to those that occurred in early
2023 that caused bank depositors to move uninsured deposits to other banks or alternative investments outside the banking
industry;
• our ability to identify and enter into agreements to combine with attractive acquisition partners, finance acquisitions,
complete acquisitions after definitive agreements are entered into, and successfully integrate and grow acquired operations;
• our adoption on January 1, 2023 of ASU 2016-13, and inaccuracy of the assumptions and estimates we make in establishing
reserves for credit losses and other estimates;
• changes in the quality or composition of our loan portfolio, including adverse developments in borrower industries or in
the repayment ability of individual borrowers;
• changes in the quality and composition of, and changes in unrealized losses in, our investment portfolio, including whether
we may have to sell securities before their recovery of amortized cost basis and realize losses;
•
the extent of continuing client demand for the high level of personalized service that is a key element of our banking
approach as well as our ability to execute our strategy generally;
• our dependence on our management team, and our ability to attract and retain qualified personnel;
•
the concentration of our business within our geographic areas of operation in Louisiana, Texas and Alabama;
35
increasing costs of complying with new and potential future regulations;
•
• new or increasing geopolitical tensions, including resulting from wars in Ukraine and Israel and surrounding areas;
•
• concentration of credit exposure;
the emergence or worsening of widespread public health challenges or pandemics including COVID-19;
• any deterioration in asset quality and higher loan charge-offs, and the time and effort necessary to resolve problem assets;
•
fluctuations in the price of oil and natural gas;
• data processing system failures and errors;
•
risks associated with our digital transformation process, including increased risks of cyberattacks and other security
breaches and challenges associated with addressing the increased prevalence of artificial intelligence;
risks of losses resulting from increased fraud attacks against us and others in the financial services industry;
•
• potential impairment of our goodwill and other intangible assets;
• our potential growth, including our entrance or expansion into new markets, and the need for sufficient capital to support
that growth;
•
the impact of litigation and other legal proceedings to which we become subject;
• competitive pressures in the commercial finance, retail banking, mortgage lending and consumer finance industries, as
well as the financial resources of, and products offered by, competitors;
•
the impact of changes in laws and regulations applicable to us, including banking, securities and tax laws and regulations
and accounting standards, as well as changes in the interpretation of such laws and regulations by our regulators;
• changes in the scope and costs of FDIC insurance and other coverages;
• governmental monetary and fiscal policies;
• hurricanes, tropical storms, tropical depressions, floods, winter storms, droughts and other adverse weather events, all of
which have affected our market areas from time to time; other natural disasters; oil spills and other man-made disasters;
acts of terrorism; other international or domestic calamities; acts of God; and other matters beyond our control; and
• other circumstances, many of which are beyond our control.
The foregoing factors should not be construed as exhaustive and should be read together with the other cautionary statements
included herein. If one or more events related to these or other risks or uncertainties materialize, or if our underlying assumptions
prove to be incorrect, actual results may differ materially from what we anticipate. Accordingly, you should not place undue
reliance on any such forward-looking statements.
Any forward-looking statement speaks only as of the date on which it is made, and we do not undertake any obligation to publicly
update or review any forward-looking statement, whether as a result of new information, future developments or otherwise. New
factors emerge from time to time, and it is not possible for us to predict which will arise. In addition, we cannot assess the impact
of each factor on our business or the extent to which any factor, or combination of factors, may cause actual results to differ
materially from those contained in any forward-looking statements. We qualify all of our forward-looking statements by these
cautionary statements.
Overview
Through our wholly-owned subsidiary Investar Bank, National Association, we provide full banking services, excluding trust
services, tailored primarily to meet the needs of individuals, professionals, and small to medium-sized businesses. Our primary
areas of operation are south Louisiana (approximately 80% of our total deposits as of December 31, 2023), including Baton
Rouge, New Orleans, Lafayette, Lake Charles, and their surrounding areas; southeast Texas, primarily Houston and its
surrounding area and Alabama, including York and Oxford and their surrounding areas. As of March 7, 2024, we operated 28
full service branches comprised of 20 full service branches in Louisiana, two full service branches in Texas, and six full service
branches in Alabama. Our Bank commenced operations in 2006 and we completed our initial public offering in July 2014. On
July 1, 2019, the Bank changed from a Louisiana state bank charter to a national bank charter and its name changed to Investar
Bank, National Association.
36
During 2023, we pivoted our near-term strategy from primarily a growth strategy to primarily a focus on consistent, quality
earnings through the optimization of our balance sheet. Our long-term strategy includes organic growth through high quality
loans and growth through acquisitions, including whole-bank acquisitions, strategic branch acquisitions and asset acquisitions.
We have completed seven whole-bank acquisitions since 2011 and regularly review acquisition opportunities. Our most recent
whole bank acquisition was completed in April 2021. During our last three fiscal years, we have not opened any de novo branch
locations; however, in the third quarter of 2023, we converted an existing loan and deposit production office in Tuscaloosa,
Alabama to a cashless branch designed to provide a digital banking experience. During the third and fourth quarters of 2023, we
purchased commercial and industrial revolving lines of credit with an unpaid principal balance of $162.7 million in two tranches.
We have continued to evaluate opportunities to improve our branch network efficiency, leverage our digital initiatives, and
further reduce costs. We closed five branches during our last three fiscal years, and one in Alabama during the first quarter of
2024. Three of the branches had been acquired, and the closures involved anticipated synergies that resulted in significant cost
savings. In 2022, we sold five former branch locations and three tracts of land that were being held for future branch locations.
On January 27, 2023, we completed the sale of certain assets, deposits and other liabilities associated with our Alice, Texas and
Victoria, Texas branch locations to First Community Bank in order to focus more on our core markets. Of the Bank’s entire
branch network, these two locations were geographically the most distant from our Louisiana headquarters. During the third
quarter of 2023, we ceased operation of 14 ATMs.
In an effort to focus more on our core business and optimize profitability, in the third quarter of 2023, we made the strategic
decision to exit the consumer mortgage origination business. Consumer mortgage loan products are typically long-term and
fixed-rate and generally require a higher relative allowance for credit losses than other loan products. Consumer mortgage
volumes have decreased to historical lows due to the combination of rising housing prices and interest rates and constriction of
housing supply. As a result of this decision, we further optimized our workforce and will continue to dedicate resources to our
more profitable business lines. Related severance expense was $0.1 million. Substantially all of the consumer mortgage
portfolio is included in the 1-4 family loan category.
Our principal business is lending to and accepting deposits from individuals and small to medium-sized businesses in our areas
of operation. As a financial holding company operating through one reportable segment, we generate our income principally
from interest on loans and, to a lesser extent, our securities investments, as well as from fees charged in connection with our
various loan and deposit services. Our principal expenses are interest expense on interest-bearing customer deposits and
borrowings, salaries and employee benefits, occupancy costs, data processing and other operating expenses. We measure our
performance through our net interest margin, return on average assets, and return on average equity, among other metrics, while
seeking to maintain appropriate regulatory leverage and risk-based capital ratios.
37
For certain GAAP performance measures, see “Certain Performance Indicators” below. We also monitor changes in our tangible
equity, tangible assets, tangible book value per share, and our efficiency ratio, shown in the section “Certain Performance
Indicators: Non-GAAP Financial Measures” below.
Certain Performance Indicators
(In thousands, except share data)
Financial Information
Total assets
Total stockholders' equity
Net interest income
Net income
Diluted earnings per share
Performance Ratios
Return on average assets
Return on average equity
Net interest margin
Dividend payout ratio
Capital Ratios
Total equity to total assets
Tangible equity to tangible assets(3)
2023(1)
As of and for the years ended December 31,
2021(2)
2020(2)
2022
2019(2)
$ 2,815,155 $ 2,753,807 $ 2,513,203 $ 2,321,181 $ 2,148,916
241,976
64,818
16,839
1.66
226,768
74,520
16,678
1.69
242,598
83,814
8,000
0.76
215,782
89,785
35,709
3.50
243,284
73,534
13,889
1.27
0.60 %
7.63
2.83
23.37
1.37%
15.63
3.67
10.31
0.31%
3.22
3.53
40.26
0.61%
5.77
3.49
19.69
0.85%
8.21
3.51
13.55
8.06 %
6.65
7.84%
6.37
9.65%
8.04
10.48%
9.22
11.26%
9.96
(1) During 2023 we purchased commercial and industrial lines of credit with an unpaid principal balance of $162.7 million.
We also sold certain assets, deposits, and other liabilities associated with two branches in Texas previously acquired
from PlainsCapital Bank.
(2) The following acquisitions are included from the date of each acquisition: On March 1, 2019, the Company acquired
Mainland Bank, by merger with and into the Bank. On November 1, 2019, the Company acquired Bank of York, by
merger with and into the Bank. On February 21, 2020, the Bank acquired two branches from PlainsCapital Bank. On
April 1, 2021, the Company acquired Cheaha Financial Group, Inc. and its wholly-owned subsidiary Cheaha Bank, by
merger with and into the Company and Bank, respectively.
(3) Non-GAAP financial measure. See reconciliation below.
Certain Performance Indicators: Non-GAAP Financial Measures
Our accounting and reporting policies conform to accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, or GAAP, and
the prevailing practices in the banking industry. However, we also evaluate our performance based on certain additional metrics.
The efficiency ratio, tangible book value per share, and the ratio of tangible equity to tangible assets are not financial measures
recognized under GAAP and, therefore, are considered non-GAAP financial measures.
38
Our management, banking regulators, financial analysts and investors use these non-GAAP financial measures to compare the
capital adequacy of banking organizations with significant amounts of preferred equity and/or goodwill or other intangible assets,
which typically stem from the use of the purchase accounting method of accounting for mergers and acquisitions. Tangible
equity, tangible assets, tangible book value per share or related measures should not be considered in isolation or as a substitute
for total stockholders’ equity, total assets, book value per share or any other measure calculated in accordance with GAAP.
Moreover, the manner in which we calculate tangible equity, tangible assets, tangible book value per share and any other related
measures may differ from that of other companies reporting measures with similar names. The following table reconciles, as of
the dates set forth below, stockholders’ equity (on a GAAP basis) to tangible equity and total assets (on a GAAP basis) to tangible
assets and calculates both our tangible book value per share and efficiency ratio (dollars in thousands).
Total stockholders’ equity - GAAP
Adjustments:
Goodwill
Core deposit intangible
Trademark intangible
Tangible equity
$
$
2023
226,768 $
As of and for the years ended December 31,
2021
242,598 $
2022
215,782 $
2020
243,284 $
2019
241,976
40,088
2,132
100
184,448 $
40,088
2,959
100
172,635 $
40,088
3,848
100
198,562 $
28,144
3,988
100
211,052 $
26,132
4,803
100
210,941
Total assets - GAAP
Adjustments:
Goodwill
Core deposit intangible
Trademark intangible
Tangible assets
Total shares outstanding
Book value per share
Effect of adjustments
Tangible book value per share
Total equity to total assets
Effect of adjustments
Tangible equity to tangible assets
Efficiency ratio(1)
Noninterest expense
Net interest income
Noninterest income
Efficiency ratio
$ 2,815,155 $ 2,753,807 $ 2,513,203 $ 2,321,181 $ 2,148,916
40,088
2,132
100
26,132
4,803
100
$ 2,772,835 $ 2,710,660 $ 2,469,167 $ 2,288,949 $ 2,117,881
40,088
2,959
100
28,144
3,988
100
40,088
3,848
100
9,748,067 9,901,847 10,343,494 10,608,869 11,228,775
21.55
$
(2.76)
18.79
11.26%
(1.30)
9.96%
23.45 $
(4.25)
19.20 $
9.65%
(1.61)
8.04%
23.26 $
(4.34 )
18.92 $
8.06 %
(1.41 )
6.65 %
21.79 $
(4.36)
17.43 $
7.84%
(1.47)
6.37%
22.93 $
(3.04)
19.89 $
10.48%
(1.26)
9.22%
$
$
62,630 $
74,520
6,538
77.26 %
60,865 $
89,785
18,350
56.29%
63,062 $
83,814
12,042
65.79%
57,131 $
73,534
12,096
66.72%
48,168
64,818
6,216
67.81%
(1) Calculated as noninterest expense divided by the sum of net interest income (before provision for credit losses) and
noninterest income.
Critical Accounting Estimates
The preparation of our consolidated financial statements in accordance with GAAP requires us to make estimates and judgments
that affect our reported amounts of assets, liabilities, income and expenses and related disclosure of contingent assets and
liabilities. Although independent third parties are often engaged to assist us in the estimation process, management evaluates the
results, challenges assumptions used and considers other factors which could impact these estimates. Actual results may differ
from these estimates under different assumptions or conditions.
For more detailed information about our accounting policies, please refer to Note 1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies.
The following discussion presents our critical accounting estimates, which are those estimates made in accordance with GAAP
that involve a significant level of estimation uncertainty and have had or are reasonably likely to have a material impact on our
financial condition or results of operations. We believe that the judgments, estimates and assumptions that we use in the
preparation of our consolidated financial statements are appropriate.
39
Allowance for Credit Losses. In June 2016, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued a new accounting
standard (Accounting Standards Update “ASU” 2016-13), referred to as the Current Expected Credit Loss (“CECL”) standard,
which became effective for us, as a smaller reporting company, on January 1, 2023. The CECL methodology requires that lifetime
expected credit losses be recorded at the time the financial asset is originated or acquired, and be adjusted each period for changes
in expected lifetime credit losses. The CECL methodology replaces multiple prior impairment models under U.S. GAAP that
generally required that a loss be “incurred” before it was recognized, and represents a significant change from prior U.S.
GAAP. Results for reporting periods beginning prior to January 1, 2023 are presented in accordance with ASU 2016-13 while
prior period amounts continue to be reported in accordance with previously applicable U.S. GAAP.
For reporting periods beginning on and after January 1, 2023, reflecting the adoption of ASU 2016-13:
On January 1, 2023, we adopted Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) Topic 326, “Financial Instruments—Credit
Losses,” commonly referred to as Current Expected Credit Losses (“CECL”), on a modified retrospective basis. The provisions
of this guidance required a material change to the manner in which the Company estimates and reports losses on financial
instruments, including loans and unfunded lending commitments, select investment securities, and other assets carried at
amortized cost.
The allowance is sensitive to external factors including the general health of the economy, as evidenced by changes in interest
rates, gross domestic product, unemployment rates, and changes in real estate demand and values. Management considers these
variables and all other available information when establishing the final level of the allowance. These variables and others have
the ability to result in actual loan losses that differ from the originally estimated amounts. Changes in the factors used by
management to determine the appropriateness of the allowance or the availability of new information could cause the allowance
to be increased or decreased in future periods.
The Company’s management considers available forecasts, current events not captured and our specific portfolio characteristics
and applies weights to the scenario output based on a best estimate of likely outcomes. Changing economic conditions have
introduced enhanced estimation uncertainty in the forecasts used to estimate expected credit loss. Our credit loss models were
built using historical data that may not correlate to existing economic conditions. Such forecasted information is inherently
uncertain, therefore, actual results may differ significantly from management’s estimates.
The quantitative loss rate analysis is supplemented by a review of qualitative factors that considers whether conditions differ
from those existing during the historical periods used in the development of the credit loss models. Such factors include, but are
not limited to, changes in current and expected future economic conditions, changes in the nature and volume of the portfolio,
changes in levels of concentrations, changes in the volume and severity of past due loans, changes in lending policies and
personnel and changes in the competitive and regulatory environment of the banking industry. While quantitative data for these
factors is used where available, there is significant judgment applied in these processes.
For credits that are individually evaluated, a specific allowance is calculated as the shortfall between the credit’s value and the
Bank’s exposure. The loan’s value is measured by either the fair value of the collateral of the loan based on third-party
appraisals if it is collateral dependent, or based on a discounted cash flow methodology. Collateral on impaired loans may include,
but is not limited to, commercial and residential real estate and accounts receivable. Values for impaired credits are highly
subjective and based on information available at the time of valuation and the current resolution strategy. These values are
difficult to assess and have heightened uncertainty resulting from current market conditions. Actual results could differ from
these estimates.
Management considers the appropriateness of these critical assumptions as part of its allowance review and believes the
allowance for credit loss level is appropriate based on information available through the financial statement date. Please refer to
Note 3. Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses, and Note 1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies – Allowance for Credit
Losses and – Accounting Standards Adopted in 2023, for additional discussion.
40
For reporting periods prior to January 1, 2023, prior to the adoption of ASU 2016-13:
The allowance for loan losses was established as losses were estimated through a provision for loan losses charged to earnings.
Through December 31, 2022, the allowance for loan losses was based on the amount that management believed would be
adequate to absorb probable losses inherent in the loan portfolio based on, among other things, evaluations of the collectability
of loans and prior loan loss experience. The evaluations took into consideration such factors as changes in the nature and volume
of the loan portfolio, overall portfolio quality, review of specific problem loans, and current economic conditions that may affect
borrowers’ ability to pay. Another component of the allowance was losses on loans assessed as impaired under FASB Accounting
Standards Codification (“ASC”) Topic 310,“Receivables” (“ASC 310”). The balance of the loans determined to be impaired
under ASC 310 and the related allowance was included in management’s estimation and analysis of the allowance for loan losses.
Allowances for impaired loans were generally determined based on collateral values or the present value of estimated cash flows.
The determination of the appropriate level of the allowance was inherently subjective as it requires estimates that are susceptible
to significant revision as more information became available. We had an established methodology to determine the adequacy of
the allowance for loan losses that assessed the risks and losses inherent in our portfolio and portfolio segments. We have an
internally developed model that required significant judgment to determine the estimation method that fit the credit risk
characteristics of the loans in our portfolio and portfolio segments. Qualitative and environmental factors that may not be directly
reflected in quantitative estimates include: asset quality trends, changes in loan concentrations, new products and process
changes, changes and pressures from competition, changes in lending policies and underwriting practices, trends in the nature
and volume of the loan portfolio, and national and regional economic trends. Changes in these factors were considered in
determining changes in the allowance for loan losses. The impact of these factors on our qualitative assessment of the allowance
for loan losses could change from period to period based on management’s assessment of the extent to which these factors were
already reflected in historic loss rates. The uncertainty inherent in the estimation process was also considered in evaluating the
allowance for loan losses.
Acquisition Accounting. We account for our acquisitions under ASC Topic 805,“Business Combinations” (“ASC 805”), which
requires the use of the purchase method of accounting. All identifiable assets acquired, including loans, are recorded at fair value
(which is discussed below). The excess purchase price over the fair value of net assets acquired is recorded as goodwill. If the
fair value of the net assets acquired exceeds the purchase price, a bargain purchase gain is recognized.
For reporting periods beginning on and after January 1, 2023, reflecting the adoption of ASU 2016-13:
ASU 2016-13 amended the accounting model for purchased financial assets and replaced the guidance for purchased credit
impaired (“PCI”) financial assets with the concept of purchased credit deteriorated (“PCD”) assets. For PCD assets, the CECL
estimate is recognized through the allowance for credit losses with an offset to the amortized cost basis of the PCD asset at the
date of acquisition. Subsequent changes in the allowance for credit losses for PCD assets are recognized through a provision for
credit losses on loans. We used the prospective transition approach for PCD loans that were previously classified as PCI and
accounted for under ASC 310-30, “Loans and Debt Securities Acquired with Deteriorated Credit Quality” (“ASC 310-30”).
As permitted under ASU 2016-13, the Company did not reassess whether PCI assets met the criteria of PCD assets as of the date
of adoption.
Please refer to Note 1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies – Acquisition Accounting and – Accounting Standards
Adopted in 2023, for additional discussion.
For reporting periods prior to January 1, 2023, prior to the adoption of ASU 2016-13:
Because the fair value measurements incorporated assumptions regarding credit risk, no allowance for loan losses related to
acquired loans was recorded on the acquisition date. The fair value measurements of acquired loans were based on estimates
related to expected prepayments and the amount and timing of undiscounted expected principal, interest and other cash flows.
The fair value adjustment was amortized over the life of the loan using the effective interest method.
Through December 31, 2022, we accounted for acquired impaired loans under ASC Topic 310-30. An acquired loan was
considered impaired when there was evidence of credit deterioration since origination and it was probable at the date of
acquisition that we would be unable to collect all contractually required payments. ASC 310-30 prohibited the carryover of an
allowance for loan losses for acquired impaired loans. Over the life of the acquired loans, we continually estimated the cash
flows expected to be collected on individual loans or on pools of loans sharing common risk characteristics. As of the end of
each fiscal quarter, we evaluated the present value of the acquired loans using the effective interest rates. For any increases in
cash flows expected to be collected, we adjusted the amount of accretable yield recognized on a prospective basis over the loan’s
or pool’s remaining life, while we recognized a provision for loan loss in the consolidated statement of operations if the cash
flows expected to be collected had decreased.
41
Overview of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
Net income for the year ended December 31, 2023 totaled $16.7 million, or $1.69 per diluted share, compared to $35.7 million,
or $3.50 per diluted share, for the year ended December 31, 2022. This represents a $19.0 million, or a 53.3%, decrease in net
income.
Net income decreased primarily due to a $15.3 million decrease in net interest income and an $11.8 million decrease in
noninterest income, partially offset by a $2.0 million negative provision for credit losses in 2023 compared to a provision for
credit losses of $2.9 million in 2022. The decrease in net interest income was a result of a $43.9 million increase in interest
expense partially offset by a $28.6 million increase in interest income, as the Bank experienced margin compression due to rising
market interest rates. The decrease in noninterest income is mainly attributable to $8.1 million of swap termination fees and $1.4
million of income from insurance proceeds recorded during the year ended December 31, 2022 and the loss on sale or disposition
of fixed assets of $1.3 million during the year ended December 31, 2023, primarily resulting from the sale of the Alice and
Victoria, Texas branches, compared to a loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets of $0.3 million for the year ended December
31, 2022. The negative provision for credit losses of $2.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2023 was primarily due to net
recoveries of $2.3 million in 2023. At December 31, 2023, the Company and the Bank each were in compliance with all
regulatory capital requirements, and the Bank was considered “well-capitalized” under prompt corrective action regulations.
Additional key components of the Company’s performance during the year ended December 31, 2023 are summarized below.
•
Credit quality metrics improved as nonperforming loans were 0.26% of total loans at December 31, 2023 compared
to 0.54% at December 31, 2022.
• We recognized net recoveries of $2.3 million in the loan portfolio during the year ended December 31, 2023 primarily
attributable to recoveries on one loan relationship that became impaired in the third quarter of 2021 as a result of
Hurricane Ida.
• We recognized interest recoveries of $1.5 million during the year ended December 31, 2023, $1.1 million of which are
attributable to one commercial and industrial oil and gas loan relationship.
•
•
Total deposits were $2.3 billion at December 31, 2023, an increase of $173.4 million, or 8.3%, compared to deposits
of $2.1 billion at December 31, 2022. Noninterest-bearing deposits decreased $132.0 million, or 22.7%, to
$448.8 million compared to $580.7 million at December 31, 2022. Time deposits and brokered time deposits increased,
and other deposit categories decreased. At December 31, 2023, estimated uninsured deposits represented
approximately 32% of our total deposits.
Total loans increased $105.9 million, or 5.0% to $2.2 billion at December 31, 2023, compared to $2.1 billion at
December 31, 2022. Excluding approximately $13.9 million in loans associated with the Alice and Victoria, Texas
branches sold in January 2023 and approximately $162.7 million in revolving lines of credit purchased during 2023,
total loans decreased $43.0 million, or 2.1%, to $2.05 billion at December 31, 2023, compared to $2.09 billion
at December 31, 2022.
• On January 1, 2023, Investar adopted ASU 2016-13. Also referred to as the CECL standard, ASU 2016-13 requires the
measurement of all expected credit losses for financial assets held at the reporting date based on historical experience,
current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts. Upon adoption, we recorded a one-time, cumulative effect
adjustment to increase the allowance for credit losses by $5.9 million and reduce retained earnings, net of tax, by $4.3
million. Our allowance for credit losses to total loans was 1.38% at December 31, 2023.
• Net interest income for the year ended December 31, 2023 was $74.5 million, a decrease of $15.3 million, or 17.0%,
compared to $89.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2022, driven primarily by an increase in the rates paid on
interest-bearing liabilities, partially offset by increases in the volume and yield earned on interest-earning assets.
• We experienced pressure on our net interest margin as interest rates rose rapidly during 2022 and 2023, and we raised
rates offered on deposits and incurred higher costs on our borrowings. For the year ended December 31, 2023 our net
interest margin was 2.83%, compared to 3.67% for the year ended December 31, 2022
•
Return on average assets decreased to 0.60% for the year ended December 31, 2023, compared to 1.37% for the year
ended December 31, 2022. Return on average equity was 7.63% for the year ended December 31, 2023 compared
to 15.63% for the year ended December 31, 2022.
42
• We repurchased 222,448 shares of our common stock at an average price of $13.47 per share during 2023 and
repurchased 518,978 shares of our common stock at an average price of $20.27 per share during 2022. We increased
dividends by 8% to $0.395 per share for 2023 from $0.365 per share for 2022.
•
Stockholders’ equity increased 5.1% to $226.8 million at December 31, 2023, compared to December 31, 2022, due to
net income for 2023 and a decrease in accumulated other comprehensive loss due to an increase in the fair value of the
Bank’s AFS securities portfolio, partially offset by the cumulative effect adjustment as a result of the adoption of ASU
2016-13 reflected in retained earnings.
Certain Events That Affect Year-over-Year Comparability
Rising Inflation and Interest Rates. During the entirety of 2021, the federal funds target rate was 0% to 0.25%, and it remained
at that rate until March 2022. Inflation increased rapidly during 2021 through June 2022. Since June 2022, the rate of inflation
generally has declined; however, it has remained at high levels compared to recent historical periods. In response, the Federal
Reserve raised the federal funds target rate multiple times from March 2022 through July 2023. Through these incremental
increases to the target rate, the Federal Reserve has raised, on a cumulative basis, the target rate from 0% to 0.25% by 525 basis
points to 5.25% to 5.50%.
Disruptions in the Banking Industry in 2023. Between March 10, 2023 and March 12, 2023, state banking supervisors closed
Silicon Valley Bank (“SVB”) and Signature Bank and named the FDIC as receiver. At the time of closure, they were among the
30 largest U.S. banks. Reports indicated that, among other things, both banks had grown in asset size in recent periods at a faster
rate than their peers, had large proportions of uninsured deposits (approximately 87.5% and 89.7% of total deposits, respectively)
and high unrealized losses on investment securities. SVB’s business strategy focused on serving the technology and venture
capital sectors, and Signature Bank had significant exposure to deposits from the digital asset industry. Prior to their closure,
both banks experienced sudden and rapid deposit withdrawals. These events caused bank deposit customers, particularly those
with uninsured deposits, to become concerned regarding the safety of their deposits, and in some cases caused customers to
withdraw deposits. In response to the disruptions, among other things, the Federal Reserve announced a new Bank Term Funding
Program (“BTFP”) to provide eligible banks with loans of up to one-year maturity backed by collateral pledged at par value. On
April 24, 2023, San Francisco-based First Republic Bank, also among the 30 largest U.S. banks, reported a large deposit outflow
and substantially reduced net income. First Republic Bank also had a large proportion of uninsured deposits (67% as of December
31, 2022). On May 1, 2023, regulators seized First Republic Bank and sold all of its deposits and most of its assets to JPMorgan
Chase Bank.
In response to the disruptions and related publicity, we formed an internal task force that included members of our Asset/Liability
Committee (“ALCO”). The task force met frequently to review our liquidity position and liquidity sources, and oversaw the
Bank’s process to qualify for the BTFP. In addition, we took steps to inform our customers about our financial position, liquidity
and insured deposit products. During the second quarter of 2023, we utilized the BTFP and reduced Federal Home Loan
Bank (“FHLB”) advances. The Bank utilized this source of funding due to its lower rate, the ability to prepay
the obligations without penalty, and as a means to lock in funding. During the fourth quarter of 2023 and again in the first quarter
of 2024, the Bank refinanced its BTFP borrowings with new borrowings under the program due to more favorable rates. In
January 2024, the Federal Reserve announced that it will cease making new loans under the BTFP on March 11, 2024. As
of December 31, 2023, estimated uninsured deposits represented approximately 32% of our total deposits. For additional
information, see “Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition – Deposits, Borrowings, Liquidity and Capital Resources” and
Part I. Item 1A. Risk Factors.
Hurricane Ida. On August 29, 2021, Hurricane Ida hit the Louisiana coast as a category 4 hurricane. Though Hurricane Ida did
not cause significant physical damage to our branch locations, the storm devastated some of our market areas. The Company set
up programs to help employees and customers experiencing financial difficulty as a result of the hurricane, including a deferral
program. Additionally, the Company recorded an impairment charge of $21.6 million in the third quarter of 2021 related to a
lending relationship with related borrowers (collectively, the “Borrower”) consisting of multiple loans secured by various types
of collateral, including real estate, inventory, and equipment. As a result of Hurricane Ida’s impact on the Borrower’s business
operations, some of the collateral securing the loan relationship, including real estate, inventory, and equipment, experienced a
significant reduction in value. Since the third quarter of 2021, as of December 31, 2023, we have recorded net recoveries related
to this loan relationship of $2.5 million, substantially all of which were in 2023.
43
COVID-19 Pandemic. In March 2020, COVID-19 was declared a pandemic by the World Health Organization. Our business
remained open through the pandemic, although it was significantly disrupted in the early stages of the pandemic as we adjusted
to various and changing government and voluntary restrictions on activities. The pandemic generally slowed business lending
activity from the level we would otherwise have expected, particularly in 2020, except for our participation in the Paycheck
Protection Program (“PPP”) under which we made loans to qualified borrowers that under specified conditions were subject to
forgiveness and repayment by the federal government. We began participating in the PPP in the second quarter of 2020 and made
loans totaling $178.0 million, almost all of which had been repaid by the end of 2022. The pandemic and the PPP created excess
liquidity in the market, contributing to increases in our noninterest and interest-bearing demand deposits, and in money market
deposit accounts and savings accounts in 2021. We took actions to protect our customers and employees throughout the
pandemic, including increasing our remote banking and working options. We recorded an increased provision for loan losses
during 2020 as a result of the impact of the pandemic. Market conditions generally improved during 2021 and 2022 compared to
2020, as vaccines became available and government restrictions lessened. The federal government declared an end to the COVID-
19 public health emergency in May 2023.
Acquisitions. On April 1, 2021, the Company completed its acquisition of Cheaha Financial Group, Inc. (“Cheaha”) and its
wholly-owned subsidiary, Cheaha Bank, an Alabama state bank headquartered in Oxford, Alabama that served the residents of
Calhoun Country, Alabama through four branch locations. All of the issued and outstanding shares of Cheaha were converted
into aggregate cash merger consideration of $41.1 million. On the date of the acquisition, Cheaha had total assets with a fair
value of $240.8 million, including $120.4 million in loans, and we assumed $207.0 million in deposits. The Company recorded
a core deposit intangible and goodwill of $0.8 million and $11.9 million, respectively, related to the acquisition of Cheaha.
Adoption of ASU 2016-13. As discussed throughout this report, we adopted ASU 2016-13 on January 1, 2023, and recorded a
one-time, cumulative effect adjustment that increased the allowance for credit losses by $5.9 million and decreased retained
earnings, net of tax, by $4.3 million.
Loan Purchase Agreement. In August 2023, we entered into a loan purchase agreement to acquire commercial and industrial
revolving lines of credit, and related accrued interest, with an unpaid principal balance of $162.7 million and total commitments
of $237.8 million in two tranches. The first and second tranches consist of unpaid principal balances of $35.8 million and $127.0
million, respectively, and total commitments of $61.1 million and $176.7 million, respectively. The purchase of the first tranche
was completed on September 15, 2023, and the purchase of the second tranche was completed on October 3, 2023. The revolving
lines of credit are variable-rate and shorter-term in nature with varying renewal terms. The loans are to consumer finance lending
companies that possess a history of high credit quality and that we believe provide us with opportunities to deepen the
relationships through our services such as treasury management. We also hired two individuals with significant experience in
lending in this area.
Sale of Two Branches to First Community Bank. On January 27, 2023, we completed the sale of certain assets, deposits and
other liabilities associated with the Alice and Victoria, Texas locations to First Community Bank, a Texas state bank located in
Corpus Christi, Texas. We sold approximately $13.9 million in loans and $14.5 million in deposits.
Exit from Consumer Mortgage Origination Business. In the third quarter of 2023, we made the strategic decision to exit the
consumer mortgage origination business. For additional discussion, see “Overview.”
Branch Closures. We closed one branch location in Prairieville, Louisiana in April 2021 and one branch location in Dickinson,
Texas in October 2021. We closed one branch location in Baton Rouge, Louisiana and one branch location in Westlake,
Louisiana in May 2022. We closed one branch location in Central, Louisiana in March 2023. We sold the land and buildings
relating to five locations during 2022. During 2022, we also sold three tracts of land that were held for future branch locations.
In the first quarter of 2024, we closed one branch in Alabama. We continue to evaluate opportunities to reduce our physical
branch footprint and further improve efficiency through digital initiatives.
Subordinated Debt Issuance and Redemption. In April 2022, we completed a private placement of $20.0 million in aggregate
principal amount of our 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Subordinated Notes due 2032 (the “2032 Notes”). In June 2022, we used the
majority of the proceeds to redeem $18.6 million of our 2017 issuance of 6.00% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due
2027 (the “2027 Notes”). We utilized the remaining proceeds for share repurchases and for general corporate purposes.
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition
Total assets were $2.82 billion at December 31, 2023, an increase of $61.3 million, or 2.2%, compared to total assets
of $2.75 billion at December 31, 2022. The growth experienced since December 31, 2022 can mainly be attributed to growth in
loans of $105.9 million primarily due to the purchase of commercial and industrial revolving lines of credit, partially offset by a
decrease of $43.2 million in the available for sale securities portfolio.
44
Loans
General. Loans, constitute our most significant asset, comprising 79% and 76%, of our total assets at December 31, 2023 and
2022, respectively. Loans increased $105.9 million, or 5.0%, to $2.2 billion at December 31, 2023 from $2.1 billion at December
31, 2022. The increase in loans was primarily the result of the purchase of approximately $162.7 million in revolving lines of
credit during 2023 as described in Certain Events that Affect Year-Over-Year Comparability – Loan Purchase Agreement,
partially offset by lower demand and the sale of approximately $13.9 million in loans associated with the sale of the Alice and
Victoria, Texas branches. Given the elevated interest rate environment, we are emphasizing origination of high margin loans that
promote long-term profitability and proactively exiting credit relationships that do not fit this strategy.
The table below sets forth the balance of loans outstanding by loan type as of the dates presented, and the percentage of each
loan type to total loans (dollars in thousands).
Mortgage loans on real estate
Construction and development
1-4 Family
Multifamily
Farmland
Commercial real estate
Owner-occupied
Nonowner-occupied
Commercial and industrial
Consumer
Total loans
December 31,
2023
Percentage
of Total
Loans
Amount
2022
Percentage
of Total
Loans
Amount
$
190,371
413,786
105,946
7,651
449,610
488,098
543,421
11,736
$ 2,210,619
8.6% $
18.7
4.8
0.4
201,633
401,377
81,812
12,877
445,148
20.3
513,095
22.1
435,093
24.6
13,732
0.5
100% $ 2,104,767
9.6%
19.1
3.9
0.6
21.1
24.4
20.7
0.6
100%
At December 31, 2023, the Company’s total business lending portfolio, which consists of loans secured by owner-occupied
commercial real estate properties and commercial and industrial loans, was $993.0 million, an increase of $112.8 million,
or 12.8%, compared to the business lending portfolio of $880.2 million at December 31, 2022. The increase in the business
lending portfolio as of December 31, 2023 is primarily driven by the purchase of commercial and industrial revolving lines of
credit described above, partially offset by lower loan demand due to higher rates. Largely as a result of the loan portfolio
purchase, our variable-rate loans as a percentage of total loans increased to 27% at December 31, 2023 compared to 22% at
December 31, 2022. We continue to focus on a relationship-driven banking strategy and have increased our emphasis on
originating higher margin commercial and industrial and owner-occupied commercial real estate loans.
Nonowner-occupied loans totaled $488.1 million at December 31, 2023, a decrease of $25.0 million, or 4.9% compared
to $513.1 million at December 31, 2022, primarily due to a reclassification of approximately $24.1 million nonowner-occupied
loans to multifamily loans due to a change to the primary use of the property.
As discussed above under “Overview,” during the third quarter of 2023 we exited the consumer mortgage loan origination
business to transition into shorter duration, higher risk-adjusted return asset classes, in an effort to focus more on our core business
and optimize profitability. The consumer mortgage portfolio was approximately $261.6 million at December 31, 2023,
substantially all of which is included in the 1-4 family category. The remaining loans in the category consisted primarily of
second mortgages, home equity loans, home equity lines of credit, and business purpose loans secured by 1-4 family residential
real estate.
Loan Concentrations. Loan concentrations are considered to exist when there are amounts loaned to multiple borrowers engaged
in similar activities that would cause them to be similarly impacted by economic or other conditions. At December 31, 2023 and
December 31, 2022, we had no concentrations of loans exceeding 10% of total loans other than loans in the categories listed in
the table above.
45
The following table sets forth loans outstanding at December 31, 2023, which, based on remaining scheduled repayments of
principal, are due in the periods indicated, as well as the amount of loans with fixed and variable rates in each maturity range.
Loans with balloon payments and longer amortizations are often repriced and extended beyond the initial maturity when credit
conditions remain satisfactory. Demand loans, loans having no stated schedule of repayments and no stated maturity, and
overdrafts are reported below as due in one year or less.
(dollars in thousands)
Mortgage loans on real estate:
Construction and development
1-4 Family
Multifamily
Farmland
Commercial real estate
Owner-occupied
Nonowner-occupied
Commercial and industrial
Consumer
Total loans
Loans with fixed rates:
Mortgage loans on real estate:
Construction and development
1-4 Family
Multifamily
Farmland
Commercial real estate
Owner-occupied
Nonowner-occupied
Commercial and industrial
Consumer
Total loans with fixed rates $
After One
Year
Through
Five Years
After Five
Years
Through
Ten Years
After Ten
Years
Through
Fifteen
Years
One Year
or Less
After
Fifteen
Years
Total
$
104,701 $
51,591
5,386
1,496
51,251 $
85,021
82,147
4,552
17,390 $
38,047
16,780
1,603
9,106 $
21,224
522
—
7,923 $
217,903
1,111
—
190,371
413,786
105,946
7,651
$
$
35,807
34,408
300,972
2,794
537,155 $
100,426
250,717
84,165
7,558
665,837 $
196,837
161,603
91,887
910
525,057 $
107,946
41,159
64,944
384
245,285 $
8,594
211
1,453
90
449,610
488,098
543,421
11,736
237,285 $ 2,210,619
13,752 $
13,875
3,786
592
50,801 $
79,989
79,151
3,994
17,390 $
38,047
6,472
1,603
9,106 $
21,224
522
—
7,923 $
217,903
1,111
—
98,972
371,038
91,042
6,189
16,882
30,242
28,637
2,108
109,874 $
96,894
226,060
73,257
7,558
617,704 $
159,033
137,006
91,887
910
452,348 $
88,321
23,408
64,944
384
207,909 $
2,136
211
1,453
90
363,266
416,927
260,178
11,050
230,827 $ 1,618,662
Loans with variable rates:
Mortgage loans on real estate:
Construction and development
1-4 Family
Multifamily
Farmland
Commercial real estate
Owner-occupied
Nonowner-occupied
Commercial and industrial
Consumer
Total loans with variable
$
90,949 $
37,716
1,600
904
450 $
5,032
2,996
558
18,925
4,166
272,335
686
3,532
24,657
10,908
—
— $
—
10,308
—
37,804
24,597
—
—
— $
—
—
—
— $
—
—
—
91,399
42,748
14,904
1,462
19,625
17,751
—
—
6,458
—
—
—
86,344
71,171
283,243
686
rates
$
427,281 $
48,133 $
72,709 $
37,376 $
6,458 $
591,957
46
Investment Securities
We purchase investment securities primarily to provide a source for meeting liquidity needs, with return on investment as a
secondary consideration. We also use investment securities as collateral for certain deposits and other types of borrowings.
Investment securities represented 14% of our total assets and totaled $382.4 million at December 31, 2023, a decrease of $31.1
million, or 7.5%, from $413.5 million at December 31, 2022. The decrease in investment securities at December 31, 2023
compared to December 31, 2022 was driven primarily by a $20.3 million decrease in residential mortgage-backed securities, a
$9.8 million decrease in obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agencies and corporations, and an $8.4 million
decrease in commercial mortgage-backed securities, partially offset by an $11.0 million increase in obligations of state and
political subdivisions. Due in large part to higher interest rates and market volatility, net unrealized losses in our investment
portfolio totaled $57.3 million at December 31, 2023 and $62.1 million at December 31, 2022.
The table below shows the carrying value of our investment securities portfolio by investment type and the percentage that such
investment type comprises of our entire portfolio as of the dates indicated (dollars in thousands).
Obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agencies
and corporations
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
Corporate bonds
Residential mortgage-backed securities
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
Total investment securities
December 31,
2023
2022
Balance
Percentage
of Portfolio Balance
Percentage
of Portfolio
$
$
20,043
34,866
26,356
234,354
66,771
382,390
5.2% $
9.1
6.9
61.3
17.5
100% $
29,805
23,916
29,942
254,618
75,191
413,472
7.2%
5.8
7.2
61.6
18.2
100%
The investment portfolio consists of available for sale (“AFS”) and held to maturity (“HTM”) securities. We do not hold any
investments classified as trading. We classify debt securities as HTM if management has the positive intent and ability to hold
the securities to maturity. HTM securities are stated at amortized cost. Securities not classified as HTM are classified as AFS
and are stated at fair value. At December 31, 2023, AFS securities comprised 95% of our total investment portfolio.
We adopted ASU 2016-13 effective January 1, 2023. Due to the nature of the investments, current market prices, and the current
interest rate environment, we determined that the declines in the fair values of the AFS and HTM securities portfolio were not
attributable to credit losses. Accordingly, there was no adjustment made to the amortized cost basis upon adoption. The carrying
values of our AFS securities are adjusted for unrealized gains or losses not attributable to credit losses as valuation allowances,
and any gains or losses are reported on an after-tax basis as a component of other comprehensive income (loss). For additional
information regarding accounting for our investment securities upon the adoption of ASU 2016-13, see Note 1. Summary of
Significant Accounting Policies – Accounting Standards Adopted in 2023.
During the year ended December 31, 2023, we purchased $14.1 million of HTM securities classified as obligations of state and
political subdivisions. There were no purchases of HTM securities during the year ended December 31, 2022. During the year
ended December 31, 2023, we purchased $107.9 million of AFS investment securities, compared to $181.6 million during the
year ended December 31, 2022. Proceeds from maturities, prepayments and calls of AFS investment securities were $140.7
million in 2023 compared to $60.2 million in 2022, and we sold $15.0 million of AFS investment securities in 2023 compared
to none in 2022.
U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agencies and corporations securities represented 96% and 9% of the AFS securities we
purchased in 2023 and 2022, respectively. We utilized excess funds in the third quarter of 2023 to purchase $40.0 million in
obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agencies and corporations, which matured in October 2023. Mortgage-
backed securities represented 4% and 84% of the AFS securities we purchased in 2023 and 2022, respectively. We did not
purchase any other investment type in 2023. Of the remaining AFS securities purchased in 2022, 5% were corporate bonds and
2% were municipal securities. We only purchase corporate bonds that are investment grade securities issued by seasoned
corporations.
47
The table below sets forth the stated maturities and weighted average yields of our investment debt securities based on the
amortized cost of our investment portfolio as of December 31, 2023 (dollars in thousands).
One Year or
Less
After One Year
Through Five
Years
After Five
Years Through
Ten Years
After Ten Years
Amount Yield Amount Yield Amount Yield Amount Yield
Held to maturity:
Obligations of states and political
subdivisions
Residential mortgage-backed securities
Available for sale:
Obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S.
government agencies and corporations
Obligations of states and political
subdivisions
Corporate bonds
Residential mortgage-backed securities
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
$
960 4.90% $ 2,556 5.31% $ 4,647 4.62% $ 10,000 5.82 %
— — 2,309 3.09
— —
— —
605 2.88 9,942 5.44 9,836 6.28
— —
27 2.92 1,412 2.37 9,459 2.57 7,870 2.63
350 3.55 12,439 3.98 14,558 4.38 2,750 2.80
— —
— — 6,692 2.93 268,258 2.24
52 4.00 4,827 4.11 3,089 3.25 67,117 3.62
$ 1,994
$ 31,176
$ 48,281
$358,304
The maturity of mortgage-backed securities reflects scheduled repayments based upon the contractual maturities of the securities.
Weighted average yields on tax-exempt obligations have been computed on a fully tax equivalent basis assuming a federal tax
rate of 21%.
Premises and Equipment
Bank premises and equipment decreased $5.4 million, or 10.9%, to $44.2 million at December 31, 2023 from $49.6 million at
December 31, 2022. The decrease was primarily attributable to the sale of the Alice and Victoria, Texas locations and the closure
of one branch and one stand-alone ATM in Louisiana, which decreased bank premises and equipment by $1.4 million and $1.7
million, respectively. The remaining decrease was primarily attributable to depreciation.
Deferred Tax Asset
At December 31, 2023, the net deferred tax asset was $16.9 million, compared to $16.4 million at December 31, 2022. The
increase in the deferred tax asset at December 31, 2023 compared to December 31, 2022 was primarily driven by the adoption
of ASU 2016-13, partially offset by a decrease in the net unrealized losses of the Bank’s AFS securities portfolio.
The Bank acquired net operating loss carryforwards as a result of acquisitions. At December 31, 2023, we held approximately
$4,000 and $0.3 million in net operating loss carryforwards that expire in 2033 and 2039, respectively. U.S. tax law imposes
annual limitations under Internal Revenue Code Section 382 on the amount of net operating loss carryforwards that may be used
to offset federal taxable income. Under these laws, we may apply up to approximately $0.6 million to offset our taxable income
each year. In addition to this limitation, our ability to utilize net operating loss carryforwards depends upon the Company
generating taxable income. Given the substantial amount of time before our net operating loss carryforwards begin to expire, we
currently expect to utilize these net operating loss carryforwards in full before their expiration.
48
Deposits
The following table sets forth the composition of our deposits and the percentage of each deposit type to total deposits at
December 31, 2023 and 2022 (dollars in thousands).
December 31,
2023
2022
Noninterest-bearing demand deposits
Interest-bearing demand deposits
Money market deposit accounts
Savings accounts
Brokered time deposits
Time deposits
Total deposits
Percentage
of Total
Deposits Amount
Percentage
of Total
Deposits
27.9%
27.1
10.0
7.5
0.5
27.0
100%
580,741
19.9% $
565,598
21.7
208,596
8.0
155,176
6.1
9,990
11.9
32.4
562,264
100% $ 2,082,365
Amount
$
448,752
489,604
179,366
137,606
269,102
731,297
$ 2,255,727
Total deposits were $2.26 billion at December 31, 2023, an increase of $173.4 million, or 8.3%, from total deposits
of $2.08 billion at December 31, 2022. Time deposits and brokered time deposits increased, and other deposit categories
decreased. The majority of the increase in time deposits at December 31, 2023 compared to December 31, 2022 is due to organic
growth and existing customer funds migrating from other deposit categories as a result of rising interest rates. Brokered time
deposits
at December 31, 2023 from $10.0 million December 31, 2022. We
utilize brokered time deposits, entirely in denominations of less than $250,000, to secure fixed cost funding and reduce short-
term borrowings. We utilized shorter term brokered time deposits, which were laddered in duration to provide flexibility, to fund
a portion of the purchase of commercial and industrial revolving lines of credit in 2023. At December 31, 2023, the balance of
brokered time deposits remained below 10% of total assets, and the remaining weighted average duration was approximately 12
months with a weighted average rate of 5.18%.
to $269.1 million
increased
The Company had no brokered demand deposits at December 31, 2023 and 2022 or at December 31, 2021. Prior to December
31, 2021, the Bank utilized brokered demand deposits to satisfy the borrowings under its interest rate swap agreements due to
more favorable pricing. In the third quarter of 2021, we voluntarily terminated multiple swap agreements, the borrowings for
which matured in October 2021. During 2022, we voluntarily terminated our remaining interest rate swap agreements.
Estimated uninsured deposits were $720.1 million and $701.1 million at December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively. The
estimates are based on the same methodologies and assumptions used for our regulatory reporting requirements. The insured
deposit data for 2023 and 2022 does not reflect an evaluation of all of the account ownership category distinctions that would
determine the availability of deposit insurance to individual accounts based on FDIC regulations.
The following table shows scheduled maturities of time deposits in excess of the FDIC insurance limit of $250,000 at December
31, 2023 and 2022 (dollars in thousands).
Time remaining until maturity:
Three months or less
Over three months through six months
Over six months through twelve months
Over twelve months
Total
Borrowings
December 31,
2023
2022
68,638 $
27,536
77,471
20,793
194,438 $
63,006
13,610
58,672
14,228
149,516
$
$
Total borrowings include securities sold under agreements to repurchase, federal funds purchased, advances from the Federal
Home Loan Bank (“FHLB”), borrowings under the BTFP, subordinated debt issued in 2019 and 2022, and junior subordinated
debentures assumed through acquisitions. We also maintain unsecured lines of credit with First National Bankers Bank
(“FNBB”) and The Independent Bankers Bank (“TIB”) totaling $60.0 million, which are federal funds lines of credit used for
overnight borrowing only. We had no outstanding balances drawn on the unsecured lines of credit at December 31, 2023 or 2022.
49
Our advances from the FHLB were $23.5 million at December 31, 2023, a decrease of $363.5 million from FHLB advances
of $387.0 million at December 31, 2022. FHLB advances are used to fund increased loan and investment activity that is not
funded by deposits or other borrowings. Based on original maturities, at December 31, 2023, all of our $23.5 million of FHLB
advances were long-term, compared to $333.5 million short-term and $53.5 million long-term FHLB advances at December 31,
2022. We utilized federal funds purchased during 2023 and 2022 although none were outstanding at year-end. We
had $8.6 million of securities sold under agreements to repurchase at December 31, 2023 compared to none at December 31,
2022. The carrying value of the subordinated debt was $44.3 million and $44.2 million at December 31, 2023 and December 31,
2022, respectively. Junior subordinated debt of $8.6 million and $8.5 million at December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively,
represents the junior subordinated debentures that we assumed in connection with our acquisitions of Cheaha in 2021, BOJ
Bancshares, Inc. in 2017 (“BOJ”), and First Community Bank in 2013.
On March 12, 2023, the Federal Reserve established the BTFP. The BTFP is a one-year program which provides additional
liquidity through borrowings for a term of up to one year secured by the pledging of certain qualifying securities and other assets
valued at par. Beginning in the second quarter, we utilized the BTFP to secure fixed rate funding for a one-year term and reduce
short-term FHLB advances, which are priced daily. We utilized this source of funding due to its lower rate and the ability to
prepay the obligations without penalty. The rates on the borrowings under the BTFP are fixed for one year from the day each
borrowing is made. During the fourth quarter of 2023 and again in the first quarter of 2024, we refinanced all of our borrowings
under the BTFP with new loans under the BTFP with a one-year term due to more favorable rates. At December 31, 2023,
outstanding borrowings under the BTFP were $212.5 million with a weighted average rate of 4.83%.
Typically, the main source of our short-term borrowings are advances from the FHLB; however, during 2023, our primary source
of short-term borrowings were borrowings under the BTFP due to more favorable rates. The rate charged for advances from the
FHLB is directly tied to the Federal Reserve’s federal funds target rate. As previously discussed, the Federal Reserve raised the
federal funds target rate multiple times in 2022 and 2023. As of December 31, 2023, the federal funds target rate was 5.25% to
5.50%.
The average balances and cost of short-term borrowings for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 are summarized
in the table below (dollars in thousands).
Average Balances
December 31,
2022
2021
2023
Cost of Short-term Borrowings
December 31,
2022
2021
2023
Federal funds purchased, short-term FHLB
advances and other short-term borrowings
Borrowings under BTFP
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase
Total short-term borrowings
$ 124,191 $ 132,703 $
—
131,952
1,489
4,587
$ 260,730 $ 134,192 $
3,242
—
6,081
9,323
4.93%
5.09
0.13
4.93%
3.08%
—
0.15
3.05%
0.20%
—
0.21
0.20%
2032 Notes. On April 6, 2022, we entered into a Subordinated Note Purchase Agreement with certain institutional accredited
investors and qualified institutional buyers (the “Purchasers”) under which we issued $20.0 million in aggregate principal amount
of our 2032 Notes to the Purchasers at a price equal to 100% of the aggregate principal amount of the 2032 Notes. The 2032
Notes were issued under an indenture, dated April 6, 2022 (the “Indenture”), by and among the Company and UMB Bank,
National Association, as trustee.
The 2032 Notes have a stated maturity date of April 15, 2032 and will bear interest at a fixed rate of 5.125% per year from and
including April 6, 2022 to but excluding April 15, 2027 or earlier redemption date. From April 15, 2027 to but excluding the
stated maturity date or earlier redemption date, the 2032 Notes will bear interest a floating rate equal to the then current three-
month term secured overnight financing rate (“SOFR”), plus 277 basis points. As provided in the 2032 Notes, the interest rate on
the 2032 Notes during the applicable floating rate period may be determined based on a rate other than three-month term
SOFR. The 2032 Notes may be redeemed, in whole or in part, on or after April 15, 2027 or, in whole but not in part, under certain
other limited circumstances set forth in the Indenture. Any redemption we made would be at a redemption price equal to 100%
of the principal balance being redeemed, together with any accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption.
Principal and interest on the 2032 Notes are subject to acceleration only in limited circumstances in the case of certain bankruptcy
and insolvency-related events. The 2032 Notes are the unsecured, subordinated obligations of the Company and rank junior in
right of payment to our current and future senior indebtedness and to our obligations to our general creditors. The 2032 Notes are
intended to qualify as Tier 2 capital for regulatory purposes.
50
We used the majority of the net proceeds to redeem our 2027 Notes in June 2022, and utilized the remaining proceeds for share
repurchases and for general corporate purposes.
2029 Notes. On November 12, 2019, the Company issued $25.0 million in aggregate principal amount of its 5.125% Fixed-to-
Floating Rate Subordinated 2029 Notes due 2029 (“2029 Notes”) at 100% of their face amount in a private placement to certain
institutional and other accredited investors. The 2029 Notes have a maturity date of December 30, 2029. From and including the
date of issuance to, but excluding December 30, 2024, the 2029 Notes will bear interest at an initial fixed rate of 5.125% per
annum, payable semi-annually in arrears. From and including December 30, 2024 and thereafter, the 2029 Notes will bear interest
at a floating rate equal to the then-current three-month LIBOR as calculated on each applicable date of determination, or an
alternative rate determined in accordance with the terms of the 2029 Notes if the three-month LIBOR cannot be determined, plus
3.490%, payable quarterly in arrears.
The Company may redeem the 2029 Notes, in whole or in part, on or after December 30, 2024 or, in whole but not in part, under
certain limited circumstances set forth in the 2029 Notes. Any redemption by the Company would be at a redemption price equal
to 100% of the principal balance being redeemed, together with any accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption.
Principal and interest on the 2029 Notes are not subject to acceleration, except upon certain bankruptcy-related events. The 2029
Notes are unsecured, subordinated obligations of the Company and rank junior in right of payment to the Company’s current and
future senior indebtedness and to the Company’s obligations to its general creditors. The 2029 Notes are obligations of the
Company only and are not obligations of, and are not guaranteed by, any of the Company’s subsidiaries. The 2029 Notes are
intended to qualify as Tier 2 capital for regulatory capital purposes.
2027 Notes. On March 24, 2017, the Company issued $18.6 million in aggregate principal amount of its 2027 Notes due March
20, 2027 at 100% of the aggregate principal amount.
From and including the date of issuance, but excluding March 30, 2022, the 2027 Notes bore interest at an initial fixed rate of
6.00% per annum, payable semi-annually. From and including March 30, 2022 and thereafter, the 2027 Notes bore interest at a
floating rate equal to the then-current three-month LIBOR (but not less than zero) as calculated on each applicable date of
determination, plus 3.945%, payable quarterly.
The Company could, beginning with the interest payment date of March 30, 2022, and on any interest payment date thereafter,
redeem the 2027 Notes, in whole or in part, at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the 2027 Notes to be
redeemed plus accrued and unpaid interest to but excluding the date of redemption. The 2027 Notes were intended to qualify as
Tier 2 capital for regulatory capital purposes.
In June 2022, we redeemed the 2027 Notes in full in accordance with their terms at a redemption price equal to 100% of the
outstanding principal balance plus accrued and unpaid interest up to but excluding the June 30, 2022 redemption date
(“Redemption Date”). The aggregate redemption price, excluding accrued interest, totaled $18.6 million. Interest on the 2027
Notes no longer accrued on or after the Redemption Date.
Stockholders’ Equity
Stockholders’ equity was $226.8 million at December 31, 2023, an increase of $11.0 million, or 5.1%, compared to December
31, 2022. The increase in stockholders’ equity is primarily attributable to net income for fiscal year 2023 and a decrease in
accumulated other comprehensive loss due to an increase in the fair value of the Bank’s AFS securities portfolio, partially offset
by the cumulative effect adjustment as a result of the adoption of ASU 2016-13, reflected in retained earnings.
51
Results of Operations
Performance Summary
2023 vs. 2022. For the year ended December 31, 2023, net income was $16.7 million, or $1.69 per basic and diluted common
share, compared to net income of $35.7 million, or $3.54 per basic common share and $3.50 per diluted common share, for the
year ended December 31, 2022. The primary drivers of the decrease in net income are a $15.3 million decrease in net interest
income and an $11.8 million decrease in noninterest income, partially offset by a $2.0 million negative provision for credit losses
in 2023 compared to a provision for credit losses of $2.9 million in 2022. The decrease in net interest income was a result of a
$43.9 million increase in interest expense partially offset by a $28.6 million increase in interest income, as the Bank experienced
margin compression due to rising market interest rates. The decrease in noninterest income is mainly attributable to $8.1 million
of swap termination fees and $1.4 million of income from insurance proceeds recorded during the year ended December 31, 2022
and the loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets of $1.3 million during the year ended December 31, 2023, primarily resulting
from the sale of the Alice and Victoria, Texas branches, compared to a loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets of $0.3 million
for the year ended December 31, 2022. The negative provision for credit losses of $2.0 million for the year ended December 31,
2023 was primarily due to net recoveries of $2.3 million in 2023 primarily attributable to recoveries on one loan relationship that
became impaired in the third quarter of 2021 as a result of Hurricane Ida. Return on average assets decreased to 0.60% for the
year ended December 31, 2023 from 1.37% for the year ended December 31, 2022. Return on average equity was 7.63% for the
year ended December 31, 2023 compared to 15.63% for the year ended December 31, 2022. The decrease in both return on
average assets and return on average equity is mainly attributable to the $19.0 million decrease in net income.
2022 vs. 2021. For the year ended December 31, 2022, net income was $35.7 million, or $3.54 per basic common share and
$3.50 per diluted common share, compared to net income of $8.0 million, or $0.77 per basic common share and $0.76 per diluted
common share, for the year ended December 31, 2021. The primary driver of the increase in net income is related to a decrease
in provision for loan losses due to the $21.6 million impairment charge recorded during the third quarter of 2021 as a result of
Hurricane Ida. As shown on the consolidated statement of income for the year ended December 31, 2022, a provision for loan
losses of $2.9 million was recorded, compared to a provision for loan losses of $22.9 million for the year ended December 31,
2021. We had record annual net income in 2022 primarily as a result of increases in interest income and noninterest income as
well as a decrease in noninterest expense compared to 2021. Return on average assets increased to 1.37% for the year ended
December 31, 2022 from 0.31% for the year ended December 31, 2021. Return on average equity was 15.63% for the year ended
December 31, 2022 compared to 3.22% for the year ended December 31, 2021. The increase in both return on average assets and
return on average equity is mainly attributable to the $27.7 million increase in net income.
Net Interest Income and Net Interest Margin
Net interest income, our principal source of earnings, is the difference between the interest income generated by earning assets
and the total interest cost of the deposits and borrowings obtained to fund those assets. Factors affecting the level of net interest
income include the volume of earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, yields earned on loans and investments and rates
paid on deposits and other borrowings, the level of nonperforming loans, the amount of noninterest-bearing liabilities supporting
earning assets, and the interest rate environment. Net interest margin is the ratio of net interest income to average interest-earning
assets.
The primary factors affecting net interest margin are changes in interest rates, competition, and the shape of the interest rate yield
curve. The Federal Reserve Board sets various benchmark rates, including the federal funds rate, and thereby influences the
general market rates of interest, including the deposit and loan rates offered by financial institutions. On March 3, 2020, the
Federal Reserve lowered the federal funds target rate to 1.00% to 1.25%, which the Federal Reserve stated was in response to
the evolving risks to economic activity posed by the coronavirus. In a measure aimed at lessening the economic impact of
COVID-19, the Federal Reserve reduced the federal funds target rate to 0% to 0.25% on March 16, 2020, where it remained until
March 2022 when the Federal Reserve began increasing the federal funds target rate a total of seven times during 2022 and four
times during 2023 to 5.25% to 5.50% as discussed in Certain Events That Affect Year-over-Year Comparability – Rising Inflation
and Interest Rates.
2023 vs. 2022. Net interest income decreased 17.0% to $74.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2023 from $89.8 million
for the same period in 2022. Net interest margin was 2.83% for the year ended December 31, 2023, a decrease of 84 basis points
from 3.67% for the year ended December 31, 2022. The decrease in net interest income resulted primarily from an increase in
the rates paid on interest-bearing deposits and short-term borrowings partially offset primarily by an increase in the yield earned
on loans. Average time deposits increased $272.2 million primarily due to organic growth and customer funds migrating from
other deposit categories due to higher rates offered, which along with higher rates paid, resulted in a $20.6 million increase in
interest expense compared to the year ended December 31, 2022. Average short-term borrowings increased $126.5 million, as
we utilized advances from the FHLB and borrowings under the BTFP to fund loan growth and investment activity, which along
52
with higher rates paid, resulted in an $8.8 million increase in interest expense compared to the year ended December 31,
2022. Average interest-bearing demand deposits decreased $211.6 million but increases in rates led to a $6.5 million increase in
interest expense compared to the year ended December 31, 2022. Average brokered time deposits were $163.9 million during
the year ended December 31, 2023 compared to $0.1 million during the year ended December 31, 2022, which along with higher
rates paid added $8.2 million to interest expense. Average noninterest-bearing deposits decreased $111.1 million. Average loans
increased $186.0 million primarily due to organic growth and the purchase of commercial and industrial revolving lines of
credit which, in addition to higher loan yields, resulted in a $24.5 million increase in interest income compared to the year ended
December 31, 2022. Our yield on interest-earning assets increased as did our rate paid on interest-bearing liabilities primarily as
a result of the overall increase in prevailing interest rates.
We experienced margin pressure beginning late in 2022, which continued in 2023. We raised rates offered on deposits and
incurred higher costs on our borrowings, compared to the year ended December 31, 2022. We may experience additional pressure
on our net interest margin during 2024 if our cost of funds increases faster than the yield on our interest-earning assets.
Interest income was $133.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2023 compared to $104.6 million for the same period in
2022. Loan interest income made up substantially all of our interest income for the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022,
although interest on investment securities contributed 9.8% of interest income for the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022.
Interest on our commercial real estate loans, commercial and industrial loans, and 1-4 family residential real estate loans
constituted the three largest components of our loan interest income for both of the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022 at
84% total interest income on loans. The overall yield on interest-earning assets increased 78 basis points to 5.06% for the year
ended December 31, 2023 compared to 4.28% for the same period in 2022. The loan portfolio yielded 5.55% for the year ended
December 31, 2023 compared to 4.82% for the year ended December 31, 2022. The increase in yield on our loan portfolio was
driven primarily by higher yields on commercial real estate loans and commercial and industrial loans. In addition, the yield on
the investment portfolio was 2.78% for the year ended December 31, 2023 compared to 2.23% for the year ended December 31,
2022.
Interest expense was $58.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2023, an increase of $43.9 million compared to interest
expense of $14.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2022. The increase in interest expense is primarily attributable to the
increase in the rates paid for interest-bearing liabilities, primarily interest-bearing deposits, and to a lesser extent the increase in
the volume of interest-bearing liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2023 compared to December 31, 2022. For the year
ended December 31, 2023, the cost of interest-bearing deposits increased 207 basis points to 2.49% and the cost of short-term
borrowings increased 188 basis points to 4.93% primarily due to increases in the federal funds target rate. As previously
discussed, the federal funds target rate increased from 0% to 0.25% to 4.25% to 4.50% during 2022 and to 5.25% to 5.50% during
2023, which affects the rate the Company pays for deposits, immediately available overnight funds, borrowings under the BTFP,
and long-term borrowings. For the year ended December 31, 2023, the cost of interest-bearing liabilities increased 205 basis
points to 2.89% compared to the same period in 2022.
2022 vs. 2021. For a detailed discussion of our net interest income and net interest margin performance for 2022 compared to
2021, see our annual report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2022, Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis
of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Results of Operations – Performance Summary and – Net Interest Income
and Net Interest Margin –2022 vs. 2021, and – Volume/Rate Analysis.
53
Average Balances and Yields. The following table sets forth average balance sheet data, including all major categories of interest-
earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, together with the interest earned or paid and the average yield or rate paid on each
such category as of and for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021. Averages presented below are daily averages
(dollars in thousands).
2023
Interest
As of and for the year ended December 31,
2022
Interest
2021
Interest
Average Income/ Yield/ Average Income/ Yield/ Average Income/ Yield/
Balance Expense(1) Rate(1) Balance Expense(1) Rate(1) Balance Expense(1) Rate(1)
$2,123,234 $ 117,892 5.55% $1,937,255 $ 93,373 4.82% $1,902,070 $ 90,230 4.74%
447,442
22,051
12,372 2.76 442,767
18,746
693 3.14
9,796 2.21 275,963
20,259
482 2.57
3,948 1.43
552 2.73
Assets
Interest-earning assets:
Loans
Securities:
Taxable
Tax-exempt
Interest-earning balances with
banks
38,561
2,244 5.82
45,542
918 2.02 176,349
812 0.46
Total interest-earning
assets
Cash and due from banks
Intangible assets
Other assets
Allowance for credit losses
Total assets
Liabilities and stockholders’
2,631,288 133,201 5.06 2,444,310 104,569 4.28 2,374,641
39,262
41,299
138,096
(20,704)
$2,572,594
34,327
43,588
103,711
(22,093)
$2,603,843
29,142
42,695
86,712
(30,242)
$2,759,595
95,542 4.02
equity
Interest-bearing liabilities:
Deposits:
Interest-bearing demand
deposits
Brokered demand deposits
Savings deposits
Brokered time deposits
Time deposits
$ 688,786 $
—
134,817
163,873
699,648
8,941 1.30% $ 900,405 $
— —
1,773
534 0.40 173,460
8,224 5.02
82
24,373 3.48 427,416
2,411 0.27% $ 858,660 $
7 0.42
77,432
79 0.05 168,194
—
4 4.80
3,749 0.88 508,954
2,398 0.28%
715 0.92
247 0.15
— —
4,127 0.81
Total interest-bearing
deposits
Short-term borrowings(2)
Long-term debt
Total interest-bearing
liabilities
Noninterest-bearing demand
1,687,124
260,730
82,844
42,072 2.49 1,503,136
12,845 4.93 134,192
3,764 4.54 127,288
6,250 0.42 1,613,240
4,093 3.05
9,323
4,441 3.49 129,318
7,487 0.46
19 0.20
4,222 3.26
2,030,698
58,681 2.89 1,764,616
14,784 0.84 1,751,881
11,728 0.67
deposits
Other liabilities
Stockholders’ equity
489,175
21,220
218,502
600,286
10,425
228,516
553,083
18,852
248,778
Total liabilities and
stockholders’
equity
Net interest
$2,759,595
$2,603,843
$2,572,594
income/net
interest margin
$ 74,520 2.83%
$ 89,785 3.67%
$ 83,814 3.53%
(1)
(2)
Interest income and net interest margin are expressed as a percentage of average interest-earning assets outstanding for the indicated
periods. Interest expense is expressed as a percentage of average interest-bearing liabilities for the indicated periods.
For additional information, see Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition – Borrowings.
54
Nonaccrual loans were included in the computation of average loan balances but carry a zero yield. The yields include the effect
of loan fees of $2.0 million, $3.6 million and $3.0 million for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, respectively,
and discounts and premiums that are amortized or accreted to interest income or expense.
Volume/Rate Analysis. The following tables set forth a summary of the changes in interest earned and interest paid resulting from
changes in volume and rates for the year ended December 31, 2023 compared to the year ended December 31, 2022 and the year
ended December 31, 2022 compared to the year ended December 31, 2021 (dollars in thousands).
Year ended December 31, 2023 vs.
Year ended December 31, 2022
Rate
Net(1)
Volume
Interest income:
Loans
Securities:
Taxable
Tax-exempt
Interest-earning balances with banks
Total interest-earning assets
Interest expense:
Interest-bearing demand deposits
Brokered demand deposits
Savings deposits
Brokered time deposits
Time deposits
Short-term borrowings
Long-term debt
Total interest-bearing liabilities
Change in net interest income
Interest income:
Loans
Securities:
Taxable
Tax-exempt
Interest-earning balances with banks
Total interest-earning assets
Interest expense:
Interest-bearing demand deposits
Brokered demand deposits
Savings deposits
Brokered time deposits
Time deposits
Short-term borrowings
Long-term debt
Total interest-bearing liabilities
Change in net interest income
$
8,964 $
15,555 $
24,519
103
85
(140)
9,012
(567)
(7)
(18)
7,870
2,388
3,860
(1,551)
11,975
(2,963) $
2,473
126
1,466
19,620
7,097
—
473
350
18,236
4,892
874
31,922
(12,302) $
2,576
211
1,326
28,632
6,530
(7)
455
8,220
20,624
8,752
(677)
43,897
(15,265)
$
Year ended December 31, 2022 vs.
Year ended December 31, 2021
Rate
Net(1)
Volume
$
1,669 $
1,474 $
3,143
2,386
(41)
(602)
3,412
117
(699)
8
4
(665)
255
(66)
(1,046)
4,458 $
3,462
(29)
708
5,615
(104)
(9)
(176)
—
287
3,819
285
4,102
1,513 $
5,848
(70)
106
9,027
13
(708)
(168)
4
(378)
4,074
219
3,056
5,971
$
(1) Changes in interest due to both volume and rate have been allocated entirely to rate.
55
Noninterest Income
Noninterest income includes, among other things, service charges on deposit accounts, gains and losses on call or sale of
investment securities, gains and losses on sales or dispositions of fixed assets and other real estate owned, swap termination fee
income, gain on sale of loans, servicing fees and fee income on serviced loans, interchange fees, income from bank owned life
insurance, changes in the fair value of equity securities, and income from insurance proceeds. We expect to continue to develop
new products that generate noninterest income, and enhance our existing products, in order to diversify our revenue sources.
2023 vs. 2022. Total noninterest income decreased $11.8 million, or 64.4%, to $6.5 million for the year ended December 31,
2023 compared to $18.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2022. The decrease is mainly attributable to $8.1 million of
swap termination fees and $1.4 million of income from insurance proceeds recorded during the year ended December 31,
2022 and the loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets of $1.3 million during the year ended December 31, 2023, primarily
resulting from the sale of the Alice and Victoria, Texas branches, compared to a loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets of $0.3
million for the year ended December 31, 2022.
Service charges on deposit accounts include maintenance fees on accounts, account enhancement charges for additional deposit
account features, per item charges, overdraft fees, and treasury management charges. Service charges on deposit accounts
were $3.1 million for both of the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022.
There was a $0.3 million loss on call or sale of investment securities for the year ended December 31, 2023 compared to a de
minimis gain for the year ended December 31, 2022. We sold approximately $15.0 million of securities during the year ended
December 31, 2023 compared to no sales and de minimis calls during the year ended December 31, 2022.
Loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets for the year ended December 31, 2023 increased to $1.3 million from $0.3 million for
the year ended December 31, 2022. During 2023, a loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets of $1.3 million was recorded as a
result of the sale of the Alice and Victoria, Texas branches, the disposition of ATMs, and a reclassification of bank premises and
equipment to other real estate owned. During 2022, a loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets of $0.5 million was recorded as
a result of the Bank closing two branches in Louisiana, which was partially offset by a gain on sale or disposition of fixed assets
as a result of the sale of three tracts of land that were being held for future branch locations.
There was a $0.1 million loss on sale of other real estate owned for the year ended December 31, 2023 compared to a de minimis
gain for the year ended December 31, 2022. We sold approximately $1.5 million of other real estate owned during the year ended
December 31, 2023 compared to $5.8 million of sales during the year ended December 31, 2022.
No swap termination fee income was recorded during the year ended December 31, 2023. Swap termination fee income of $8.1
million was recorded for the year ended December 31, 2022 when we voluntarily terminated a number of our interest rate swap
agreements during the first and second quarters of 2022 in response to market conditions.
There was a $0.1 million gain on sale of loans for the year ended December 31, 2023 as a result of the sale of the Alice and
Victoria, Texas branches, compared to no gain or loss for the year ended December 31, 2022.
Servicing fees and fee income on serviced loans decreased $60,000, or 81.1%, to $14,000 for the year ended December 31, 2023.
This decrease is a result of the Bank exiting the indirect auto loan origination business at the end of 2015. Since the Bank did not
originate auto loans for sale during the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022, the servicing portfolio, which experienced
regularly scheduled paydowns, was not replaced with new loans. We expect servicing fees and fee income on serviced loans to
decrease over time until all serviced loans are paid off.
Interchange fees, which are fees earned on the usage of the Bank’s credit and debit cards, decreased $0.3 million, or 16.7%,
to $1.7 million for year ended December 31, 2023 from $2.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2022. The decrease in
interchange fees can primarily be attributed to the decrease in the volume of debit and credit card transactions.
Income from bank owned life insurance increased $0.1 million to $1.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2023
from $1.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2022. This increase reflects increased interest earned on the Company’s bank
owned life insurance policies.
No income from insurance proceeds was recorded for the year ended December 31, 2023. Income from insurance proceeds
totaled $1.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2022. Nontaxable income related to an insurance policy for the former
Chief Financial Officer of the Company and the Bank of $1.4 million was recorded during the fourth quarter of 2022.
56
Other operating income includes, among other things, credit card, ATM and wire fees, derivative fee income, changes in the net
asset value of other investments and rental income. The $0.6 million decrease in other operating income for the year ended
December 31, 2023 is primarily attributable to a $0.5 million decrease in derivative fee income compared to the year ended
December 31, 2022.
2022 vs. 2021. For a detailed discussion of our noninterest income for 2022 compared to 2021, see Item 7. Management’s
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Results of Operations – Noninterest Income – 2022
vs. 2021 in our annual report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2022.
Noninterest Expense
Noninterest expense includes salaries and employee benefits and other costs associated with the conduct of our operations. Our
goal is to manage our costs within the framework of our near-term operating strategy of generating consistent, quality earnings.
2023 vs. 2022. Total noninterest expense was $62.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2023, an increase of $1.8 million,
or 2.9%, from $60.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2022. This increase was primarily driven by the increases in
salaries and employee benefits and other operating expenses, partially offset by a decrease in depreciation and amortization.
Salaries and employee benefits increased $2.2 million, or 6.2%, to $37.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2023,
compared to $35.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2022. Included in salaries and employee benefits for the
year ended December 31, 2022 is a $2.3 million employee retention credit (“ERC”) recognized as a credit to payroll taxes, which
decreased salaries and employee benefits reported for 2022. The increase in salaries and employee benefits is mainly attributable
to increases in health insurance claims and payroll taxes, partially offset by decreases in incentive-based compensation and
severance. Salaries and employee benefits for 2022 also included $0.6 million of severance due to the separation agreement with
the former Chief Financial Officer of the Company and the Bank. Please refer to Note 1. Summary of Significant Accounting
Policies – Employee Retention Credit, for additional discussion regarding the ERCs. As of December 31, 2023, we had 320 full-
time and 11 part-time employees, compared to 331 full-time and seven part-time employees as of December 31, 2022.
Depreciation and amortization decreased $0.7 million, or 14.8%, to $3.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2023,
compared to $4.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2022. The decrease in depreciation and amortization is primarily
driven by the sale of the Alice and Victoria, Texas branches and the closure of one branch during the first quarter of 2023 and two
branches during 2022.
Data processing decreased $0.1 million, or 3.3%, to $3.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2023 from $3.6 million for
the same period in 2022. We did not complete any acquisitions, which typically drive higher data processing expenses, during
the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022. We regularly review existing contracts with the goal of negotiating favorable
terms to offset the increased variable cost components of our data processing costs, such as new accounts and increased
transaction volume.
Occupancy expense increased $0.1 million, or 2.7%, to $3.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2023 from $2.9 million for
the year ended December 31, 2022. This increase is primarily attributable to $0.4 million in occupancy expense recorded
primarily to terminate remaining contractually obligated lease payments due under non-cancelable operating leases, partially
offset by a decrease in building rent, both as a result of the sale the Alice and Victoria, Texas branches in January 2023.
Other operating expenses include security, business development, FDIC and OCC assessments, bank shares and property taxes,
collection and repossession, charitable contributions, repair and maintenance costs, personnel training and development, filing
fees, and other costs related to the operation of our business. Other operating expenses increased $0.3 million, or 2.5%,
to $13.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2023 from $12.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2022. The increase in
other operating expenses was primarily due to increases in FDIC assessments, other real estate expense, and bank shares taxes,
partially offset by a decrease in collection and repossession expenses, the majority of which was related to one impaired loan
relationship impacted by Hurricane Ida.
2022 vs. 2021. For a detailed discussion of our noninterest expense for 2022 compared to 2021, see Item 7. Management’s
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Results of Operations – Noninterest Expense – 2022
vs. 2021 in our annual report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2022.
57
Income Tax Expense
Income tax expense for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 was $3.8 million, $8.6 million, and $1.9 million,
respectively. The effective tax rates for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 were 18.4%, 19.5%, and 19.3%,
respectively. For the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2021, the effective tax rate differs from the statutory rate of 21%
primarily due to tax-exempt interest income earned on certain loans and investment securities and income from bank owned life
insurance. For the year ended December 31, 2022, the effective tax rate differs from the statutory rate of 21% primarily due to
nontaxable income from insurance proceeds and tax-exempt interest income earned on certain loans and investment securities
and income from bank owned life insurance.
Risk Management
The primary risks associated with our operations are credit, interest rate and liquidity risk. Higher inflation also presents risks.
Credit, inflation and interest rate risk are discussed below, while liquidity risk is discussed in this section under the heading
Liquidity and Capital Resources below.
Credit Risk and the Allowance for Credit Losses
General. The risk of loss should a borrower default on a loan is inherent in any lending activity. Our portfolio and related credit
risk are monitored and managed on an ongoing basis by our risk management department, the board of directors’ loan committee
and the full board of directors. We utilize a ten point risk-rating system, which assigns a risk grade to each borrower based on a
number of quantitative and qualitative factors associated with a loan transaction. The risk grade categorizes the loan into one of
five risk categories, based on information about the ability of borrowers to service the debt. The information includes, among
other factors, current financial information about the borrower, historical payment experience, credit documentation, public
information and current economic trends. These categories assist management in monitoring our credit quality. The risk
categories, which are consistent with the definitions used in guidance promulgated by federal banking regulators are Pass (grades
1-6), Special Mention (grade 7), Substandard (grade 8), Doubtful (grade 9) and Loss (grade 10). For additional information, see
Note 3. Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses – Credit Quality Indicators.
At December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, there were no loans classified as loss, while there were no loans and $0.2 million
of loans, respectively, classified as doubtful, $12.0 million and $15.0 million, respectively, of loans classified as substandard,
and $10.8 million and $12.8 million, respectively, of loans classified as special mention as of such dates. Of our
aggregate $22.9 million and $28.0 million doubtful, substandard and special mention loans at December 31, 2023 and December
31, 2022, respectively, $2.3 million and $4.7 million, respectively, were acquired and marked to fair value at the time of their
acquisition.
An independent loan review is conducted annually, whether internally or externally, on at least 40% of commercial loans utilizing
a risk-based approach designed to maximize the effectiveness of the review. Internal loan review is independent of the loan
underwriting and approval process. In addition, credit analysts periodically review certain commercial loans to identify negative
financial trends related to any one borrower, any related groups of borrowers or an industry. All loans not categorized as pass are
put on an internal watch list, with quarterly reports to the board of directors. In addition, a written status report is maintained by
our special assets division for all commercial loans categorized as substandard or worse. We use this information in connection
with our collection efforts.
If our collection efforts are unsuccessful, collateral securing loans may be repossessed and sold or, for loans secured by real
estate, foreclosure proceedings initiated. The collateral is sold at public auction for fair market value (based upon recent
appraisals), with fees associated with the foreclosure being deducted from the sales price. The purchase price is applied to the
outstanding loan balance. If the loan balance is greater than the sales proceeds, the deficient balance is charged-off.
Allowance for Credit Losses. Effective January 1, 2023, we adopted ASU 2016-13, which uses the CECL accounting
methodology for the allowance for credit losses. Upon adoption, we recorded a one-time, cumulative effect adjustment to
increase the allowance for credit losses by $5.9 million. The allowance for credit losses was $30.5 million at December 31,
2023, an increase compared to $24.4 million at December 31, 2022 and $20.9 million at December 31, 2021, respectively. The
CECL methodology requires that lifetime expected credit losses be recorded at the time the financial asset is originated or
acquired and be adjusted each period through a provision for credit losses for changes in the expected lifetime credit losses.
58
For the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, the provision for credit losses on loans was negative $2.0 million, $2.9
million, and $22.9 million, respectively. The negative provision for credit losses for the year ended December 31, 2023 was
primarily driven by net recoveries of $2.3 million in the loan portfolio primarily attributable to recoveries on one loan relationship
that became impaired in the third quarter of 2021 as a result of Hurricane Ida. The provision for loan losses for the year ended
December 31, 2022 reflects provisioning related to our organic loan growth. The provision for loan losses for the year ended
December 31, 2021 includes a $21.6 million impairment charge related to one loan relationship impacted by Hurricane Ida, as
discussed in Certain Events That Affect Year-over-Year Comparability – Hurricane Ida.
Refer to Note 1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies – Allowance for Credit Losses and – Accounting Standards
Adopted in 2023, for information regarding our adoption of ASU 2016-13. Results for reporting periods beginning after
December 31, 2022 are presented in accordance with ASU 2016-13 while prior period amounts continue to be reported in
accordance with previously applicable U.S. GAAP. Refer to “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition
and Results of Operations – Critical Accounting Estimates” for further discussion.
The following table presents the allocation of the allowance for credit losses by loan category as of the dates indicated (dollars
in thousands).
2023
December 31,
2022
2021
% of Loans
in each
Category
to Total
Loans
% of Loans
in each
Category
to Total
Loans
% of Loans
in each
Category to
Total
Loans
Allowance
for Credit
Losses
Allowance
for Credit
Losses
Allowance
for Credit
Losses
Mortgage loans on real estate:
Construction and development
1-4 Family
Multifamily
Farmland
Commercial real estate
Commercial and industrial
Consumer
Total
$
$
2,471
9,129
1,124
2
10,691
6,920
203
30,540
8.6% $
18.7
4.8
0.4
42.4
24.6
0.5
100% $
2,555
3,917
999
113
10,718
5,743
319
24,364
9.6% $
19.1
3.9
0.6
45.5
20.7
0.6
100% $
2,347
3,337
673
383
9,354
4,411
354
20,859
10.9%
19.4
3.2
1.1
47.9
16.6
0.9
100%
The following table presents the amount of the allowance for credit losses allocated to each loan category as a percentage of
total loans as of the dates indicated.
Mortgage loans on real estate:
Construction and development
1-4 Family
Multifamily
Farmland
Commercial real estate
Commercial and industrial
Consumer
Total
2023
December 31,
2022
2021
0.11%
0.41
0.05
—
0.49
0.31
0.01
1.38%
0.12%
0.18
0.05
0.01
0.51
0.27
0.02
1.16%
0.12%
0.18
0.04
0.02
0.50
0.23
0.02
1.11%
As discussed above, the balance in the allowance for credit losses is principally influenced by the provision for credit losses and
by net loan loss experience. Additions to the allowance are charged to the provision for credit losses. Losses are charged to the
allowance as incurred and recoveries on losses previously charged to the allowance are credited to the allowance at the time
recovery is collected.
59
The table below reflects the activity in the allowance for credit losses and key ratios for the periods indicated (dollars in
thousands).
Allowance for credit losses at beginning of period
ASU 2016-13 adoption impact
Provision for credit losses on loans(1)
Net recoveries (charge-offs)(2)
Allowance for credit losses at end of period
Total loans - period end
Nonaccrual loans - period end
Key Ratios:
$
$
Year ended December 31,
2022
2023
2021
24,364 $
5,865
(1,964)
2,275
30,540 $
2,210,619
5,770
20,859 $
—
2,922
583
24,364 $
2,104,767
9,986
20,363
—
22,885
(22,389)
20,859
1,872,012
29,495
Allowance for credit losses to total loans - period end
Allowance for credit losses to nonaccrual loans - period end
Nonaccrual loans to total loans - period end
1.38%
529%
0.26%
1.16%
244%
0.47%
1.11%
71%
1.58%
(1) For the year ended December 31, 2023, the negative provision for credit losses of $2.0 million on the consolidated
statement of income includes a negative provision for loan losses of $2.0 million and a negative provision for unfunded
loan commitments of $36,000.
(2) We recognized net recoveries of $2.4 million and net charge-offs of $21.6 million in the loan portfolio during the years
ended December 31, 2023 and 2021, respectively, attributable to one loan relationship that became impaired in the
third quarter of 2021 as a result of Hurricane Ida.
The allowance for credit losses to total loans increased to 1.38% at December 31, 2023 compared to 1.16% at December 31,
2022 while the allowance for credit losses to nonaccrual loans ratio increased to 529% at December 31, 2023 from 244% at
December 31, 2022. The increase in the allowance for credit losses to total loans at December 31, 2023 compared to December
31, 2022 is primarily due to the one-time, cumulative effect adjustment to increase the allowance for credit losses by $5.9 million
recorded upon adoption of ASU 2016-13 on January 1, 2023. The increase in the allowance for credit losses to nonaccrual loans
and the decrease in nonaccrual loans to total loans are due to the decrease in nonaccrual loans primarily due to large paydowns
on one loan relationship impacted by Hurricane Ida. Nonaccrual loans were $5.8 million, or 0.26% of total loans, at December
31, 2023, a decrease of $4.2 million compared to $10.0 million, or 0.47% of total loans, at December 31, 2022. Many of the loans
comprising the total relationship were placed on nonaccrual following the impairment in the third quarter of 2021.
The following table presents the allocation of net (charge offs) recoveries by loan category for the periods indicated (dollars in
thousands).
2023
Year ended December 31,
2022
2021
Net
(Charge-
offs)
Recoveries
Average
balance
Ratio of
Net
Charge-
offs to
Average
Loans
Net
(Charge-
offs)
Recoveries
Average
balance
Ratio of
Net
Charge-
offs to
Average
Loans
Net
(Charge-
offs)
Recoveries
Average
balance
Ratio of
Net
Charge-
offs to
Average
Loans
Mortgage loans on
real estate:
Construction and
development
1-4 Family
Multifamily
Farmland
Commercial real
estate
Commercial and
industrial
Consumer
Total
$
75 $ 200,691
(24) 410,320
86,668
—
9,206
—
(0.04)% $
0.01
—
—
48 $ 210,160
103 380,481
56,665
—
15,837
13
(0.02 )% $
(0.03 )
—
(0.08 )
(247) $ 211,230
(156) 354,748
60,327
23,128
—
(13)
0.12%
0.04
—
0.06
2,219 961,617
(0.23)
33 901,422
(0.00 )
(10,274) 869,098
1.18
171 442,299
(166)
12,433
2,275 $2,123,234
(0.04)
1.34
(0.11)% $
535 357,837
(149)
14,853
583 $1,937,255
(0.15 )
1.00
(0.03 )% $
(11,641) 362,483
21,056
(22,389) $1,902,070
(58)
3.21
0.28
1.18%
$
60
Charge-offs reflect the realization of losses in the portfolio that were recognized previously through the provision for credit
losses. Net charge-offs include recoveries of amounts previously charged off. Net recoveries for the years ended December 31,
2023 and 2022 were $2.3 million and $0.6 million, respectively, equal to 0.11% and 0.03% of the average loan balance for the
respective periods. Net charge-offs for the year ended December 31, 2021 were $22.4 million, or 1.18%, of the average loan
balance. Net recoveries for the year ended December 31, 2023 were primarily attributable to recoveries on one loan relationship
that became impaired in the third quarter of 2021 as a result of Hurricane Ida. Net recoveries for the year ended December 31,
2022 were primarily driven by one $0.9 million recovery on a commercial and industrial loan relationship. Net charge-offs for
the year ended December 31, 2021 were primarily due to charge-offs of $21.6 million in the third quarter of 2021 due to the
impairment charge related to one loan relationship impacted by Hurricane Ida. Commercial and industrial loans and commercial
real estate loans were the categories affected.
Management believes the allowance for credit losses at December 31, 2023 is sufficient to provide adequate protection against
losses in our loan portfolio. However, there can be no assurance that this allowance will prove to be adequate over time to cover
ultimate losses in connection with our loans. This allowance may prove to be inadequate due to higher inflation and interest rates
than anticipated, other unanticipated adverse changes in the economy, unanticipated effects of the current geopolitical and
domestic political conflicts, a resurgence of COVID-19, or discrete events adversely affecting specific customers or industries.
Our results of operations and financial condition could be materially adversely affected to the extent that the allowance is
insufficient to cover such changes or events.
Nonperforming assets. Nonperforming assets consist of nonperforming loans and other real estate owned. Nonperforming loans
are those on which the accrual of interest has stopped or loans which are contractually 90 days past due on which interest
continues to accrue. Loans are ordinarily placed on nonaccrual when a loan is specifically determined to be impaired or when
principal and interest is delinquent for 90 days or more. Additionally, management may elect to continue the accrual when the
estimated net available value of collateral is sufficient to cover the principal balance and accrued interest. It is our policy to
discontinue the accrual of interest income on any loan for which we have reasonable doubt as to the payment of interest or
principal. A loan may be returned to accrual status when all the principal and interest amounts contractually due are brought
current and future principal and interest amounts contractually due are reasonably assured, which is typically evidenced by a
sustained period of repayment performance by the borrower.
Restructured loans. Effective January 1, 2023, we adopted ASU 2022-02, “Financial Instruments - Credit Losses (Topic 326):
Troubled Debt Restructurings and Vintage Disclosures”, which eliminated the accounting guidance for troubled debt
restructurings (“TDRs”). Prior to our adoption of ASU 2022-02, we accounted for a modification to the contractual terms of a
loan that resulted in granting a concession to a borrower experiencing financial difficulties as a TDR.
Occasionally, we modify loans to borrowers in financial distress by providing certain concessions, such as principal forgiveness,
term extension, an other-than-insignificant payment delay, an interest rate reduction, or a combination of such concessions.
When principal forgiveness is provided, the amount of forgiveness is charged-off against the allowance for credit losses. Upon
our determination that a modified loan (or portion of a loan) has subsequently been deemed uncollectible, the loan (or portion of
the loan) is written off.
Other Real Estate Owned. Other real estate owned consists of properties acquired through foreclosure or acceptance of a deed in
lieu of foreclosure, as well as any properties owned by the Company that are not intended to be used to carry out its
operations. These properties are initially recorded at the lower of cost or fair market value based on appraisal at the time of
foreclosure, less estimated selling cost. Losses arising at the time of foreclosure of properties are charged to the allowance for
credit losses. For the year ended December 31, 2023, additions to other real estate owned were $3.9 million, which were
primarily driven by transfers of properties related to one loan relationship that became impaired in the third quarter of 2021 as a
result of Hurricane Ida. During the year ended December 31, 2023, we closed one branch and one stand-alone ATM and
transferred the associated land and buildings from bank premises and equipment to other real estate owned, as we did not intend
to use the properties for banking operations. Other real estate owned with a cost basis of $1.5 million and $5.8 million was sold
during the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively, resulting in a net loss of $0.1 million and a
net gain of $9,000 for the respective periods, compared to a cost basis of $0.9 million and a net loss of $5,000 for the year ended
December 31, 2021.
61
The following table provides details of our other real estate owned as of the dates indicated (dollars in thousands).
1-4 Family
Commercial real estate
Commercial and industrial
Total other real estate owned
December 31,
2023
December 31,
2022
$
$
— $
4,323
115
4,438 $
682
—
—
682
Changes in our other real estate owned are summarized in the table below for the periods indicated (dollars in thousands).
Balance, beginning of period
Additions
Transfers from bank premises and equipment
Sales of other real estate owned
Balance, end of period
Year ended
December 31,
2023
Year ended
December 31,
2022
$
$
682 $
3,930
1,425
(1,599)
4,438 $
2,653
3,327
525
(5,823)
682
Please refer to Note 4. Other Real Estate Owned, for additional information.
Impact of Inflation. Inflation reached a near 40-year high in late 2021 primarily due to effects of the COVID-19 pandemic, and
continued rising through June 2022. Since June 2022, the rate of inflation has generally declined; however, it has remained above
the Federal Reserve’s target inflation rate of two percent through March 7, 2024. In response to higher inflation, the Federal
Reserve increased the federal funds target rate during 2022 and 2023 as discussed in Certain Events That Affect Year-over-Year
Comparability – Rising Inflation and Interest Rates, which generally increased the amount we earn on our interest-earning assets
but also increased the amount we pay on our interest-bearing liabilities as discussed throughout this report. We believe that higher
rates resulting from inflation and related factors led to constrained loan demand during 2023. When the rate of inflation
accelerates, there is an erosion of consumer and customer purchasing power. Accordingly, if the rate of inflation accelerates in
the future, this could impact our business by reducing our tolerance for extending credit, and our customer’s desire to obtain
credit, or causing us to incur additional provisions for credit losses resulting from a possible increased default rate. Inflation and
related higher rates have led and may continue to lead to lower loan re-financings. Inflation has also increased and may continue
to increase the costs of goods and services we purchase, including the costs of salaries and benefits. In January 2024, the Federal
Reserve decided not to change the federal funds target rate. Many economists expect the Federal Reserve to decrease the federal
funds target rate one or more times during the remainder of 2024. For additional information, see Interest Rate Risk below, and
Item 1A. Risk Factors – Risks Related to our Business – Increasing and high interest rates in 2022 and 2023 caused interest
expense on both deposits and borrowings to increase significantly in 2023; further increases in interest rates could continue to
have an adverse effect on our profitability and – Inflation and rising prices may continue to adversely affect our results of
operations and financial condition.
Interest Rate Risk
Market risk is the risk of loss from adverse changes in market prices and rates. Since the majority of our assets and liabilities are
monetary in nature, our market risk arises primarily from interest rate risk inherent in our lending and deposit activities. A sudden
and substantial change in interest rates may adversely impact our earnings and profitability because the interest rates borne by
assets and liabilities do not change at the same speed, to the same extent, or on the same basis. Accordingly, our ability to
proactively structure the volume and mix of our assets and liabilities to address anticipated changes in interest rates, as well as
to react quickly to such fluctuations, can significantly impact our financial results. To that end, management actively monitors
and manages our interest rate risk exposure.
The ALCO has been authorized by the board of directors to implement our asset/liability management policy, which establishes
guidelines with respect to our exposure to interest rate fluctuations, liquidity, loan limits as a percentage of funding sources,
exposure to correspondent banks and brokers and reliance on non-core deposits. The goal of the policy is to enable us to maximize
our interest income and maintain our net interest margin without exposing the Bank to excessive interest rate risk, credit risk and
liquidity risk. Within that framework, the ALCO monitors our interest rate sensitivity and makes decisions relating to our
asset/liability composition.
62
Net interest income simulation is the Bank’s primary tool for benchmarking near term earnings exposure. Given the ALCO’s
objective to understand the potential risk/volatility embedded within the current mix of assets and liabilities, standard rate
scenario simulations assume total assets remain static (i.e. no growth). The Bank may also use a standard gap report in its interest
rate risk management process. The primary use for the gap report is to provide supporting detailed information to the ALCO’s
discussion.
The Bank has particular concerns with the utility of the gap report as a risk management tool because of difficulties in relating
gap directly to changes in net interest income. Hence, the income simulation is the key indicator for earnings-at-risk since it
expressly measures what the gap report attempts to estimate.
Short term interest rate risk management tactics are decided by the ALCO where risk exposures exist out into the 1 to 2-year
horizon. Tactics are formulated and presented to the ALCO for discussion, modification, and/or approval. Such tactics may
include asset and liability acquisitions of appropriate maturities in the cash market, loan and deposit product/pricing strategy
modification, and derivatives hedging activities to the extent such activity is authorized by the board of directors.
Since the impact of rate changes due to mismatched balance sheet positions in the short-term can quickly and materially affect
the current year’s income statement, they require constant monitoring and management.
Within the gap position that management directs, we attempt to structure our assets and liabilities to minimize the risk of either
a rising or falling interest rate environment. We manage our gap position for time horizons of one month, two months, three
months, four to six months, seven to twelve months, 13-24 months, 25-36 months, 37-60 months and more than 60 months. The
goal of our asset/liability management is for the Bank to maintain a net interest income at risk in an up or down 100 basis point
environment at less than (5)%. At December 31, 2023, the Bank was within the policy guidelines for asset/liability management.
The following table depicts the estimated impact on net interest income of immediate changes in interest rates at the specified
levels for the periods presented.
As of December 31, 2023
Changes in Interest Rates
(in basis points)
+300
+200
+100
-100
-200
-300
Estimated
Increase/Decrease in
Net Interest Income (1)
(7.4)%
(5.4)%
(2.4)%
2.8%
6.8%
9.7%
(1) The percentage change in this column represents the projected net interest income for 12 months on a flat balance sheet
in a stable interest rate environment versus the projected net interest income in the various rate scenarios.
The computation of the prospective effects of hypothetical interest rate changes requires numerous assumptions regarding
characteristics of new business and the behavior of existing positions. These business assumptions are based upon our experience,
business plans and published industry experience. Key assumptions include asset prepayment speeds, competitive factors, the
relative price sensitivity of certain assets and liabilities, and the expected life of non-maturity deposits. However, there are a
number of factors that influence the effect of interest rate fluctuations on us which are difficult to measure and predict. For
example, a rapid drop in interest rates might cause our loans to repay at a more rapid pace and certain mortgage-related
investments to prepay more quickly than projected. This could mitigate some of the benefits of falling rates as are expected when
we are in a negatively-gapped position. Conversely, a rapid rise in rates could give us an opportunity to increase our margins and
slow the rate of repayment on our mortgage-related loans which would increase our returns, but can also increase our costs of
interest-bearing liabilities faster than we expect and faster than an increase in our yield on interest-earning assets which would
decrease our returns. As a result, because these assumptions are inherently uncertain, actual results will differ from simulated
results.
63
Liquidity and Capital Resources
Liquidity. Liquidity is a measure of the ability to fund loan commitments and meet deposit maturities and withdrawals in a timely
and cost-effective way. Cash flow requirements can be met by generating net income, attracting new deposits, converting assets
to cash or borrowing funds. While maturities and scheduled amortization of loans and securities are predictable sources of funds,
deposit outflows, loan prepayments, and borrowings are greatly influenced by general interest rates, economic conditions, and
the competitive environment in which we operate. To minimize funding risks, we closely monitor our liquidity position through
periodic reviews of maturity profiles, yield and rate behaviors, and loan and deposit forecasts. Excess short-term liquidity is
usually invested in overnight federal funds sold.
Our core deposits, which are deposits excluding time deposits greater than $250,000 and deposits of municipalities and other
political entities, are our most stable source of liquidity to meet our cash flow needs due to the nature of the long-term
relationships generally established with our customers. Maintaining the ability to acquire these funds as needed in a variety of
markets, and within ALCO compliance targets, is essential to ensuring our liquidity. At December 31, 2023 and 2022, 64% and
70% of our total assets, respectively, were funded by core deposits.
Our investment portfolio is another alternative for meeting our cash flow requirements. Investment securities generate cash flow
through principal payments and maturities, and they generally have readily available markets that allow for their conversion to
cash. At December 31, 2023, 95% of our investment securities portfolio was classified as AFS, and we had gross unrealized
losses in our AFS investment securities portfolio of $57.7 million and gross unrealized gains of $0.3 million. The sale of
securities in a loss position would cause us to record a loss on sale of investment securities in noninterest income in the period
during which the securities were sold. Some securities are pledged to secure certain deposit types or short-term borrowings, such
as FHLB advances and borrowings under the BTFP, which impacts their liquidity. At December 31, 2023, securities with a
carrying value of $296.2 million were pledged to secure certain deposits, borrowings, and other liabilities compared to
$165.7 million in pledged securities at December 31, 2022 with the increase due primarily to the pledge of securities to secure
borrowings under the BTFP.
Other sources available for meeting liquidity needs include advances from the FHLB, repurchase agreements and other
borrowings. FHLB advances may be used to meet day to day liquidity needs, particularly if the prevailing interest rate on an
FHLB advance compares favorably to the rates that we would be required to pay to attract deposits. At December 31, 2023, the
balance of our outstanding advances with the FHLB was $23.5 million, all long-term advances based on original maturity, a
decrease from $387.0 million at December 31, 2022, consisting of $333.5 million short-term and $53.5 million long-term
advances; we decreased our use of FHLB advances as we utilized the BTFP. The total amount of the remaining credit available
to us from the FHLB at December 31, 2023 was $919.5 million. At December 31, 2023, our FHLB borrowings were collateralized
by a blanket pledge of certain loans totaling approximately $975.4 million.
Beginning in March 2023, we became eligible to borrow from the BTFP, which provides additional liquidity through borrowings
secured by the pledging of certain qualifying securities and other assets valued at par. The BTFP is a one-year program ending
March 11, 2024, and we can borrow any time during the term and can repay the obligation at any time without penalty. During
the second quarter, we utilized the BTFP to secure fixed rate funding for a one-year term and reduce short-term FHLB advances,
which are priced daily. During the fourth quarter of 2023 and again in the first quarter of 2024, we refinanced all of our
borrowings under the BTFP with new borrowings under the BTFP with a one-year term due to more favorable rates. At December
31, 2023, borrowings outstanding under the BTFP were $212.5 million, and our remaining borrowing capacity under the BTFP
was $58.5 million based on the value of securities available to be used as collateral, valued at par value as permitted under the
program.
Repurchase agreements are contracts for the sale of securities which we own with a corresponding agreement to repurchase those
securities at an agreed upon price and date. Our policies limit the use of repurchase agreements to those collateralized by certain
investment securities. We had $8.6 million of repurchase agreements outstanding at December 31, 2023, and none at December
31, 2022.
We maintain unsecured lines of credit with FNBB and TIB totaling $60.0 million. These lines of credit are federal funds lines of
credit and are used for overnight borrowing only. There were no outstanding balances on our unsecured lines of credit
at December 31, 2023 or 2022.
At December 31, 2023, we held $32.0 million of cash and cash equivalents and maintained approximately $1.04 billion of
available funding from FHLB advances, the BTFP, and unsecured lines of credit with correspondent banks. Cash and cash
equivalents and available funding represent 149% of uninsured deposits of $720.1 million at December 31, 2023.
64
In addition, at both December 31, 2023 and 2022 we had $45.0 million in aggregate principal amount of subordinated debt
outstanding. In April 2022, we completed a private placement of $20.0 million in aggregate principal amount of our 2032 Notes,
and used the majority of the proceeds to redeem $18.6 million of our 2027 Notes in June 2022. For additional information,
see Note 10. Subordinated Debt Securities and see Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition – Borrowings above.
Our liquidity strategy is focused on using the least costly funds available to us in the context of our balance sheet composition
and interest rate risk position. Accordingly, we target growth of noninterest-bearing deposits. Although we cannot directly control
the types of deposit instruments our customers choose, we can influence those choices with the interest rates and deposit specials
we offer. In recent periods, the proportion of our deposits represented by noninterest-bearing deposits has declined primarily due
to rising market interest rates as customers have migrated to higher yielding alternatives. At December 31, 2023, we held $269.1
million of brokered time deposits and no brokered demand deposits, as defined for federal regulatory purposes, to secure fixed
cost funding and reduce FHLB advances. At December 31, 2022, we held $10.0 million of brokered time deposits and
no brokered demand deposits, as defined for federal regulatory purposes. We have historically utilized brokered demand deposits,
due to more favorable pricing, to satisfy the required borrowings under interest rate swap agreements. We also hold QwickRate®
deposits, included in our time deposit balances, which we obtain through a qualified network, to address liquidity needs when
rates on such deposits compare favorably with deposit rates in our markets. At December 31, 2023, we held $17.0 million of
QwickRate® deposits, a decrease compared to $26.5 million at December 31, 2022.
The following table presents, by type, our funding sources, which consist of total average deposits and borrowed funds, as a
percentage of total funds and the total cost of each funding source for the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022.
Noninterest-bearing demand
Interest-bearing demand
Brokered demand deposits
Savings deposits
Brokered time deposits
Time deposits
Short-term borrowings
Borrowed funds
Total deposits and borrowed funds
Percentage of Total
Average Deposits and
Borrowed Funds
Cost of Funds
Year ended December 31, Year ended December 31,
2023
2022
2023
2022
20%
27
—
5
7
28
10
3
100%
26%
38
—
7
—
18
6
5
100%
—%
1.30
—
0.40
5.02
3.48
4.93
4.54
2.33%
—%
0.27
0.42
0.05
4.80
0.88
3.05
3.49
0.63%
Capital Resources. Our primary sources of capital include retained earnings, capital obtained through acquisitions and proceeds
from the sale of our capital stock and subordinated debt. We may issue capital stock and debt securities from time to time to fund
acquisitions and support our organic growth. In April 2022, we completed a private placement of $20.0 million in aggregate
principal amount of our 2032 Notes, which are intended to quality as Tier 2 capital for regulatory purposes, and used the majority
of the proceeds to redeem $18.6 million of our 2027 Notes in June 2022. During 2019, we issued $25.0 million of our 2029
Notes, which are intended to qualify as Tier 2 capital for regulatory capital purposes. For additional information see Discussion
and Analysis of Financial Condition – Borrowings.
During 2023, we paid $3.8 million in dividends, compared to $3.6 million in 2022 and $3.1 million in 2021. Our board of
directors has authorized a share repurchase program and during 2023 we paid $3.0 million to repurchase our shares, compared
to $10.5 million in 2022 and $6.9 million in 2021. The aggregate purchase price does not include the effect of excise tax expense
incurred on net share repurchases. On July 19, 2023 and September 21, 2022, the board of directors approved an additional
350,000 shares and 300,000 shares, respectively, of the Company’s common stock for repurchase. At December 31, 2023, we
had 514,266 shares of our common stock remaining authorized for repurchase under the program. For additional information,
see Note 10. Subordinated Debt Securities and Note 13. Stockholders' Equity.
We are subject to restrictions on dividends under applicable banking laws and regulations. Please refer to the discussion under
the heading “Supervision and Regulation – Dividends” in Item 1. Business, for more information. We are also subject to additional
legal and contractual restrictions on dividends. Please refer to the discussion under the heading “Dividend Policy” in Item 5.
Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities and under the
heading “Common Stock – Dividend Restrictions” in Note 13. Stockholders' Equity.
65
We are subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by the Federal Reserve and the OCC. These requirements
are described in greater detail under the heading “Supervision and Regulation – Regulatory Capital Requirements” of Item 1.
Business. Those guidelines specify capital tiers, which include the following classifications:
Tier 1 Leverage
Ratio
5% or above
4% or above
Less than 4%
Less than 3%
Capital Tiers(1)
Well capitalized
Adequately capitalized
Undercapitalized
Significantly
undercapitalized
Critically
undercapitalized
Common Equity Tier 1
Capital Ratio
6.5% or above
4.5% or above
Less than 4.5%
Tier 1 Capital
Ratio
8% or above
6% or above
Less than 6%
Total Capital
Ratio
10% or above
8% or above
Less than 8%
Less than 3%
Less than 4%
Less than 6%
Ratio of Tangible
Equity to Total Assets
2% or less
(1)
In order to be well capitalized or adequately capitalized, a bank must satisfy each of the required ratios in the table. In
order to be undercapitalized or significantly undercapitalized, a bank would need to fall below just one of the relevant
ratio thresholds in the table. In order to be well capitalized, the Bank cannot be subject to any written agreement or
order requiring it to maintain a specific level of capital for any capital measure.
The Company and the Bank each were in compliance with all regulatory capital requirements as of December 31, 2023, 2022
and 2021. The Bank also was considered “well-capitalized” under the OCC’s prompt corrective action regulations as of these
dates.
The following table presents the actual capital amounts and regulatory capital ratios for the Company and the Bank as of the
dates presented (dollars in thousands).
December 31, 2023
Investar Holding Corporation:
Tier 1 capital to average assets (leverage)
Tier 1 common equity to risk-weighted assets
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets
Total capital to risk-weighted assets
Investar Bank:
Tier 1 capital to average assets (leverage)
Tier 1 common equity to risk-weighted assets
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets
Total capital to risk-weighted assets
December 31, 2022
Investar Holding Corporation:
Tier 1 capital to average assets (leverage)
Tier 1 common equity to risk-weighted assets
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets
Total capital to risk-weighted assets
Investar Bank:
Tier 1 capital to average assets (leverage)
Tier 1 common equity to risk-weighted assets
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets
Total capital to risk-weighted assets
Actual
Minimum Capital
Requirement to be Well
Capitalized
Amount
Ratio
Amount
Ratio
$
$
239,095
229,595
239,095
313,574
280,687
280,687
280,687
310,846
231,048
221,548
231,048
300,009
267,603
267,603
267,603
292,339
8.35% $
9.51
9.90
12.99
9.81
11.64
11.64
12.89
8.53% $
9.79
10.21
13.25
9.89
11.83
11.83
12.92
—
—
—
—
—%
—
—
—
143,085
156,805
192,990
241,238
5.00
6.50
8.00
10.00
—
—
—
—
—%
—
—
—
135,344
147,044
180,977
226,221
5.00
6.50
8.00
10.00
66
Off-Balance Sheet Transactions and Lease Obligations
Swap Contracts. The Bank historically has entered into interest rate swap contracts, some of which are forward starting, to
manage exposure against the variability in the expected future cash flows (future interest payments) attributable to changes in
the 1-month LIBOR associated with the forecasted issuances of 1-month fixed rate debt arising from a rollover strategy. An
interest rate swap is an agreement whereby one party agrees to pay a fixed rate of interest on a notional principal amount in
exchange for receiving a floating rate of interest on the same notional amount for a predetermined period of time, from a second
party. At December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, the Company had no current or forward starting interest rate swap
agreements. For additional information, see Note 12. Derivative Financial Instruments.
During the year ended December 31, 2022, we voluntarily terminated our remaining interest rate swap agreements with a total
notional amount of $115.0 million in response to market conditions. During year ended December 31, 2021, we voluntarily
terminated interest rate swap agreements with a total notional amount of $150.0 million in response to market conditions and as
a result of excess liquidity. For years ended December 31, 2022 and December 31, 2021, unrealized gains of $6.4 million and
$1.4 million, respectively, net of tax expenses of $1.7 million and $0.4 million, respectively, were reclassified from
“Accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income” and recorded as “Swap termination fee income” in noninterest income in the
accompanying consolidated statements of income.
For the years ended December 31, 2022 and December 31, 2021, a gain of $4.3 million, net of a $1.2 million tax expense, and
a gain of $5.3 million, net of a $1.4 million tax expense, respectively, was recognized in “Other comprehensive income (loss)” in
the accompanying consolidated statements of comprehensive (loss) income for the change in fair value of the interest rate swap
contracts.
The Company also enters into interest rate swap contracts that allow commercial loan customers to effectively convert a variable-
rate commercial loan agreement to a fixed-rate commercial loan agreement. Under these agreements, the Company enters into a
variable-rate loan agreement with a customer in addition to an interest rate swap agreement, which serves to effectively swap the
customer’s variable-rate loan into a fixed-rate loan. The Company then enters into a corresponding swap agreement with a third
party in order to economically hedge its exposure through the customer agreement. The interest rate swaps with both the
customers and third parties are not designated as hedges under FASB ASC Topic 815, “Derivatives and Hedging,” and are
marked to market through earnings. As the interest rate swaps are structured to offset each other, changes to the underlying
benchmark interest rates considered in the valuation of these instruments do not result in an impact to earnings; however, there
may be fair value adjustments related to credit quality variations between counterparties, which may impact earnings as required
by FASB ASC Topic 820, “Fair Value Measurement.” The Company did not recognize any gains or losses in other income
resulting from fair value adjustments during the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021. At December 31, 2023, we had
notional amounts of $174.9 million in interest rate swap contracts with customers and $174.9 million in offsetting interest rate
swap contracts with other financial institutions. The fair value of the swap contracts consisted of gross assets of $17.3 million
and gross liabilities of $17.3 million recorded in “Other assets” and “Accrued taxes and other liabilities”, respectively, in the
accompanying consolidated balance sheet.
Unfunded Commitments. The Bank enters into loan commitments and standby letters of credit in the normal course of its business.
Loan commitments are made to meet the financing needs of our customers, while standby letters of credit commit the Bank to
make payments on behalf of customers when certain specified future events occur. The credit risks associated with loan
commitments and standby letters of credit are essentially the same as those involved in making loans to our customers.
Accordingly, our normal credit policies apply to these arrangements. Collateral (e.g., securities, receivables, inventory,
equipment, etc.) is obtained based on management’s credit assessment of the customer. The credit risk associated with these
commitments is evaluated in a manner similar to the allowance for credit losses. The reserve for unfunded loan commitments is
included in “Accrued taxes and other liabilities” in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. At December 31, 2023 and
2022, the reserve for unfunded loan commitments was $0.3 million and $0.4 million, respectively.
Loan commitments and standby letters of credit do not necessarily represent future cash requirements, in that while the customer
typically has the ability to draw upon these commitments at any time, these commitments often expire without being drawn upon
in full or at all. Virtually all of our standby letters of credit expire within one year. Our unfunded loan commitments and standby
letters of credit outstanding are summarized below as of the dates indicated (dollars in thousands).
Commitments to extend credit:
Loan commitments
Standby letters of credit
67
December 31,
2023
December 31,
2022
$
413,019 $
17,844
333,040
11,379
The Company closely monitors the amount of remaining future commitments to borrowers in light of prevailing economic
conditions and adjusts these commitments as necessary. The Company will continue this process as new commitments are entered
into or existing commitments are renewed.
Additionally, at December 31, 2023, the Company had unfunded commitments of $1.3 million for its investment in Small
Business Investment Company qualified funds.
For each of the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022, we engaged in no off-balance sheet transactions reasonably likely to
have a material effect on our financial condition, results of operations, or cash flows currently or in the future.
Lease Obligations. The Company’s primary leasing activities relate to certain real estate leases entered into in support of the
Company’s branch operations. The Company’s branch locations operated under lease agreements have all been designated as
operating leases. The Company does not lease equipment under operating leases, nor does it have leases designated as finance
leases.
The following table presents, as of December 31, 2023, contractually obligated lease payments due under non-cancelable
operating leases by payment date (dollars in thousands).
Less than one year
One to three years
Three to five years
Over five years
Total
$
$
381
727
682
671
2,461
On January 27, 2023, we completed the previously announced sale of certain assets, deposits and other liabilities associated with
the Alice and Victoria, Texas branch locations. Upon the completion of the sale, we recorded $0.3 million of occupancy expense
to terminate the remaining contractually obligated lease payments due under non-cancelable operating leases.
Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk
The information contained in Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
– Risk Management hereof is incorporated herein by reference.
68
Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting
To the Stockholders and Board of Directors
Investar Holding Corporation
Baton Rouge, Louisiana
Investar Holding Corporation (the “Company”) is responsible for the preparation, integrity and fair presentation of the
consolidated financial statements included in this annual report. The consolidated financial statements and notes included in this
annual report have been prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America
and necessarily include some amounts that are based on management’s best estimates and judgments.
Management of the Company is responsible for establishing and maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting
designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial
statements for external purposes in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.
The Company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that: (1) pertain to the
maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of
the Company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial
statements in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America and that receipts and
expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the
Company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or
disposition of the Company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
The system of internal control over financial reporting as it relates to the financial statements is evaluated for effectiveness by
management and tested for reliability through a program of internal audits. Actions are taken to correct potential deficiencies as
they are identified. Any system of internal control, no matter how well designed, has inherent limitations, including the possibility
that a control can be circumvented or overridden, and misstatements due to error or fraud may occur and not be detected. Also,
because of changes in conditions, internal control effectiveness may vary over time. Accordingly, even an effective system of
internal control will provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation.
Management, with the participation of the Company’s principal executive officer and principal financial officer, conducted an
assessment of the effectiveness of the Company’s system of internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2023,
based on criteria for effective internal control over financial reporting described in the “Internal Control - Integrated Framework,”
(2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Based on this assessment,
management has concluded that, as of December 31, 2023, the Company’s system of internal control over financial reporting is
effective and meets the criteria of the “Internal Control – Integrated Framework.”
HORNE LLP, the Company’s independent registered public accounting firm that has audited the Company’s financial statements
included in this annual report, has issued an attestation report on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting which
is included herein.
Date: March 7, 2024
Date: March 7, 2024
By: /s/ John J. D’Angelo
John J. D’Angelo
President and Chief Executive Officer
By: /s/ John R. Campbell
John R. Campbell
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
69
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
To the Stockholders and the Board of Directors of Investar Holding Corporation
Opinion on the Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
We have audited Investar Holding Corporation’s (the “Company”) internal control over financial reporting as of December 31,
2023, based on criteria established in the Internal Control - Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring
Organizations of the Treadway Commission in 2013. In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective
internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2023, based on criteria established in the Internal Control - Integrated
Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission in 2013.
We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (the
“PCAOB”), the consolidated financial statements of the Company as of December 31, 2023 and our report dated March 7, 2024
expressed an unqualified opinion.
Basis for Opinion
The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its
assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting in the accompanying Report on Management's
Assessment of Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal
control over financial reporting based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required
to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and
regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the
audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all
material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk
that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the
assessed risk. Our audit also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We
believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the
reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally
accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that
(1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions
of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation
of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the
company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide
reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the company’s
assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also,
projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate
because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
/s/ HORNE LLP
Baton Rouge, Louisiana
March 7, 2024
70
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
To the Stockholders and the Board of Directors of Investar Holding Corporation
Opinion on the Financial Statements
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Investar Holding Corporation (the “Company”) as of
December 31, 2023 and 2022, and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in
stockholders’ equity, and cash flows, for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2023, and the related notes to
the consolidated financial statements (collectively, referred to as the “financial statements”). In our opinion, the financial
statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2023 and 2022, and
the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2023, in conformity
with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.
We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (the
“PCAOB”), the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2023, based on criteria established in
the Internal Control - Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission
in 2013, and our report dated March 7, 2024, expressed an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal
control over financial reporting.
Emphasis-of-Matter
As discussed in Note 1 to the financial statements, the Company has changed its method of accounting for credit losses effective
January 1, 2023, due to the adoption of Accounting Standards Codification ASC 326: Financial Instruments – Credit Losses
(“ASC 326”). The Company adopted the new credit loss standard using the modified retrospective approach such that prior
period amounts are not adjusted and continue to be reported in accordance with previously applicable generally accepted
accounting principles. Our opinion is not modified with respect to this matter.
Basis for Opinion
These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on
the Company’s financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are
required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules
and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the
audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to
error or fraud. Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements,
whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a
test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the
accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the
financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
Critical Audit Matter
The critical audit matter communicated below is a matter arising from the current period audit of the financial statements that
was communicated or required to be communicated to the audit committee and that: (i) relates to accounts or disclosures that are
material to the financial statements and (ii) involved especially challenging, subjective, or complex judgments. The
communication of critical audit matters does not alter in any way our opinion on the financial statements, taken as a whole, and
we are not, by communicating the critical audit matter below, providing separate opinions on the critical audit matter or on the
accounts or disclosures to which it relates.
71
Allowance for Credit Losses
Description of the Matter
As described in Notes 1 and 3 to the financial statements, the Company’s allowance for credit losses (“ACL”) is a valuation that
reflects the Company’s best estimate of expected credit losses inherent within the Company’s loans held for investment portfolio
and is maintained at a level believed adequate by management to absorb credit losses inherent in the entire loan portfolio in
accordance with Accounting Standards Codification ASC 326: Financial Instruments – Credit Losses. The ACL is measured
over the contractual life of loans held for investments and is estimated using relevant available information relating to past events,
current conditions and reasonable and supportable forecasts, as well as qualitative adjustments. The ACL was $30,540,000 at
December 31, 2023, which consists of two components; the loss allocations on pools of loans that share similar risk characteristics
and loss allocations on individual loans that do not share similar risk characteristics with other loans and the measurement of
expected credit loss for such individual loans.
The Company’s measurement of expected credit losses of loans on a pool basis when the loans share similar risk characteristics
is based off historical data that is adjusted, as necessary, for qualitative factors where there are differences in the historical loss
data of the Company and current or projected future conditions. Consideration of the relevant qualitative factors are used to bring
the ACL to the level management believes is appropriate based on factors that are otherwise unaccounted for in the quantitative
process. The ACL also includes reserves for loans evaluated on an individual basis, such as certain loans on nonaccrual.
Management applies judgment in the determination of the qualitative factors and reserves assigned on an individual basis to
estimate the ACL.
The ACL was identified by us as a critical audit matter because of the extent of auditor judgment applied and significant audit
effort to evaluate the significant subjective and complex judgments made by management including the judgment required in
evaluating management's determination of the qualitative factors and the reserve assumptions for loans evaluated on an individual
basis.
How we Addressed the Matter in Our Audit
The primary audit procedures we performed in responses to this critical audit matter included:
• Obtained an understanding of the Company's process for establishing the ACL, including determination of the
qualitative factors and reserve assumptions for loans evaluated on an individual basis, and evaluated the process utilized
by management to challenge the model results and determine the best estimate of the ACL as of the balance sheet date.
Evaluated the design and tested the operating effectiveness of the controls associated with the ACL process, including
controls around the reliability and accuracy of data used in the model, management's review and approval of the selected
qualitative factors, the reserve assumptions for loans evaluated on an individual basis, the governance of the credit loss
methodology, and management's review and approval of the ACL.
•
• Assessed reasonableness of model methodology and key modeling assumptions, as well as the appropriateness of
•
management’s qualitative framework, and reserve assumptions for loans evaluated on an individual basis.
Performed specific substantive tests of the model utilized, qualitative factors and the reserve assumptions for loans
evaluated on an individual basis. We evaluated if qualitative factors were applied based on a comprehensive framework
and compared the adjustments utilized by management to both internal portfolio metrics and external macroeconomic
data (as applicable) to support adjustments and evaluate trends in such adjustments. Within our reserve testing for loans
evaluated on an individual basis, we evaluated management’s assumptions, including collateral valuations. In addition,
we evaluated the Company’s estimate of the overall ACL giving consideration to the Company’s borrowers, loan
portfolio, and macroeconomic trends, independently obtained and compared such information to comparable financial
institutions and considered whether new or contrary information existed.
We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2020.
/s/ HORNE LLP
Baton Rouge, Louisiana
March 7, 2024
72
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
(Amounts in thousands, except share data)
ASSETS
Cash and due from banks
Interest-bearing balances due from other banks
Federal funds sold
Cash and cash equivalents
Available for sale securities at fair value (amortized cost of $419,283 and $467,316,
respectively)
Held to maturity securities at amortized cost (estimated fair value of $20,513 and
$7,922, respectively)
Loans
Less: allowance for credit losses
Loans, net
Equity securities
Bank premises and equipment, net of accumulated depreciation of $19,476 and
$22,025, respectively
Other real estate owned, net
Accrued interest receivable
Deferred tax asset
Goodwill and other intangible assets, net
Bank owned life insurance
Other assets
Total assets
LIABILITIES
Deposits:
Noninterest-bearing
Interest-bearing
Total deposits
Advances from Federal Home Loan Bank
Borrowings under Bank Term Funding Program
Repurchase agreements
Subordinated debt, net of unamortized issuance costs
Junior subordinated debt
Accrued taxes and other liabilities
Total liabilities
Commitments and contingencies (Note 19)
STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
$
$
Preferred stock, no par value per share; 5,000,000 shares authorized
Common stock, $1.00 par value per share; 40,000,000 shares authorized; 9,748,067
and 9,901,847 shares issued and outstanding, respectively
Surplus
Retained earnings
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
Total stockholders’ equity
Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
$
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
73
December 31,
2023
2022
$
28,285 $
3,724
—
32,009
30,056
10,010
193
40,259
361,918
405,167
20,472
2,210,619
(30,540)
2,180,079
14,597
44,183
4,438
14,366
16,910
42,320
58,797
25,066
2,815,155 $
448,752 $
1,806,975
2,255,727
23,500
212,500
8,633
44,320
8,630
35,077
2,588,387
8,305
2,104,767
(24,364)
2,080,403
27,254
49,587
682
12,749
16,438
43,147
57,379
12,437
2,753,807
580,741
1,501,624
2,082,365
387,000
—
—
44,225
8,515
15,920
2,538,025
—
—
9,748
145,456
116,711
(45,147)
226,768
2,815,155 $
9,902
146,587
108,206
(48,913)
215,782
2,753,807
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
(Amounts in thousands, except share data)
For the years ended December 31,
2022
2021
2023
INTEREST INCOME
Interest and fees on loans
Interest on investment securities
Taxable
Tax-exempt
Other interest income
Total interest income
INTEREST EXPENSE
Interest on deposits
Interest on borrowings
Total interest expense
Net interest income
Provision for credit losses
Net interest income after provision for credit losses
NONINTEREST INCOME
Service charges on deposit accounts
(Loss) gain on call or sale of investment securities, net
Loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets, net
(Loss) gain on sale of other real estate owned, net
Swap termination fee income
Gain on sale of loans
Servicing fees and fee income on serviced loans
Interchange fees
Income from bank owned life insurance
Change in the fair value of equity securities
Income from insurance proceeds
Other operating income
Total noninterest income
Income before noninterest expense
NONINTEREST EXPENSE
Depreciation and amortization
Salaries and employee benefits
Occupancy
Data processing
Marketing
Professional fees
Loss on early extinguishment of subordinated debt
Acquisition expense
Other operating expenses
Total noninterest expense
Income before income tax expense
Income tax expense
Net income
EARNINGS PER SHARE
Basic earnings per share
Diluted earnings per share
Cash dividends declared per common share
$
117,892 $
93,373 $
90,230
12,372
693
2,244
133,201
9,796
482
918
104,569
42,072
16,609
58,681
74,520
(2,000)
76,520
3,090
(323)
(1,323)
(114)
—
75
14
1,697
1,417
(65)
—
2,070
6,538
83,058
3,780
37,143
2,994
3,482
302
1,933
—
—
12,996
62,630
20,428
3,750
16,678 $
6,250
8,534
14,784
89,785
2,922
86,863
3,090
6
(258)
9
8,077
37
74
2,036
1,305
(90)
1,384
2,680
18,350
105,213
4,435
34,974
2,915
3,600
262
1,774
222
—
12,683
60,865
44,348
8,639
35,709 $
1.69 $
1.69
0.395
3.54 $
3.50
0.365
3,948
552
812
95,542
7,487
4,241
11,728
83,814
22,885
60,929
2,422
2,321
(408)
(5)
1,835
199
204
1,920
1,146
214
—
2,194
12,042
72,971
4,988
35,527
2,753
3,112
275
1,585
—
2,448
12,374
63,062
9,909
1,909
8,000
0.77
0.76
0.31
$
$
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
74
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)
(Amounts in thousands)
Net income
Other comprehensive income (loss):
Investment securities:
For the years ended December 31,
2021
2022
2023
$
16,678 $
35,709 $
8,000
Unrealized gain (loss), available for sale, net of tax expense (benefit) of
$951, ($12,993), and ($694), respectively
3,510
(48,019)
(2,611)
Reclassification of realized loss (gain), available for sale, net of tax
benefit (expense) of $67, ($1), and ($488), respectively
Unrealized loss, transfer from available for sale to held to maturity, net
of tax benefit of $0 for all respective periods
Derivative financial instruments:
Change in fair value of interest rate swaps designated as cash flow
hedges, net of tax expense of $0, $1,151, and $1,396, respectively
Reclassification of realized gain, interest rate swap termination, net of
tax expense of $0, $1,697, and $385, respectively
Total other comprehensive income (loss)
Total comprehensive income (loss)
256
(5)
(1,833)
—
(1)
(1)
—
4,329
5,253
—
3,766
20,444 $
(6,380)
(50,076)
(14,367) $
(1,450)
(642)
7,358
$
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
75
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
(Amounts in thousands, except share data)
Accumulated
Other
Retained Comprehensive Stockholders’
Total
Surplus Earnings Income (Loss) Equity
Common
Stock
$
$
Balance, December 31, 2020
Surrendered shares
Shares repurchased
Options exercised
Dividends declared, $0.31 per share
Stock-based compensation
Net income
Other comprehensive loss, net
Balance, December 31, 2021
Surrendered shares
Shares repurchased
Options exercised
Dividends declared, $0.365 per share
Stock-based compensation
Net income
Other comprehensive loss, net
Balance, December 31, 2022
$
Cumulative effect of adoption of ASU 2016-13, net
Surrendered shares
Shares repurchased
Options exercised
Dividends declared, $0.395 per share
Stock-based compensation
Net income
Other comprehensive income, net
Balance, December 31, 2023
$
(24)
(519)
10
—
92
—
—
(19)
(359)
47
—
65
—
—
71,385 $
10,609 $ 159,485 $
—
(348)
—
(6,566)
—
685
(3,225 )
—
—
1,676
8,000
—
—
—
76,160 $
10,343 $ 154,932 $
—
(462)
—
(10,021)
—
123
(3,663 )
—
—
2,015
35,709
—
—
—
9,902 $ 146,587 $ 108,206 $
(4,295 )
—
—
(330)
—
(2,804)
97
—
(3,878 )
—
1,906
—
—
16,678
—
—
9,748 $ 145,456 $ 116,711 $
—
(22)
(222)
8
—
82
—
—
1,805 $
—
—
—
—
—
—
(642)
1,163 $
—
—
—
—
—
—
(50,076)
(48,913) $
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
3,766
(45,147) $
243,284
(367)
(6,925)
732
(3,225)
1,741
8,000
(642)
242,598
(486)
(10,540)
133
(3,663)
2,107
35,709
(50,076)
215,782
(4,295)
(352)
(3,026)
105
(3,878)
1,988
16,678
3,766
226,768
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
76
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
(Amounts in thousands)
Cash flows from operating activities
Net income
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating
For the years ended December 31,
2021
2022
2023
$
16,678 $
35,709 $
8,000
activities:
Depreciation and amortization
Provision for credit losses
Net accretion of purchase accounting adjustments
Net (accretion) amortization of securities
Loss (gain) on call or sale of investment securities, net
Loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets, net
Loss (gain) on sale of other real estate owned, net
Gain on sale of loans to First Community Bank
Loss on early extinguishment of subordinated debt
FHLB stock dividend
Stock-based compensation
Deferred taxes
Net change in value of bank owned life insurance
Amortization of subordinated debt issuance costs
Change in the fair value of equity securities
Loans held for sale:
Originations
Proceeds from sales
Gain on sale of loans
Net change in:
Accrued interest receivable
Other assets
Accrued taxes and other liabilities
Net cash provided by operating activities
Cash flows from investing activities
Proceeds from sales of investment securities available for sale
Purchases of securities available for sale
Purchases of securities held to maturity
Proceeds from maturities, prepayments and calls of investment securities
available for sale
Proceeds from maturities, prepayments and calls of investment securities
held to maturity
Proceeds from redemption or sale of equity securities
Purchases of equity securities
Net decrease (increase) in loans
Proceeds from sales of other real estate owned
Purchases of other real estate owned
Proceeds from sales of fixed assets
Purchase of loans
Purchases of fixed assets
Purchases of bank owned life insurance
Purchases of other investments
Distributions from investments
Cash paid for branch sale to First Community Bank, net of cash received
Cash acquired from acquisition of Cheaha Financial Group, net of cash
paid
Net cash (used in) provided by investing activities
77
3,780
(2,000)
(274)
(62)
323
1,323
114
(75)
—
(642)
1,988
(350)
(1,417)
95
65
—
—
—
(518)
5,772
1,447
26,247
4,435
2,922
(95)
972
(6)
258
(9)
—
222
(152)
2,107
(655)
(1,305)
66
90
(624)
1,281
(37)
(1,394)
(1,732)
695
42,748
4,988
22,885
(1,560)
3,484
(2,321)
408
5
—
—
(40)
1,741
(547)
(1,143)
92
(214)
(10,235)
9,814
(199)
2,451
(3,086)
(1,042)
33,481
14,974
(107,904)
(14,056)
—
(181,636)
—
137,803
(255,455)
—
140,712
60,173
84,729
1,879
17,429
(4,196)
41,999
1,484
—
42
(163,842)
(1,072)
—
(617)
274
(596)
1,933
1,225
(11,615)
(225,090)
6,071
—
4,692
—
(1,056)
(5,000)
(718)
34
—
—
(73,490)
—
(350,987)
2,149
574
(523)
86,967
878
(501)
194
—
(3,318)
(8,000)
(233)
23
—
8,112
53,399
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS, CONTINUED
(Amounts in thousands)
Cash flows from financing activities
Net increase (decrease) in customer deposits
Net increase (decrease) in repurchase agreements
Net (decrease) increase in short-term FHLB advances
Net increase in borrowings under the Bank Term Funding Program
Repayment of long-term FHLB advances
Cash dividends paid on common stock
Payments to repurchase common stock
Proceeds from stock options exercised
Proceeds from subordinated debt, net of issuance costs
Extinguishment of subordinated debt
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
Net (decrease) increase in cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period
Cash and cash equivalents, end of period
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF CASH FLOW
INFORMATION
Cash payments for:
Income taxes
Interest on deposits and borrowings
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF NONCASH INVESTING
ACTIVITIES
Transfer from loans to other real estate owned
Transfer from bank premises and equipment to other real estate owned
For the years ended December 31,
2021
2022
2023
188,125
8,633
(333,500)
212,500
(30,000)
(3,844)
(3,026)
105
—
—
38,993
(8,250)
40,259
32,009 $
(38,249)
(5,783)
333,500
—
(25,000)
(3,552)
(10,540)
133
19,548
(18,600)
251,457
(56,782)
97,041
40,259 $
25,946
130
(42,000)
—
—
(3,090)
(6,925)
732
—
—
(25,207)
61,673
35,368
97,041
2,899 $
56,773
8,887 $
14,409
4,207
11,817
3,930 $
1,425
3,327 $
525
521
1,850
$
$
$
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
78
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
NOTE 1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
Nature of Operations
Investar Holding Corporation is a financial holding company headquartered in Baton Rouge, Louisiana, that provides, through
its wholly-owned subsidiary, Investar Bank, National Association (the “Bank”), full banking services, excluding trust services,
tailored primarily to meet the needs of individuals, professionals, and small to medium-sized businesses throughout its markets
in south Louisiana, southeast Texas and Alabama.
Basis of Presentation
The consolidated financial statements of Investar Holding Corporation and its wholly-owned subsidiary, the Bank (together, the
“Company”), have been prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America
(“GAAP”) and to generally accepted practices within the banking industry.
Segments
All of the Company’s banking operations are considered by management to be aggregated in one reportable operating
segment. Because the overall banking operations comprise substantially all of the consolidated operations, no separate segment
disclosures are presented in the accompanying consolidated financial statements.
Principles of Consolidation
The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and its wholly-owned subsidiary, the Bank. All
significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.
Use of Estimates
The preparation of statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the
reported amounts of assets and liabilities and the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial
statements as well as the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from
those estimates, and such differences could be material.
Material estimates that are particularly susceptible to significant change relate to the determination of the allowance for credit
losses. While management uses available information to recognize credit losses on loans, future additions to the
allowance may be necessary based on changes in economic conditions, changes in conditions of our borrowers’ industries or
changes in the condition of individual borrowers. As described below under “Accounting Standards Adopted in 2023,” the
Company adopted Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) 2016-13 effective January 1, 2023, which changed how the Company
accounts for the allowance for credit losses. In addition, regulatory agencies, as an integral part of their examination process,
periodically review the Company’s allowance for credit losses. Such agencies may require the Company to recognize additions
to the allowance based on their judgments about information available to them at the time of their examination. Because of these
factors, it is reasonably possible that the allowance for credit losses may change materially in the near term. However, the amount
of the change that is reasonably possible cannot be estimated.
Other estimates that are susceptible to significant change in the near term relate to the allowance for off-balance sheet credit
losses, the fair value of stock-based compensation awards, the determination of other-than-temporary impairments of securities,
and the fair value of financial instruments and goodwill.
The COVID-19 pandemic and, in 2022 and 2023, rising inflation and interest rates have made certain estimates more challenging,
including those discussed above.
79
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Investment Securities
The Company’s investments in securities are accounted for in accordance with applicable guidance contained in the Financial
Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”), which requires the classification of
securities into one of the following categories:
•
•
Securities to be held to maturity (“HTM”): bonds, notes, and debentures for which the Company has the positive intent
and ability to hold to maturity are reported at cost, adjusted for premiums and discounts that are recognized in interest
income using the interest method over the period to maturity.
Securities available for sale (“AFS”): available for sale securities consist of bonds, notes, and debentures that are
available to meet the Company’s operating needs. These securities are reported at fair value.
Unrealized holding gains and losses, net of tax, on available for sale securities are reported as a net amount in other
comprehensive income. Purchase premiums and discounts are recognized in interest income using the interest method over the
terms of the securities. Realized gains and losses on the sale of debt and equity securities are determined using the specific-
identification method and average price method, respectively.
The Company follows FASB guidance related to the recognition and presentation of other-than-temporary impairment. The
guidance specifies that if an entity does not have the intent to sell a debt security prior to recovery, the security would not be
considered other-than-temporarily impaired unless there is a credit loss. When an entity does not intend to sell the security, and
it is more likely than not that the entity will not have to sell the security before recovery of its cost basis, it will recognize the
credit component of an other-than-temporary impairment of a debt security in earnings and the remaining portion in other
comprehensive income.
See “Allowance for Credit Losses” below for the accounting treatment of the allowance of credit losses for AFS and HTM
securities.
Loans
The Company’s loan portfolio categories include real estate, commercial and consumer loans. Real estate loans are further
categorized into construction and development, 1-4 family residential, multifamily, farmland and commercial real estate loans.
The consumer loan category includes loans originated through indirect lending. Indirect lending, which is lending initiated
through third-party business partners, is largely comprised of loans made through automotive dealerships.
Loans that management has the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future or until maturity or pay-off are stated at the
unpaid principal balance outstanding, net of purchase premiums or discounts, deferred income (net of costs), any direct principal
charge-offs, and an allowance for credit losses. Interest on loans is calculated by using the effective interest rate on daily balances
of the principal amount outstanding. Loan origination fees, net of direct loan origination costs, and commitment fees, are deferred
and amortized as an adjustment to yield over the life of the loan, or over the commitment period, as applicable.
Loans are considered past due if the required principal and interest payments have not been received as of the date such payments
were due. Loans are ordinarily placed on nonaccrual when a loan is specifically determined to be impaired or when principal or
interest is delinquent for 90 days or more; however, management may elect to continue the accrual when the estimated net
realizable value of collateral is sufficient to cover the principal balance and the accrued interest. Any unpaid interest previously
accrued on nonaccrual loans is reversed from income. Interest income, generally, is not recognized on specific impaired loans
unless the likelihood of further loss is remote. Interest payments received on such loans are applied as a reduction of the loan
principal balance. Interest income on other nonaccrual loans is recognized only to the extent of interest payments received. A
loan may be returned to accrual status when all the principal and interest amounts contractually due are brought current and
future principal and interest amounts contractually due are reasonably assured, which is typically evidenced by a sustained period
of repayment performance by the borrower.
The Company follows the FASB accounting guidance on sales of financial assets, which includes participating interests in loans.
For loan participations that are structured in accordance with this guidance, the sold portions are recorded as a reduction of the
loan portfolio. Loan participations that do not meet the criteria are accounted for as secured borrowings.
See “Acquisition Accounting” below for accounting treatment of loans acquired through business acquisitions.
80
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Employee Retention Credit
The CARES Act provided for an Employee Retention Credit (“ERC”), which is a broad based refundable payroll tax credit that
incentivized businesses to retain employees on the payroll during the COVID-19 pandemic. The ERC is a credit against certain
employment taxes of up to $5,000 per employee for eligible employers based on certain wages paid after March 12, 2020 through
December 31, 2020. In 2021, the tax credit increased to up to $7,000 for each quarter, equal to 70% of qualified wages paid to
employees during a quarter, capped at $10,000 of qualified wages per employee per quarter. The ERC terminated effective
September 30, 2021. The Company qualified for the ERC based on the significant adverse financial impacts of the COVID-19
pandemic. In the fourth quarter of 2022, Company recorded a $2.3 million reduction to payroll taxes related to the second quarter
of 2021, and in the fourth quarter of 2021, the Company recorded a $1.9 million reduction to payroll taxes related to the first
quarter of 2021, which are included as part of “Salaries and employee benefits” in noninterest expense on the accompanying
consolidated statements of income for the years ended December 31, 2022 and 2021.
Allowance for Credit Losses
For reporting periods beginning on and after January 1, 2023, reflecting the adoption of ASU 2016-13:
The Company’s allowance for credit losses is determined using a current expected credit loss (“CECL”) model. The allowance
for credit losses represents the measurement of all expected credit losses for financial assets accounted for on an amortized cost
basis. Expected losses at the reporting date are calculated based on historical experience, current conditions, and reasonable and
supportable forecasts. The lifetime expected credit losses are recorded at the time the financial asset is originated or acquired and
adjusted each period as a provision for credit losses for changes in expected lifetime credit losses. The Company developed a
CECL model methodology that calculates expected credit losses over the life of the portfolio by analyzing the composition,
characteristics and quality of the loan and securities portfolios, as well as prevailing economic conditions and forecasts. The
Company’s CECL calculation estimates loan losses using a combination of discounted cash flow and remaining life analyses. To
the extent the lives of the loans in the portfolio extend beyond the period for which a reasonable and supportable forecast can be
made, when necessary, the model reverts back to the historical loss rates adjusted for qualitative factors related to current
conditions using a four-quarter reversion period.
lending commitments. For modeling purposes,
The allowance for credit losses is measured on a pool basis when similar risk characteristics exist and is maintained at an amount
which management believes is a current estimate of the expected credit losses for the full life of the relevant pool of loans and
related unfunded
include: agriculture and farmland,
automotive, commercial and industrial, construction and development, commercial real estate - nonowner-occupied and
multifamily, commercial real estate - owner-occupied, credit cards, home equity lines of credit and junior liens, consumer,
residential senior liens, and other loans, which primarily consist of public finance. Management periodically reassesses each pool
to confirm that the loans within the pool continue to share similar characteristics and risk profiles and to determine whether
further segmentation is necessary. For each pool of loans, the Company evaluates and applies qualitative adjustments to the
calculated allowance for credit losses based on several factors, including, but not limited to, changes in current and expected
future economic conditions, changes in the nature and volume of the portfolio, changes in levels of concentrations, changes in
the volume and severity of past due loans, changes in lending policies and personnel and changes in the competitive and
regulatory environment of the banking industry. The loss rates computed for each pool and expected pool-level funding rates are
applied to the related unfunded lending commitments to calculate an allowance for credit losses.
loan pools
Loans that do not share similar risk characteristics with other loans are excluded from the loan pools and individually evaluated
for impairment. Individually evaluated loans are loans for which it is probable that all the amounts due under the contractual
terms of the loan will not be collected. The allowance for credit losses on loans that are individually evaluated is based on a
comparison of the recorded investment in the loan with either the expected cash flows discounted using the loan’s original
effective interest rate, observable market price for the loan or the fair value of the collateral underlying certain collateral
dependent loans. The allowance for credit losses is established after input from management as well as our risk management
department and our special assets committee. For collateral dependent loans where the borrower is experiencing financial
difficulty, which the Company evaluates independently from the loan pool, the expected credit loss is measured as the difference
between the amortized cost basis of the loan and the fair value of the collateral, which is based on third-party appraisals. Credits
deemed uncollectible are charged to the allowance for credit losses. Provisions for credit losses and recoveries on loans previously
charged off are adjustments to the allowance for credit losses.
81
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Expected credit losses on AFS securities are recorded in an allowance for credit losses when management does not intend to sell
or believes that it is not more likely than not that they will be required to sell the securities prior to recovery of the securities’
amortized cost basis. If management has the intent to sell or believes it is more likely than not the Company will be required to
sell an impaired available for sale security before recovery of the amortized cost basis, the credit loss is recorded as a direct write-
down of the amortized cost basis. In evaluating AFS securities in an unrealized loss position for credit losses, the Company
considers the nature of the investments, the current market price, and the current interest rate environment, among other
factors. Declines in the fair value of AFS securities that are not considered credit related are recognized in accumulated other
comprehensive income.
Expected credit losses on HTM securities are recorded in an allowance for credit losses and estimated using a probability of loss
model based on reasonable and supportable forecasts. HTM securities are evaluated on a collective basis by security type. In
evaluating HTM securities in an unrealized loss position for credit losses, the Company considers the nature of the investments,
the current market price, and the current interest rate environment, among other factors.
See “Accounting Standards Adopted in 2023” below for additional information.
For reporting periods prior to January 1, 2023, prior to the adoption of ASU 2016-13:
Prior to the adoption of CECL, the Company established an allowance for loan losses in an amount that management believed
would be adequate to absorb probable losses inherent in the loan portfolio as of the balance sheet date based on evaluations of
the collectability of loans and prior loan loss experience. The evaluations took into consideration such factors as changes in the
nature and volume of the loan portfolio, overall portfolio quality, review of specific problem loans, and current economic
conditions that may affect the borrower’s ability to pay. This evaluation was inherently subjective as it required estimates that
were susceptible to significant revision as more information became available. Allowances for impaired loans were generally
determined based on collateral values or the present value of estimated cash flows. Credits deemed uncollectible were charged
to the allowance. Provisions for loan losses and recoveries on loans previously charged off were adjusted to the allowance. Past
due status was determined based on contractual terms.
The allowance consisted of allocated and general components. The allocated component related to loans that were classified as
impaired. For loans that were classified as impaired, an allowance was established when the discounted cash flows (or collateral
value or observable market price) of the impaired loan was lower than the carrying value of that loan. The general component
covered non-classified loans and was based on historical loss experience adjusted for qualitative factors. Based on management’s
review and observations made through qualitative review, management may apply qualitative adjustments to determine loss
estimates at a group and/or portfolio segment level as deemed appropriate. Management had an established methodology to
determine the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses that assessed the risks and losses inherent in the portfolio and portfolio
segments. The Company utilized an internally developed model that required judgment to determine the estimation method that
fit the credit risk characteristics of the loans in its portfolio and portfolio segments. Qualitative and environmental factors that
may not be directly reflected in quantitative estimates include: asset quality trends, changes in loan concentrations, new products
and process changes, changes and pressures from competition, changes in lending policies and underwriting practices, trends in
the nature and volume of the loan portfolio, changes in experience and depth of lending staff and management and national and
regional economic trends. The Company also considered third party or comparable company loss data. Changes in these factors
were considered in determining changes in the allowance for loan losses. The impact of these factors on the Company’s
qualitative assessment of the allowance for loan losses could change from period to period based on management’s assessment
of the extent to which these factors were already reflected in historic loss rates. The uncertainty inherent in the estimation process
was also considered in evaluating the allowance for loan losses.
Equity Securities
Equity securities primarily consist of Federal Home Loan Bank (“FHLB”) stock and Federal Reserve Bank of Atlanta (“FRB”)
stock. Members of the FHLB and FRB are required to own a certain amount of stock based on the level of borrowings and other
factors and may invest in additional amounts. FHLB stock and FRB stock is carried at cost, is restricted as to redemption, and is
periodically evaluated for impairment based on the ultimate recovery of par value. Both cash and stock dividends are reported as
income. Equity securities also include investments in our other correspondent banks including Independent Bankers Financial
Corporation and First National Bankers Bank stock. These investments are carried at cost which approximates fair value. The
balance of equity securities in our correspondent banks at December 31, 2023 and 2022 was $13.4 million and $26.0 million,
respectively.
82
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
In addition, equity securities include marketable securities in corporate stocks and mutual funds which totaled $1.2 million at
both December 31, 2023 and 2022.
Bank Premises and Equipment
Bank premises and equipment are stated at cost, less accumulated depreciation, with the exception of land, which is stated at
cost. Depreciation expense is computed using the straight-line method and is charged to expense over the estimated useful lives
of 39 years for buildings, five to 39 years for improvements, three to seven years for furniture and equipment, and one to five
years for computer equipment and software. Costs of major additions and improvements are capitalized. Expenditures for
maintenance and repairs are expensed as incurred. Gains or losses on the disposition of land, buildings, and equipment are
included in noninterest income on the consolidated statements of income.
The Company leases certain branch locations under operating lease agreements. The Company also leases certain office facilities
to outside parties under operating lessor agreements; however, such leases are not significant. The Company determines if an
arrangement is a lease at inception. Operating leases, with the exception of short-term leases, are included in operating lease
right-of-use (“ROU”) assets and operating lease liabilities in “Bank premises and equipment, net” and “Accrued taxes and other
liabilities”, respectively, in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. Operating lease ROU assets represent the right to use
an underlying asset for the lease term and operating lease liabilities represent the obligation to make lease payments arising from
the lease. Operating lease ROU assets and liabilities are recognized at the commencement date based on the present value of
lease payments over the lease term. As the Company’s leases do not provide an implicit rate, the Company uses its incremental
borrowing rate based on the information available at the commencement date in determining the present value of lease payments.
The operating lease ROU asset also includes any lease pre-payments made and excludes lease incentives. The Company’s lease
terms may include options to extend or terminate the lease. When it is reasonably certain that the Company will exercise an
option to extend a lease, the extension is included in the lease term when calculating the present value of lease payments.
Other Real Estate Owned
Real estate acquired through foreclosure, or other real estate owned on the consolidated balance sheets, is initially recorded at
fair value at the time of foreclosure, less estimated selling cost, and any related write down is charged to the allowance for credit
losses. Valuations are periodically performed by management and provisions for estimated losses on other real estate owned are
charged to expense when fair value is determined to be less than the carrying value.
Costs relative to the development and improvement of properties are capitalized to the extent realizable, whereas ordinary upkeep
disbursements are charged to expense. The ability of the Company to recover the carrying value of real estate is based upon
future sales of the other real estate owned. The ability to affect such sales is subject to market conditions and other factors, many
of which are beyond the Company’s control. Operating income and expense of such properties is included in other operating
income or expense, respectively, on the accompanying consolidated statements of income. Gain or loss on the disposition of such
properties is included in noninterest income on the consolidated statements of income.
Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets
Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase price over the fair value of the net identifiable assets acquired in a business
combination. Goodwill and other intangible assets deemed to have an indefinite useful life are not amortized but instead are
subject to review for impairment annually, or more frequently if deemed necessary, in accordance with the provisions of FASB
ASC Topic 350, “Intangibles – Goodwill and Other.”
Intangible assets with estimable useful lives are amortized over their respective estimated useful lives and reviewed for
impairment in accordance with FASB ASC Topic 360, “Property, Plant, and Equipment.” If impaired, the asset is written down
to its estimated fair value. No impairment charges have been recognized through December 31, 2023. Core deposit intangibles
representing the value of the acquired core deposit base are generally recorded in connection with business combinations
involving banks and branch locations. The Company’s policy is to amortize core deposit intangibles over the estimated useful
life of the deposit base. The remaining useful lives of core deposit intangibles are evaluated periodically to determine whether
events and circumstances warrant revision of the remaining period of amortization. The Company’s core deposit intangibles are
currently amortized using the sum-of-the-years-digits basis over 10 to 15 years. See Note 7. Goodwill and Other Intangible
Assets, for additional information.
83
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Bank Owned Life Insurance
The Company invests in bank owned life insurance (“BOLI”) policies that provide earnings to help cover the cost of employee
benefit plans. The Company is the owner and beneficiary of the life insurance policies it purchased directly on a chosen group
of employees. The policies are carried on the Company’s consolidated balance sheet at their cash surrender value and are subject
to regulatory capital requirements. The determination of the cash surrender value includes a full evaluation of the contractual
terms of each policy and assumes the surrender of policies on an individual-life by individual-life basis. Additionally, the
Company periodically reviews the creditworthiness of the insurance companies that have underwritten the policies. Earnings
accruing to the Company are derived from the general account investments of the insurance companies. Increases in the net cash
surrender value of BOLI policies and insurance proceeds received are not taxable and are recorded in noninterest income in the
consolidated statements of income.
Repurchase Agreements
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase are secured borrowings treated as financing activities and are carried at the
amounts at which the securities will be subsequently reacquired as specified in the respective agreements.
Stock-Based Compensation
The Company accounts for stock-based compensation under the provisions of ASC Topic 718, “Compensation - Stock
Compensation.” Under this accounting guidance, fair value is established as the measurement objective in accounting for share-
based payment awards and requires the application of a fair value based measurement method in accounting for compensation
costs, which is recognized over the requisite service period. The impact of forfeitures of share-based payment awards on
compensation expense is recognized as forfeitures occur. See Note 14. Stock-Based Compensation, for further disclosures
regarding stock-based compensation.
Off-Balance Sheet Credit-Related Financial Instruments
The Company accounts for its guarantees in accordance with the provisions of ASC Topic 460, “Guarantees.” In the ordinary
course of business, the Company has entered into commitments to extend credit, including commitments under credit card
agreements, commercial letters of credit and standby letters of credit. Such financial instruments are recorded when they are
funded.
Derivative Financial Instruments
ASC Topic 815, “Derivatives and Hedging,” requires that all derivatives be recognized as assets or liabilities in the balance sheet
at fair value. Derivatives executed with the same counterparty are generally subject to master netting arrangements, however,
fair value amounts recognized for derivative financial instruments and fair value amounts recognized for the right/obligation to
reclaim/return cash collateral are not offset for financial reporting purposes.
In the course of its business operations, the Company is exposed to certain risks, including interest rate, liquidity and credit risk.
The Company manages its risks through the use of derivative financial instruments, primarily through management of exposure
due to the receipt or payment of future cash amounts based on interest rates. The Company’s derivative financial instruments
manage the differences in the timing, amount and duration of expected cash receipts and payments.
Derivatives which are designated and qualify as a hedge of the exposure to variability in expected future cash flows, or other
types of forecasted transactions, are considered cash flow hedges. The effective portion of the derivative’s gain or loss is initially
reported as a component of other comprehensive income and subsequently reclassified into earnings when the forecasted
transaction affects earnings or when the hedge is terminated. The ineffective portion of the gain or loss is reported in earnings
immediately.
In applying hedge accounting for derivatives, the Company establishes a method for assessing the effectiveness of the hedging
derivative and a measurement approach for determining the ineffective aspect of the hedge upon the inception of the hedge.
These methods are consistent with the Company’s approach to managing risk. Note 12. Derivative Financial Instruments,
describes the derivative instruments currently used by the Company and discloses how these derivatives impact the Company’s
financial position and results of operations.
84
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Income Taxes
The provision for income taxes is based on amounts reported in the consolidated statements of income after exclusion of
nontaxable income such as interest on state and municipal securities. Also, certain items of income and expenses are recognized
in different time periods for financial statement purposes than for income tax purposes. Thus, provisions for deferred taxes are
recorded in recognition of such temporary differences.
Deferred taxes are determined utilizing a liability method whereby deferred tax assets are recognized for deductible temporary
differences and deferred tax liabilities are recognized for taxable temporary differences. Temporary differences are the
differences between the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and their tax bases. Deferred tax assets are reduced by a
valuation allowance when, in the opinion of management, it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax
assets will not be realized. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are adjusted for the effects of changes in tax laws and rates on the
date of enactment.
The Company has adopted accounting guidance related to accounting for uncertainty in income taxes, which sets out a consistent
framework to determine the appropriate level of tax reserves to maintain for uncertain tax positions.
The Company recognizes interest and penalties on income taxes as a component of income tax expense.
Revenue Recognition
The Company recognizes revenue in the consolidated statements of income as it is earned and when collectability is reasonably
assured. The primary source of revenue is interest income from interest-earning assets, which is recognized on the accrual basis
of accounting using the effective interest method. The recognition of revenues from interest-earning assets is based upon formulas
from underlying loan agreements, securities contracts, or other similar contracts. Noninterest income is recognized on the accrual
basis of accounting as services are provided or as transactions occur. Noninterest income includes fees from deposit accounts,
merchant services, automated teller machine (“ATM”) and debit card fees, servicing fees, interchange fees, and other
miscellaneous services and transactions.
Earnings Per Share
Basic earnings per share is calculated using the two-class method. The two-class method is an earnings allocation formula that
determines earnings per share separately for common stock and participating securities according to dividends declared and
participation rights in undistributed earnings. Under this method, all earnings distributed and undistributed, are allocated to
participating securities and common shares based on their respective rights to receive dividends. Unvested share-based payment
awards that contain nonforfeitable rights to dividends are considered participating securities (i.e. unvested time-vested restricted
stock), not subject to performance based measures.
Basic earnings per share is calculated by dividing net income available to common shareholders by the weighted average number
of common shares outstanding during the period. Diluted earnings per share is calculated in a manner similar to that of basic
earnings per share except that the weighted average number of common shares outstanding is increased to include the number of
additional common shares that would have been outstanding if all potentially dilutive common shares (such as those resulting
from the exercise of stock options and warrants) were issued during the period, computed using the treasury stock method.
Statements of Cash Flows
For purposes of the statements of cash flows, cash and cash equivalents include cash and amounts due from banks and federal
funds sold due to the short-term nature of these items.
Comprehensive Income
Comprehensive income includes net income and other comprehensive income or loss, which in the case of the Company includes
unrealized gains and losses on securities, changes in the fair value of interest rate swaps, and the reclassification of realized gains
on AFS securities and interest rate swap terminations to net income, net of related income taxes.
85
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Acquisition Accounting
The Company follows the FASB ASC Topic 805, “Business Combinations” (“ASC 805”) to determine the appropriate
accounting treatment for an acquisition. ASC 805 prescribes an initial fair value screen to determine if substantially all of the fair
value of the assets acquired is concentrated in a single asset or group of similar assets. If the initial screen test is met, the assets
acquired represent an asset acquisition rather than a business combination.
Loans acquired in an asset acquisitions are recorded using the cost accumulation and allocation model whereby the cost of the
acquisition is allocated on a relative fair value basis to the assets acquired.
Business combinations are accounted for under the acquisition method of accounting. Purchased assets and assumed liabilities
are recorded at their respective acquisition date fair values, and identifiable intangible assets are recorded at fair value. If the
consideration given exceeds the fair value of the net assets received, goodwill is recognized. If the fair value of the net assets
received exceeds the consideration given, a bargain purchase gain is recognized. Fair values are subject to refinement for up
to one year after the closing date of an acquisition as information relative to closing date fair values becomes available.
Loans acquired in a business combination are recorded at their estimated fair value as of the acquisition date. The fair value of
loans acquired is determined using a discounted cash flow model based on assumptions regarding the amount and timing of
principal and interest prepayments, estimated payments, estimated default rates, estimated loss severity in the event of defaults,
and current market rates. The fair value adjustment for performing acquired loans is accreted over the life of the loan using the
effective interest method. Estimated credit losses are included in the determination of fair value; therefore, an allowance for
credit losses is not recorded on the acquisition date. Subsequent to acquisition, acquired performing loans are evaluated using a
similar allowance methodology as the legacy portfolio. An allowance for credit losses is only recorded to the extent that the
required reserves exceed the unaccreted fair value adjustment.
The Company accounts for purchased credit deteriorated (“PCD”) assets under ASC Topic 326. The CECL estimate for PCD
assets is recognized through the allowance for credit losses with an offset to the amortized cost basis of the PCD asset at the date
of acquisition. Subsequent changes in the allowance for credit losses for PCD assets are recognized through a provision for credit
losses on loans.
Share Repurchases
The Louisiana Business Corporation Act does not include the concept of treasury stock. Rather, shares purchased by the Company
constitute authorized but unissued shares. Accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America state that
accounting for treasury stock shall conform to state law. The Company’s consolidated financial statements as of December 31,
2023, 2022 and 2021 reflect this principle. The cost of shares purchased by the Company has been allocated to common stock
and surplus balances.
Reclassifications
Certain reclassifications have been made to the 2022 and 2021 financial statements to conform to the 2023 presentation.
Accounting Standards Adopted in 2023
FASB ASC Topic 326 “Financial
Instruments – Credit Losses: Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial
Instruments” Update No. 2016-13 (“ASU 2016-13”). ASU 2016-13 became effective for the Company as a smaller reporting
company on January 1, 2023. ASU 2016-13, also referred to as the Current Expected Credit Loss (“CECL”) standard, requires
financial assets measured on an amortized cost basis, including loans and HTM debt securities, to be presented at an amount net
of an allowance for credit losses, which reflects expected losses for the full life of the financial asset. Unfunded lending
commitments are also within the scope of this topic. See “Allowance for Credit Losses” above for additional information on the
calculation of the allowance for credit losses under ASU 2016-13.
The Company adopted ASU 2016-13 using the modified retrospective approach for all loans and off-balance sheet credit
exposures measured at amortized cost, other than PCD financial assets. Results for reporting periods beginning after December
31, 2022 are presented in accordance with ASU 2016-13 while prior period amounts continue to be reported in accordance with
previously applicable GAAP.
86
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
CECL requires the measurement of all expected credit losses for financial assets held at the reporting date based on historical
experience, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts and requires enhanced disclosures related to the
significant estimates and judgments used in estimating credit losses, as well as the credit quality and underwriting standards of
an organization’s portfolio. Under prior GAAP, credit losses were not recognized until the occurrence of the loss was probable,
and entities, in general, did not attempt to estimate credit losses for the full life of financial assets. ASU 2016-13 does not specify
the method for measuring expected credit losses, and an entity is allowed to apply methods that reasonably reflect its expectations
of the lifetime credit loss estimate.
ASU 2016-13 also amended the accounting model for purchased financial assets and replaced the guidance for purchased credit
impaired (“PCI”) financial assets with the concept of PCDs. The Company used the prospective transition approach for PCD
loans that were previously classified as PCI and accounted for under ASC 310-30, “Loans and Debt Securities Acquired with
Deteriorated Credit Quality” (“ASC 310-30”). As permitted under ASU 2016-13, the Company did not reassess whether PCI
assets meet the criteria of PCD assets as of the date of adoption.
The Company adopted ASU 2016-13 on January 1, 2023, and recorded a one-time, cumulative effect adjustment as shown in the
table below (dollars in thousands).
Assets:
Allowance for credit losses
Deferred tax asset
Remaining purchase discount on loans(1)
Liabilities:
Reserve for unfunded loan commitments(2)
Stockholders’ Equity
Retained earnings
December 31,
2022
Impact of ASU
2016-13
Adoption
January 1,
2023
$
(24,364) $
16,438
(818)
(5,865) $
1,142
422
(30,229)
17,580
(396)
372
(6)
366
108,206
(4,295)
103,911
(1) For PCD loans, formerly classified as PCI, the Company applied the guidance under CECL using the prospective
transition approach. As a result, the Company adjusted the amortized cost basis of the PCD loans to reclassify the
purchase discount to the allowance for credit losses on January 1, 2023.
(2) The allowance for credit losses on unfunded loan commitments is included in “Accrued taxes and other liabilities” in
the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. The related provision for credit losses on unfunded loan commitments
is included in “Provision for credit losses” in the accompanying consolidated statements of income for the year ended
December 31, 2023.
In addition, ASU 2016-13 amends the accounting for credit losses on available for sale (“AFS”) securities, requiring expected
credit losses on AFS securities to be recorded in an allowance for credit losses rather than as a write-down of the securities’
amortized cost basis when management does not intend to sell or believes that it is not more likely than not that they will be
required to sell the securities prior to recovery of the securities’ amortized cost basis. The Company’s AFS and HTM securities
portfolios were not materially impacted by the adoption of ASU 2016-13 due to the composition of the portfolios, which consists
primarily of U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agencies and corporations securities and mortgage-backed securities. Due to the
nature of the investments, current market prices, and the current interest rate environment, the Company determined that the
declines in the fair values of the HTM and AFS securities portfolio were not attributable to credit losses. The Company will
apply the provisions of ASU 2016-13 to debt securities that have an other-than-temporary impairment on a prospective basis.
Accordingly, there was no adjustment made to the amortized cost basis upon adoption. The adoption of ASU 2016-13 did not
have a significant impact on the Company’s regulatory capital ratios.
FASB ASC Topic 326 “Financial Instruments – Credit Losses, Troubled Debt Restructurings and Vintage Disclosures” Update
No. 2022-02 (“ASU 2022-02”). ASU 2022-02 became effective for the Company on January 1, 2023 and is applied prospectively.
ASU 2022-02 amends Topic 326 to eliminate the accounting guidance for troubled debt restructurings (“TDRs”) by creditors
that have adopted ASU 2016-13 and, instead, requires that an entity evaluate whether the modification represents a new loan or
a continuation of an existing loan. The amendment also requires that public business entities disclose current-period gross charge-
offs by year of origination for financing receivables and net investments in leases. The adoption of ASU 2022-02 did not have a
material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
87
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
FASB ASC Topic 848 “Reference Rate Reform: Facilitation of the Effects of Reference Rate Reform on Financial
Reporting” Update No. 2020-04 (“ASU 2020-04”) and FASB ASC Topic 848 “Reference Rate Reform: Deferral of the Sunset
Date” Update No. 2022-06 (“ASU 2022-06”). In March 2020, the FASB issued ASU 2020-04, which is intended to provide
temporary optional expedients and exceptions to the GAAP guidance on contract modifications and hedge accounting to ease the
financial reporting burdens related to the expected market transition from the London Interbank Offered Rate (“LIBOR”) and
other interbank offered rates to alternative reference rates. ASU 2020-04 became effective as of March 12, 2020 and could be
adopted any time during the period of January 1, 2020 through December 31, 2022. In December 2022, the FASB issued
ASU 2022-06, which deferred the sunset date of ASU 2020-04 from December 31, 2022 to December 31, 2024. The Company
implemented a plan to transition all loans and other financial instruments, including certain indebtedness, with attributes that are
either directly or indirectly influenced by LIBOR to its preferred replacement index, the Secured Overnight Financing Rate
(“SOFR”). The Company has transitioned all loans and certain indebtedness. The adoption of ASU 2022-06 did not have a
material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
Recent Accounting Pronouncements
This section briefly describes accounting standards that have been issued, but are not yet adopted, that could impact the
Company’s financial statements.
FASB “Disclosure Improvements” Update No. 2023-06 (“ASU 2023-06”). In October 2023, the FASB issued ASU 2023-06,
which amends the disclosure or presentation requirements related to various topics. The amendment is intended to align U.S.
GAAP with the SEC’s regulations. ASU 2023-06 is required to be applied prospectively, and early adoption is prohibited. For
reporting entities subject to the SEC’s existing disclosure requirements, the effective dates of ASU 2023-06 will be the date on
which the SEC’s removal of that related disclosure requirement from Regulation S-X or Regulation S-K becomes effective. If
by June 30, 2027, the SEC has not removed the applicable requirement from Regulation S-X or Regulation S-K, the pending
content of the related amendment will be removed and will not become effective for any entities. ASU 2023-06 is not expected
to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
FASB ASC Topic 740 “Income Taxes - Improvements to Income Tax Disclosures” Update No. 2023-09 (“ASU 2023-09”). In
December 2023, the FASB issued ASU 2023-09, which enhances the transparency and decision usefulness of income tax
disclosures. ASU 2023-09 requires disclosure of additional categories of information about federal, state and foreign income
taxes in the rate reconciliation table and requires companies to provide more information about the reconciling items in some
categories if a quantitative threshold is met. The adoption of ASU 2023-09 is effective for fiscal years beginning after December
15, 2024 and is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
88
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
NOTE 2. INVESTMENT SECURITIES
The amortized cost and approximate fair value of investment securities classified as AFS are summarized below as of the dates
presented (dollars in thousands).
December 31, 2023
Obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agencies
and corporations
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
Corporate bonds
Residential mortgage-backed securities
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
Total
December 31, 2022
Obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agencies
and corporations
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
Corporate bonds
Residential mortgage-backed securities
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
Total
Amortized
Cost
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Fair Value
$
$
20,383 $
18,768
30,097
274,950
75,085
419,283 $
100 $
11
—
14
208
333 $
(440) $
(2,076)
(3,741)
(42,919)
(8,522)
(57,698) $
20,043
16,703
26,356
232,045
66,771
361,918
Amortized
Cost
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Fair Value
$
$
30,370 $
21,098
33,477
298,867
83,504
467,316 $
134 $
7
—
10
179
330 $
(699) $
(2,727)
(3,535)
(47,026)
(8,492)
(62,479) $
29,805
18,378
29,942
251,851
75,191
405,167
The Company calculates realized gains and losses on sales of debt securities under the specific identification method. Proceeds
from sales of investment securities classified as AFS and gross gains and losses are summarized below for the periods presented
(dollars in thousands).
Proceeds from sales
Gross gains
Gross losses
$
$
$
14,974 $
2 $
(325) $
— $
— $
— $
137,803
2,323
(2)
The amortized cost and approximate fair value of investment securities classified as HTM are summarized below as of the dates
presented (dollars in thousands).
Twelve months ended December 31,
2022
2021
2023
December 31, 2023
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
Residential mortgage-backed securities
Total
December 31, 2022
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
Residential mortgage-backed securities
Total
Amortized
Cost
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
$
$
18,163 $
2,309
20,472 $
314 $
—
314 $
Fair Value
18,395
2,118
20,513
(82) $
(191)
(273) $
Amortized
Cost
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
$
$
5,538 $
2,767
8,305 $
1 $
—
1 $
89
Fair Value
5,412
2,510
7,922
(127) $
(257)
(384) $
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Securities are classified in the consolidated balance sheets according to management’s intent. The Company had no securities
classified as trading as of December 31, 2023 or December 31, 2022.
The approximate fair value of AFS securities and unrealized losses, aggregated by investment category and length of time that
the individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position, are summarized below as of the dates presented
(dollars in thousands).
December 31, 2023
Obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S.
government agencies and corporations
Obligations of state and political
subdivisions
Corporate bonds
Residential mortgage-backed securities
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
Total
$
Less than 12 Months 12 Months or More
Total
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Losses
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Losses
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Losses
$
1,268 $
(7) $
9,284 $
(433) $
10,552 $
(440)
—
468
2,705
1,085
5,526 $
15,425
—
(28)
25,888
(421) 228,415
50,271
(35)
(491) $ 329,283 $
(2,076)
(3,713)
15,425
26,356
(42,498) 231,120
51,356
(57,207) $ 334,809 $
(8,487)
(2,076)
(3,741)
(42,919)
(8,522)
(57,698)
December 31, 2022
Obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S.
government agencies and corporations
Obligations of state and political
subdivisions
Corporate bonds
Residential mortgage-backed securities
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
Total
Less than 12 Months 12 Months or More
Total
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Losses
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Losses
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Losses
$
16,017 $
(688) $
1,013 $
(11) $
17,030 $
(699)
13,695
19,606
134,419
27,181
$ 210,918 $
(1,427)
(1,170)
4,524
10,085
(18,122) 116,132
32,432
(24,039) $ 164,186 $
(2,632)
(1,300)
(2,365)
18,219
29,691
(28,904) 250,551
59,613
(38,440) $ 375,104 $
(5,860)
(2,727)
(3,535)
(47,026)
(8,492)
(62,479)
At December 31, 2023, 698 of the Company’s AFS debt securities had unrealized losses totaling 14.7% of the individual
securities’ amortized cost basis and 13.8% of the Company’s total amortized cost basis of the AFS investment securities portfolio.
At such date, 682 of the 698 securities had been in a continuous loss position for over 12 months.
The approximate fair value of HTM securities, and unrealized losses, aggregated by investment category and length of time that
the individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position, are summarized below as of the dates presented
(dollars in thousands).
December 31, 2023
Obligations of state and political
subdivisions
Residential mortgage-backed securities
Total
Less than 12 Months 12 Months or More
Total
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Losses
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Losses
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Losses
$
$
— $
—
— $
— $
—
— $
3,064 $
2,118
5,182 $
(82) $
(191)
(273) $
3,064 $
2,118
5,182 $
(82)
(191)
(273)
December 31, 2022
Obligations of state and political
subdivisions
Residential mortgage-backed securities
Total
Less than 12 Months 12 Months or More
Total
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Losses
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Losses
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Losses
$
$
3,536 $
2,510
6,046 $
(127) $
(257)
(384) $
— $
—
— $
— $
—
— $
3,536 $
2,510
6,046 $
(127)
(257)
(384)
90
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Unrealized losses are generally due to changes in market interest rates. The Company has the intent to hold these securities either
until maturity or a forecasted recovery, and it is more likely than not that the Company will not have to sell the securities before
the recovery of their amortized cost basis. Due to the nature of the investments, current market prices, and the current interest
rate environment, the Company determined that these declines were not attributable to credit losses at December 31, 2023 and
2022.
The amortized cost and approximate fair value of investment debt securities, by contractual maturity, are shown below as of the
dates presented (dollars in thousands). Actual maturities may differ from contractual maturities due to mortgage-backed securities
whereby borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties and certain
callable bonds whereby the issuer has the option to call the bonds prior to contractual maturity.
Securities Available
For Sale
Securities Held to
Maturity
December 31, 2023
Due within one year
Due after one year through five years
Due after five years through ten years
Due after ten years
Total debt securities
December 31, 2022
Due within one year
Due after one year through five years
Due after five years through ten years
Due after ten years
Total debt securities
Amortized
Cost
Fair Value
Amortized
Cost
$
$
1,034 $
28,620
43,634
345,995
419,283 $
1,027 $
27,623
39,971
293,297
361,918 $
Fair Value
961
2,582
4,621
12,349
20,513
960 $
2,556
4,647
12,309
20,472 $
Securities Available
For Sale
Securities Held to
Maturity
Amortized
Cost
Fair Value
Amortized
Cost
$
$
1,082 $
32,452
52,093
381,689
467,316 $
1,072 $
31,394
48,229
324,472
405,167 $
Fair Value
915
961
3,536
2,510
7,922
915 $
960
3,663
2,767
8,305 $
Accrued interest receivable on the Company’s investment securities was $1.7 million at both December 31, 2023 and December
31, 2022, and is included in “Accrued interest receivable” on the accompanying consolidated balance sheets.
At December 31, 2023, securities with a carrying value of $296.2 million were pledged to secure certain deposits, borrowings,
and other liabilities, compared to $165.7 million in pledged securities at December 31, 2022.
NOTE 3. LOANS AND ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES
The Company’s loan portfolio consists of the following categories of loans as of the dates presented (dollars in thousands).
Construction and development
1-4 Family
Multifamily
Farmland
Commercial real estate
Total mortgage loans on real estate
Commercial and industrial
Consumer
Total loans
91
December 31,
2023
2022
190,371 $
413,786
105,946
7,651
937,708
1,655,462
543,421
11,736
2,210,619 $
201,633
401,377
81,812
12,877
958,243
1,655,942
435,093
13,732
2,104,767
$
$
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Unamortized premiums and discounts on loans, included in the total loans balances above, were $0.2 million and $0.8 million at
December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, respectively. Unearned income, or deferred fees, on loans was $1.1 million and
$1.3 million at December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, respectively, and is also included in the total loans balance in the
table above.
The table below provides an analysis of the aging of loans as of December 31, 2023 (dollars in thousands).
30 - 59
Days Past
Due
December 31, 2023
60 - 89
Days Past
Due
90 Days or
More Past
Due
Construction and development
1-4 Family
Multifamily
Farmland
Commercial real estate
Total mortgage loans on real
estate
Commercial and industrial
Consumer
Total loans
Current
$
189,746 $
406,014
105,946
7,651
937,272
1,646,629
542,206
11,552
$ 2,200,387 $
— $
3,031
—
—
48
3,079
259
57
3,395 $
55 $
1,720
—
—
359
2,134
488
82
2,704 $
> 90 Days
and
Accruing
—
—
—
—
—
Total
190,371 $
413,786
105,946
7,651
937,708
570 $
3,021
—
—
29
3,620 1,655,462
543,421
11,736
4,133 $ 2,210,619 $
468
45
—
—
—
—
The table below provides an analysis of nonaccrual loans as of December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022 (dollars in
thousands).
December 31, 2023
Nonaccrual
with No
Allowance
for Credit
Loss
Nonaccrual
with an
Allowance
for Credit
Loss
Total
Nonaccrual
Loans
December
31, 2022(1)
Total
Nonaccrual
Loans
Interest
Income
Recognized
on
Nonaccrual
Loans
$
$
577 $
2,937
—
—
216
3,730
59
74
3,863 $
212 $
1,241
—
—
—
1,453
409
45
1,907 $
789 $
4,178
—
—
216
5,183
468
119
5,770 $
42 $
26
—
10
416
494
997
15
1,506 $
372
1,207
—
62
6,032
7,673
2,183
130
9,986
Construction and development
1-4 Family
Multifamily
Farmland
Commercial real estate
Total mortgage loans on real estate
Commercial and industrial
Consumer
Total loans
(1) Nonaccrual loans previously reported as of December 31, 2022 excluded $0.5 million of nonaccrual acquired impaired
loans being accounted for under ASC 310-30.
92
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
The table below provides an analysis of the aging of loans as of December 31, 2022 (dollars in thousands).
Accruing
December 31, 2022
30-59
Days Past
Due
60-89
Days Past
Due
90 Days
or More
Past Due Nonaccrual
Total Past
Due &
Nonaccrual
Acquired
Impaired
Loans
Total
Loans
Current
$ 201,048 $
394,846
81,812
12,601
951,908
101 $
2,614
—
152
181
— $
1,220
—
62
22
112 $
1,188
—
—
—
372 $
1,207
—
62
5,523
585 $
6,229
—
276
5,726
— $ 201,633
302 401,377
81,812
—
—
12,877
609 958,243
Construction and
development
1-4 Family
Multifamily
Farmland
Commercial real estate
Total mortgage
loans on real
estate
1,642,215
Commercial and industrial 432,438
13,347
Consumer
$ 2,088,000 $
Total loans
3,048
406
171
3,625 $
1,304
15
27
1,346 $
1,300
51
—
1,351 $
7,164
2,183
130
9,477 $
12,816
2,655
328
15,799 $
911 1,655,942
— 435,093
13,732
57
968 $ 2,104,767
Nonaccrual and Past Due Loans
Loans are considered past due if the required principal and interest payments have not been received as of the date such payments
were due. Loans are placed on nonaccrual status when, in management’s opinion, the borrower may be unable to meet payment
obligations as they become due, as well as when required by regulatory provisions. In determining whether or not a
borrower may be unable to meet payment obligations for each class of loans, the borrower’s debt service capacity is considered
through the analysis of current financial information, if available, and/or current information with regard to the collateral position.
Regulatory provisions would typically require the placement of a loan on nonaccrual status if (i) principal or interest has been in
default for a period of 90 days or more unless the loan is both well secured and in the process of collection or (ii) full payment
of principal and interest is not expected. Loans may be placed on nonaccrual status regardless of whether or not such loans are
considered past due. When interest accrual is discontinued, all unpaid accrued interest is reversed. Interest income on nonaccrual
loans is recognized only to the extent that cash payments are received in excess of principal due. A loan may be returned to
accrual status when all the principal and interest amounts contractually due are brought current and payment of future principal
and interest amounts contractually due are reasonably assured, which is typically evidenced by a sustained period (at
least six months) of repayment performance by the borrower. Interest income recognized on nonaccrual loans shown in the table
above for the year ended December 31, 2023 was primarily attributable to the resolution of one oil and gas loan relationship.
Collateral Dependent Loans
Collateral dependent loans are loans for which the repayments, on the basis of the Company’s assessment at the reporting date,
are expected to be provided substantially through the operation or sale of the collateral and the borrower is experiencing financial
difficulty. Loans that do not share risk characteristics are excluded from the loan pools and evaluated on an individual basis, and
the Company has determined to evaluate collateral dependent loans individually for impairment. The allowance for credit losses
for collateral dependent loans is measured based on the difference between the fair value of the collateral and the amortized cost
basis of the asset as of the measurement date. When repayment is expected to be from the operation of the collateral, expected
credit losses are calculated as the amount by which the amortized cost basis of the financial asset exceeds the present value of
expected cash flows from the operation of the collateral. When repayment is expected to be from the sale of the collateral,
expected credit losses are calculated as the amount by which the amortized costs basis of the financial asset exceeds the fair value
of the underlying collateral less estimated cost to sell. The Company’s collateral dependent loans include all nonaccrual loans
shown in the table above at December 31, 2023. The types of collateral that secure collateral dependent loans are discussed under
“Portfolio Segment Risk Factors” below.
93
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Portfolio Segment Risk Factors
The following describes the risk characteristics relevant to each of the Company’s loan portfolio segments.
Construction and Development - Construction and development loans are generally made for the purpose of acquisition and
development of land to be improved through the construction of commercial and residential buildings. The successful repayment
of these types of loans is generally dependent upon a commitment for permanent financing from the Company, or from the sale
of the constructed property. These loans carry more risk than commercial or residential real estate loans due to the dynamics of
construction projects, changes in interest rates, the long-term financing market, and state and local government regulations. One
such risk is that loan funds are advanced upon the security of the property under construction, which is of uncertain value prior
to the completion of construction. Thus, it is more difficult to evaluate accurately the total loan funds required to complete a
project and to calculate related loan-to-value ratios. The Company attempts to minimize the risks associated with construction
lending by limiting loan-to-value ratios as described above. In addition, as to speculative development loans, the Company
generally makes such loans only to borrowers that have a positive pre-existing relationship with us. The Company manages risk
by using specific underwriting policies and procedures for these types of loans and by avoiding excessive concentrations in
any one business or industry. Construction and development loans are primarily secured by residential and commercial
properties, which are under construction and/or redevelopment.
1-4 Family - The 1-4 family portfolio mainly consists of residential mortgage loans to consumers to finance a primary residence.
The majority of these loans are secured by first liens on residential properties located in the Company’s market areas and carry
risks associated with the creditworthiness of the borrower and changes in the value of the collateral and loan-to-value-ratios. The
Company manages these risks through policies and procedures such as limiting loan-to-value ratios at origination, employing
experienced underwriting personnel, requiring standards for appraisers, and not making subprime loans. In the third quarter of
2023, we exited the consumer mortgage origination business.
Multifamily - Multifamily loans are normally made to real estate investors to support permanent financing for multifamily
residential income producing properties that rely on the successful operation of the property for repayment. This management
mainly involves property maintenance and collection of rents due from tenants. This type of lending carries a lower level of risk,
as compared to other commercial lending. In addition, underwriting requirements for multifamily properties are stricter than for
other nonowner-occupied property types. The Company manages this risk by avoiding concentrations with any particular
customer. Multifamily loans are primarily secured by first liens on multifamily real estate.
Farmland - Farmland loans are often for land improvements related to agricultural endeavors and may include construction of
new specialized facilities. These loans are usually repaid through the conversion to permanent financing, or if scheduled loan
amortization begins, for the long-term benefit of the borrower’s ongoing operations. Underwriting generally involves intensive
analysis of the financial strength of the borrower and guarantor, liquidation value of the subject collateral, the associated
unguaranteed exposure, and any available secondary sources of repayment, with the greatest emphasis given to a borrower’s
capacity to meet cash flow coverage requirements as set forth by Bank policies. Farmland loans are primarily secured by raw
land.
Commercial Real Estate - Commercial real estate loans are extensions of credit secured by owner occupied and nonowner-
occupied collateral. Underwriting generally involves intensive analysis of the financial strength of the borrower and guarantor,
liquidation value of the subject collateral, the associated unguaranteed exposure, and any available secondary sources of
repayment, with the greatest emphasis given to a borrower’s capacity to meet cash flow coverage requirements as set forth by
Bank policies. Commercial real estate loans typically depend on the successful operation and management of the businesses that
occupy these properties or the financial stability of tenants occupying the properties. Nonowner-occupied commercial real estate
loans typically are dependent, in large part, on the owner’s ability to rent the property and the ability of the tenants to pay rent,
whereas owner-occupied commercial real estate loans typically are dependent, in large part, on the success of the owner’s
business. General market conditions and economic activity may impact the performance of these types of loans, including
fluctuations in the value of real estate, new job creation trends, and tenant vacancy rates. The Company attempts to limit risk by
analyzing a borrower’s cash flow and collateral value on an ongoing basis. The Company also typically requires personal
guarantees from the principal owners of the property, supported by a review of their personal financial statements, as an additional
means of mitigating our risk. The Company manages risk by avoiding concentrations
in any one business or
industry. Commercial real estate loans are primarily secured by office and industrial buildings, warehouses, retail shopping
facilities and various special purpose commercial properties.
94
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Commercial and Industrial - Commercial and industrial loans receive similar underwriting treatment as commercial real estate
loans in that the repayment source is analyzed to determine its ability to meet cash flow coverage requirements as set forth by
Bank policies. Repayment of these loans generally comes from the generation of cash flow as the result of the borrower’s business
operations. Commercial lending generally involves different risks from those associated with commercial real estate lending or
construction lending. Although commercial loans may be collateralized by equipment or other business assets (including real
estate, if available as collateral), the repayment of these types of loans depends primarily on the creditworthiness and projected
cash flow of the borrower (and any guarantors). Thus, the general business conditions of the local economy and the borrower’s
ability to sell its products and services, thereby generating sufficient operating revenue to repay us under the agreed upon terms
and conditions, are the chief considerations when assessing the risk of a commercial loan. The liquidation of collateral, if any, is
considered a secondary source of repayment because equipment and other business assets may, among other things, be obsolete
or of limited resale value. The Company actively monitors certain financial measures of the borrower, including advance rate,
cash flow, collateral value and other appropriate credit factors. Commercial and industrial loans also include public finance
loans made to governmental entities, which can be taxable or tax-exempt, and are generally repaid using pledged revenue sources
including income tax, property tax, sales tax, and utility revenue, among other sources. Commercial and industrial loans are
primarily secured by accounts receivable, inventory and equipment.
Consumer - Consumer loans are offered by the Company in order to provide a full range of retail financial services to its
customers and include auto loans, credit cards, and other consumer installment loans. Typically, the Company evaluates the
borrower’s repayment ability through a review of credit scores and an evaluation of debt to income ratios. Repayment of consumer
loans depends upon key consumer economic measures and upon the borrower’s financial stability and is more likely to be
adversely affected by divorce, job loss, illness and personal hardships than repayment of other loans. A shortfall in the value of
any collateral also may pose a risk of loss to the Company for these types of loans. Consumer loans include loans primarily
secured by vehicles and unsecured loans.
Refer to Note 1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies – Accounting Standards Adopted in 2023 for loan pools used for
modeling purposes, which are aggregated into the portfolio segments shown above.
Concentrations of Credit
Substantially all of the Company’s loans and commitments have been granted to customers in the Company’s market areas in
south Louisiana, southeast Texas and Alabama. The distribution of commitments to extend credit approximates the distribution
of loans outstanding.
95
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Credit Quality Indicators
Loans are categorized into risk categories based on relevant information about the ability of borrowers to service their debt, such
as current financial information, historical payment experience, credit documentation, public information, and current economic
trends, among other factors. The following definitions are utilized for risk ratings, which are consistent with the definitions used
in supervisory guidance:
Pass - Loans not meeting the criteria below are considered pass. These loans have high credit characteristics and financial
strength. The borrowers at least generate profits and cash flow that are in line with peer and industry standards and have debt
service coverage ratios above loan covenants and our policy guidelines. For some of these loans, a guaranty from a financially
capable party mitigates characteristics of the borrower that might otherwise result in a lower grade.
Special Mention - Loans classified as special mention possess some credit deficiencies that need to be corrected to avoid a greater
risk of default in the future. For example, financial ratios relating to the borrower may have deteriorated. Often, a special mention
categorization is temporary while certain factors are analyzed or matters addressed before the loan is re-categorized as either pass
or substandard.
Substandard - Loans classified as substandard are inadequately protected by the current net worth and paying capacity of the
borrower or the liquidation value of any collateral. If deficiencies are not addressed, it is likely that this category of loan will
result in the Bank incurring a loss. Where a borrower has been unable to adjust to industry or general economic conditions, the
borrower’s loan is often categorized as substandard.
Doubtful - Loans classified as doubtful have all the weaknesses inherent in those classified as substandard, with the added
characteristic that the weaknesses make collection or liquidation in full, on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions, and
values, highly questionable and improbable.
Loss - Loans classified as loss are considered uncollectible and of such little value that their continuance as recorded assets
is not warranted. This classification does not mean that the assets have absolutely no recovery or salvage value, but rather it
is not practical or desirable to defer writing off these assets.
96
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
The table below presents the Company’s loan portfolio by year of origination, category, and credit quality indicator as of
December 31, 2023 (dollars in thousands). Loans acquired are shown in the table by origination year. The Company had an
immaterial amount of revolving loans converted to term loans at December 31, 2023.
Construction and development
Pass
Special Mention
Substandard
Total construction and development
Current-period gross charge-offs
1-4 Family
Pass
Special Mention
Substandard
Total 1-4 family
Current-period gross charge-offs
Multifamily
Pass
Special Mention
Substandard
Total multifamily
Current-period gross charge-offs
Farmland
Pass
Special Mention
Substandard
Total farmland
Current-period gross charge-offs
Commercial real estate
Pass
Special Mention
Substandard
Total commercial real estate
Current-period gross charge-offs
Commercial and industrial
Pass
Special Mention
Substandard
Total commercial and industrial
Current-period gross charge-offs
Consumer
Pass
Special Mention
Substandard
Total consumer
Current-period gross charge-offs
Total loans
Pass
Special Mention
Substandard
Total loans
Current-period gross charge-offs
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
2023
2022
2021
2020
2019
Prior
Revolving
Loans
Total
December 31, 2023
51,811 $
3,063
—
54,874 $
83,668 $
—
293
83,961 $
25,169 $
767
489
26,425 $
2,661 $
—
—
2,661 $
935 $
—
—
935 $
4,012 $
—
7
4,019 $
17,496 $
—
—
17,496 $
185,752
3,830
789
190,371
— $
— $
— $
— $
— $
— $
— $
—
43,047 $
—
179
43,226 $
101,479 $
—
1,949
103,428 $
85,340 $
477
257
86,074 $
58,926 $
—
162
59,088 $
26,836 $
—
963
27,799 $
59,115 $
—
1,510
60,625 $
33,454 $
—
92
33,546 $
408,197
477
5,112
413,786
(22) $
— $
— $
— $
(21) $
(3) $
— $
(46)
7,839 $
—
—
7,839 $
64,932 $
—
—
64,932 $
16,300 $
—
—
16,300 $
5,045 $
—
—
5,045 $
633 $
—
—
633 $
6,969 $
4,068
—
11,037 $
160 $
—
—
160 $
101,878
4,068
—
105,946
— $
— $
— $
— $
— $
— $
— $
—
1,762 $
—
—
1,762 $
1,347 $
—
—
1,347 $
727 $
—
—
727 $
936 $
—
—
936 $
775 $
—
—
775 $
1,013 $
—
76
1,089 $
1,015 $
—
—
1,015 $
7,575
—
76
7,651
— $
— $
— $
— $
— $
— $
— $
—
76,043 $
—
—
76,043 $
269,311 $
—
—
269,311 $
218,780 $
181
—
218,961 $
175,604 $
—
1,474
177,078 $
82,909 $
—
172
83,081 $
105,083 $
—
3,233
108,316 $
4,731 $
—
187
4,918 $
932,461
181
5,066
937,708
— $
— $
— $
— $
(2) $
(25) $
— $
(27)
60,123 $
—
49
60,172 $
139,543 $
—
78
139,621 $
31,459 $
—
154
31,613 $
14,244 $
—
7
14,251 $
7,439 $
—
416
7,855 $
14,290 $
—
8
14,298 $
273,208 $
2,289
114
275,611 $
540,306
2,289
826
543,421
— $
— $
(190) $
— $
(7) $
(31) $
(193) $
(421)
4,881 $
—
4
4,885 $
2,303 $
—
7
2,310 $
1,611 $
—
1
1,612 $
734 $
—
14
748 $
250 $
—
4
254 $
1,130 $
—
139
1,269 $
658 $
—
—
658 $
11,567
—
169
11,736
(119) $
(22) $
(10) $
(12) $
(5) $
(58) $
(22) $
(248)
245,506 $
3,063
232
248,801 $
662,583 $
—
2,327
664,910 $
379,386 $
1,425
901
381,712 $
258,150 $
—
1,657
259,807 $
119,777 $
—
1,555
121,332 $
191,612 $
4,068
4,973
200,653 $
330,722 $
2,289
393
333,404 $
2,187,736
10,845
12,038
2,210,619
(141) $
(22) $
(200) $
(12) $
(35) $
(117) $
(215) $
(742)
97
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
The table below presents the Company’s loan portfolio by category and credit quality indicator as of December 31, 2022 (dollars
in thousands) under the previous incurred loss methodology.
December 31, 2022
Construction and development
1-4 Family
Multifamily
Farmland
Commercial real estate
Total mortgage loans on real estate
Commercial and industrial
Consumer
Total loans
Special
Mention Substandard Doubtful
$
Pass
198,967 $
399,143
81,812
12,815
942,927
1,635,664
427,430
13,636
$ 2,076,730 $
1,593 $
—
—
—
6,101
7,694
5,140
—
12,834 $
1,073 $
2,234
—
62
9,215
12,584
2,336
96
15,016 $
Total
201,633
— $
401,377
—
81,812
—
12,877
—
—
958,243
— 1,655,942
435,093
187
—
13,732
187 $ 2,104,767
The Company had no loans that were classified as doubtful or loss at December 31, 2023. The Company had no loans that were
classified as loss at December 31, 2022.
Loan Participations and Sold Loans
Loan participations and whole loans sold to and serviced for others are not included in the accompanying consolidated balance
sheets. The balances of the participations and whole loans sold were $25.9 million and $16.9 million as of December 31, 2023
and 2022, respectively. The unpaid principal balances of these loans were approximately $99.8 million and $92.9 million at
December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively.
Loans to Related Parties
In the ordinary course of business, the Company makes loans to related parties including its executive officers, principal
shareholders, directors and their immediate family members, as well as to companies in which these individuals are principal
owners. Loans outstanding to such related party borrowers amounted to approximately $46.0 million and $97.0 million as of
December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, respectively. No related party loans were classified as nonperforming or nonaccrual
at December 31, 2023 or December 31, 2022.
The table below shows the aggregate principal balance of loans to such related parties for the years ended December 31, 2023
and 2022 (dollars in thousands).
Balance, beginning of period
New loans/changes in relationship
Repayments/changes in relationship
Balance, end of period
Allowance for Credit Losses
December 31,
2023
2022
$
$
96,977 $
2,570
(53,547)
46,000 $
97,606
14,570
(15,199)
96,977
The Company made the accounting policy election to exclude accrued interest receivable from the amortized cost of loans and
the estimate of
loans was
$12.7 million and $10.8 million at December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, respectively, and is included in “Accrued
interest receivable” on the accompanying consolidated balance sheets.
the allowance for credit
interest receivable on
losses. Accrued
the Company’s
Refer to Note 1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies – Allowance for Credit Losses and – Accounting Standards
Adopted in 2023 for more information on the adoption of ASU 2016-13.
98
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
The table below shows a summary of the activity in the allowance for credit losses for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022
and 2021 (dollars in thousands).
Balance, beginning of period
ASU 2016-13 adoption impact(1)
Provision for credit losses on loans(2)(3)
Charge-offs
Recoveries
Balance, end of period
2023
December 31,
2022
2021
$
$
24,364 $
5,865
(1,964)
(742)
3,017
30,540 $
20,859 $
—
2,922
(633)
1,216
24,364 $
20,363
—
22,885
(22,636)
247
20,859
(1) On January 1, 2023, the Company adopted ASU 2016-13, which introduced a new model known as CECL. Refer
to Note 1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies for more information on the adoption of ASU 2016-
13. Amounts as of December 31, 2023 reflect the impact of adopting the CECL accounting standard and the Company’s
transition from a probable incurred loss methodology to the current expected credit loss methodology. Prior period
amounts represent the allowance for loan losses under the probable incurred loss methodology.
(2) For the year ended December 31, 2023, the $2.0 million negative provision for credit losses on the consolidated
statement of income includes a $2.0 million negative provision for loan losses and a $36,000 negative provision for
unfunded loan commitments.
(3) For the year ended December 31, 2021, the provision for loan losses includes a $21.6 million impairment recorded
for one of the Company’s loan relationships as a result of Hurricane Ida. The corresponding loan balances in the same
amount were then charged off.
The following tables outline the activity in the allowance for credit losses by collateral type for the years ended December 31,
2023, 2022 and 2021, and show both the allowance and portfolio balances for loans individually and collectively evaluated for
impairment as of December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 (dollars in thousands). Amounts as of December 31, 2023 reflect the impact
of adopting the CECL accounting standard and the Company’s transition from a probable incurred loss methodology to the
current expected credit loss methodology. Prior period amounts represent the allowance for loan losses under the probable
incurred loss methodology.
December 31, 2023
Construction
&
Development
1-4
Commercial
&
Commercial
Real Estate
Family Multifamily Farmland
Industrial Consumer Total
Allowance for credit losses:
Beginning balance
ASU 2016-13 adoption impact
Provision for credit losses on
loans
Charge-offs
Recoveries
Ending balance
Ending allowance balance for
$
$
loans individually evaluated for
impairment
Ending allowance balance for
loans collectively evaluated for
impairment
Loans receivable:
Balance of loans individually
evaluated for impairment
Balance of loans collectively
evaluated for impairment
Total period-end balance
$
2,555 $
(75)
3,917 $
4,712
999 $
(84)
113 $
(99)
10,718 $
676
(84)
—
75
2,471 $
524
(46)
22
9,129 $
209
—
—
1,124 $
(12)
—
—
2 $
(2,922)
(27)
2,246
10,691 $
5,743 $
793
213
(421)
592
6,920 $
319 $
(58)
24,364
5,865
108
(248)
82
203 $
(1,964)
(742)
3,017
30,540
212
187
—
—
—
114
25
538
2,259
8,942
1,124
2
10,691
6,806
178
30,002
789
4,178
—
—
216
468
119
5,770
189,582 409,608
190,371 $413,786 $
105,946
105,946 $
7,651
7,651 $
937,492
937,708 $
542,953
11,617 2,204,849
543,421 $ 11,736 $2,210,619
99
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2022
Construction
&
Development
1-4
Commercial
&
Commercial
Real Estate
Family Multifamily Farmland
Industrial Consumer Total
Allowance for credit losses:
Beginning balance
$
Provision for credit losses on loans
Charge-offs
Recoveries
Ending balance
Ending allowance balance for
$
loans individually evaluated for
impairment
Ending allowance balance for
loans acquired with deteriorated
credit quality
Ending allowance balance for
loans collectively evaluated for
impairment
Loans receivable:
Balance of loans individually
evaluated for impairment
Balance of loans acquired with
deteriorated credit quality
Balance of loans collectively
evaluated for impairment
Total period-end balance
$
2,347 $
160
—
48
2,555 $
3,337 $
477
(11)
114
3,917 $
673 $
326
—
—
999 $
383 $
(283)
(54)
67
113 $
9,354 $
1,331
29
4
10,718 $
4,411 $
797
(397)
932
5,743 $
354 $
114
(200)
51
319 $
20,859
2,922
(633)
1,216
24,364
26
46
—
—
36
112
63
283
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
2,529
3,871
999
113
10,682
5,631
256
24,081
591
1,479
—
302
—
—
62
5,936
2,241
130
10,439
—
609
—
57
968
201,042 399,596
201,633 $401,377 $
81,812
12,815
81,812 $ 12,877 $
951,698
958,243 $
432,852
13,545 2,093,360
435,093 $ 13,732 $2,104,767
December 31, 2021
Construction
&
Development
1-4
Commercial
&
Commercial
Real Estate
Family Multifamily Farmland
Industrial Consumer Total
Allowance for credit losses:
Beginning balance
Provision for credit losses on
loans
Charge-offs
Recoveries
Ending balance
Ending allowance balance for
$
2,375 $
3,370 $
589 $
435 $
8,496 $
4,558 $
540 $
20,363
219
(283)
36
2,347 $
123
(188)
32
3,337 $
84
—
—
673 $
(39)
(13)
—
383 $
11,132
(10,280)
6
9,354 $
11,494
(11,713)
72
4,411 $
(128)
(159)
101
354 $
22,885
(22,636)
247
20,859
$
loans individually evaluated for
impairment
Ending allowance balance for
loans acquired with deteriorated
credit quality
Ending allowance balance for
loans collectively evaluated for
impairment
Loans receivable:
Balance of loans individually
evaluated for impairment
Balance of loans acquired with
deteriorated credit quality
Balance of loans collectively
evaluated for impairment
Total period-end balance
$
—
—
—
—
—
468
96
564
—
—
—
210
—
—
—
210
2,347
3,337
673
173
9,354
3,943
258
20,085
529
1,995
—
79
16,685
13,321
182
32,791
—
348
—
1,701
636
—
64
2,749
202,675 361,964
203,204 $364,307 $
59,570
18,348
59,570 $ 20,128 $
879,056
896,377 $
297,510
17,349 1,836,472
310,831 $ 17,595 $1,872,012
100
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Loan Modifications to Borrowers Experiencing Financial Difficulty
In January 2023, the Company adopted ASU 2022-02, which eliminated the accounting guidance for TDRs while enhancing
disclosure requirements for certain loan refinancings and restructurings by creditors when a borrower is experiencing financial
difficulty. ASU 2022-02 became effective for the Company on January 1, 2023. See Note 1. Summary of Significant Accounting
Policies – Accounting Standards Adopted in 2023.
Occasionally, the Company modifies loans to borrowers in financial distress by providing certain concessions, such as principal
forgiveness, term extension, an other-than-insignificant payment delay, an interest rate reduction, or a combination of such
concessions. When principal forgiveness is provided, the amount of forgiveness is charged-off against the allowance for credit
losses. Upon the Company’s determination that a modified loan (or portion of a loan) has subsequently been deemed
uncollectible, the loan (or portion of the loan) is written off. During the year ended December 31, 2023, the amount of loans that
were modified to borrowers experiencing financial difficulty was immaterial.
The following disclosures are presented under GAAP in effect prior to the adoption of CECL that are no longer applicable or
required. The Company has included these disclosures to address the applicable prior periods.
Pre-Adoption of CECL - Impaired Loans
The Company considered a loan to be impaired when, based on current information and events, the Company determined that it
was probable that it would not be able to collect all amounts due according to the loan agreement, including scheduled interest
payments. Determination of impairment was treated the same across all classes of loans. When the Company identified a loan as
impaired, it measured the impairment based on the present value of expected future cash flows, discounted at the loan’s effective
interest rate, except when the sole (remaining) source of repayment for the loans was the operation or liquidation of the collateral.
In those cases when foreclosure was probable, the Company used the current fair value of the collateral, less selling costs, instead
of discounted cash flows. If the Company determined that the value of the impaired loan was less than the recorded investment
in the loan (net of previous charge-offs, deferred loan fees or costs, and unamortized premium or discount), the Company
recognized impairment through an allowance estimate or a charge-off to the allowance.
When the ultimate collectability of the total principal of an impaired loan was in doubt and the loan was on nonaccrual, all
payments were applied to principal, under the cost recovery method. When the ultimate collectability of the total principal of an
impaired loan was not in doubt and the loan was on nonaccrual, contractual interest was credited to interest income when
received, under the cash basis method.
101
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
The following tables contain information on the Company’s impaired loans at December 31, 2022 and 2021. The average
recorded investment was calculated based on the month-end balances of the loans during the period reported (dollars in
thousands).
With no related allowance recorded:
Construction and development
1-4 Family
Farmland
Commercial real estate
Total mortgage loans on real estate
Commercial and industrial
Consumer
Total
With related allowance recorded:
Construction and development
1-4 Family
Commercial real estate
Total mortgage loans on real estate
Commercial and industrial
Consumer
Total
Total loans:
Construction and development
1-4 Family
Farmland
Commercial real estate
Total mortgage loans on real estate
Commercial and industrial
Consumer
Total
As of and for the year ended December 31, 2022
Recorded
Investment
Unpaid
Principal
Balance
Related
Allowance
Average
Recorded
Investment
Interest
Income
Recognized
$
366 $
1,005
62
5,746
7,179
1,996
34
9,209
225
474
190
889
245
96
1,230
375 $
1,082
70
21,016
22,543
2,530
45
25,118
498
484
190
1,172
292
123
1,587
591
1,479
62
5,936
8,068
2,241
130
10,439 $
873
1,566
70
21,206
23,715
2,822
168
26,705 $
$
— $
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
26
46
36
108
112
63
283
26
46
—
36
108
112
63
283 $
300 $
821
68
10,515
11,704
6,868
56
18,628
225
205
32
462
421
96
979
525
1,026
68
10,547
12,166
7,289
152
19,607 $
15
17
—
28
60
70
—
130
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
15
17
—
28
60
70
—
130
102
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
As of and for the year ended December 31, 2021
Recorded
Investment
Unpaid
Principal
Balance
Related
Allowance
Average
Recorded
Investment
Interest
Income
Recognized
$
529 $
1,995
79
16,685
19,288
9,395
55
28,738
812 $
2,081
81
27,139
30,113
10,941
69
41,123
— $
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
731 $
1,965
193
10,790
13,679
9,166
96
22,941
3,926
127
4,053
9,618
164
9,782
468
96
564
1,311
146
1,457
529
1,995
79
16,685
19,288
13,321
182
32,791 $
812
2,081
81
27,139
30,113
20,559
233
50,905 $
$
—
—
—
—
—
468
96
564 $
731
1,965
193
10,790
13,679
10,477
242
24,398 $
17
30
—
181
228
152
—
380
24
—
24
17
30
—
181
228
176
—
404
With no related allowance recorded:
Construction and development
1-4 Family
Farmland
Commercial real estate
Total mortgage loans on real estate
Commercial and industrial
Consumer
Total
With related allowance recorded:
Commercial and industrial
Consumer
Total
Total loans:
Construction and development
1-4 Family
Farmland
Commercial real estate
Total mortgage loans on real estate
Commercial and industrial
Consumer
Total
Pre-Adoption of CECL - Troubled Debt Restructurings
In situations where, for economic or legal reasons related to a borrower’s financial difficulties, the Company granted a concession
for other than an insignificant period of time to the borrower that the Company would not otherwise consider, the related loan
was classified as a TDR. The Company strived to identify borrowers in financial difficulty early and work with them to modify
their loans to more affordable terms before such loans reach nonaccrual status. These modified terms included rate reductions,
principal forgiveness, payment forbearance and other actions intended to minimize the economic loss and to avoid foreclosure or
repossession of the collateral. In cases in which the Company granted the borrower new terms that provided for a reduction of
either interest or principal, or otherwise included a concession, the Company identified the loan as a TDR and measured any
impairment on the restructuring as previously noted for impaired loans.
During the year ended December 31, 2022, three loans were modified as TDRs through adjustments to maturity. There
were no loans modified as TDRs during the previous twelve month period that subsequently defaulted during the year
ended December 31, 2022.
At December 31, 2022, there were no available balances on loans classified as TDRs that the Company was committed to lend.
103
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
The table below presents the TDR pre- and post-modification outstanding recorded investments by loan category for loans
modified during the year ended December 31, 2022 (amounts in thousands, except number of loans).
Troubled debt restructurings
Commercial real estate
Commercial and industrial
Number of
Contracts
December 31, 2022
Pre-
Post-
Modification Modification
Outstanding Outstanding
Recorded
Investment
Recorded
Investment
1 $
2
$
186 $
58
244 $
186
58
244
The following is a summary of accruing and nonaccrual TDRs and the related allowance by portfolio type at December 31, 2022
(dollars in thousands).
December 31, 2022
Construction and development
1-4 Family
Commercial real estate
Commercial and industrial
Total
Accruing Nonaccrual
Total
Related
Allowance
TDRs
$
$
219 $
271
413
58
961 $
— $
127
804
1,092
2,023 $
219 $
398
1,217
1,150
2,984 $
—
—
—
—
—
The table below includes the average recorded investment and interest income recognized for TDRs for the years ended
December 31, 2022 and 2021. The average recorded investment was calculated based on the month-end balances of the loans
during the period reported (dollars in thousands).
TDRs
Average
Recorded
Investment
Interest
Income
Recognized
$
$
$
$
230 $
489
1,249
3,511
5,479 $
251 $
775
5,358
6,698
13,082 $
15
16
28
70
129
17
28
174
149
368
December 31, 2022
Construction and development
1-4 Family
Commercial real estate
Commercial and industrial
Total
December 31, 2021
Construction and development
1-4 Family
Commercial real estate
Commercial and industrial
Total
104
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
NOTE 4. OTHER REAL ESTATE OWNED
The table below shows the activity in other real estate owned for the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022 (dollars in
thousands).
Balance, beginning of period
Additions
Transfers from bank premises and equipment
Sales of other real estate owned
Balance, end of period
Year ended
December 31,
2023
Year ended
December 31,
2022
$
$
682 $
3,930
1,425
(1,599)
4,438 $
2,653
3,327
525
(5,823)
682
For the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022, additions to other real estate owned of $2.7 million and $1.6 million,
respectively, were related to transfers of properties related to one loan relationship that became impaired in the third quarter of
2021 as a result of Hurricane Ida. For the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022, additions to other real estate owned of
$0.3 million and $1.7 million, respectively, were related to acquired loans. During the year ended December 31, 2023, the
Company closed one branch and one stand-alone ATM and transferred the associated land and buildings from “Bank premises
and equipment, net” to “Other real estate owned, net” in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets, as the Company did not
intend to use the properties for banking operations. In 2022, the Company closed two branches, and transferred the land and
building associated with one of the closed branches from “Bank premises and equipment, net” to “Other real estate owned, net” in
the accompanying consolidated balance sheets, as the Company did not intend to use the properties for banking operations; the
property was sold later in the year. At December 31, 2023 and 2022, approximately $0.5 million and $0.6 million, respectively,
of loans secured by 1-4 family residential property were in the process of foreclosure.
NOTE 5. BANK PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT
Bank premises and equipment consisted of the following as of the dates indicated (dollars in thousands).
Land
Buildings and improvements
Furniture and equipment
Software
Construction-in-progress
Right-of-use asset
Less: Accumulated depreciation and amortization
Bank premises and equipment, net
December 31,
2023
2022
10,206 $
39,198
10,317
1,668
158
2,112
(19,476)
44,183 $
11,490
40,799
13,569
2,334
575
2,845
(22,025)
49,587
$
$
Depreciation and amortization related to Bank premises and equipment charged to noninterest expense was approximately
$3.0 million, $3.5 million and $4.0 million for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, respectively.
During the year ended December 31, 2023, the Company completed the sale of the Alice and Victoria, Texas locations. The
Company also closed one branch and one stand-alone ATM in Louisiana and transferred the associated land and buildings,
totaling $1.4 million, from “Bank premises and equipment, net” to “Other real estate owned, net” in the accompanying
consolidated balance sheets. The Company also ceased operation of 13 additional ATMs during the third quarter of 2023. During
the year ended December 31, 2023, the Company recognized a loss of $1.3 million included in “Loss on sale or disposition of
fixed assets, net” in the accompanying consolidated statements of income. During the year ended December 31, 2022, the
Company closed two branch locations and sold three tracts of land being held for future branch locations. The land and building
associated with one of the closed branch locations, totaling $0.5 million, was reclassified from “Bank premises and equipment,
net” to “Other real estate owned, net” in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. During the year ended December 31,
2022, the Company recognized a loss of $0.3 million included in “Loss on sale or disposition of fixed assets, net” in the
accompanying consolidated statements of income.
105
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
NOTE 6. LEASES
The Company’s primary leasing activities relate to certain real estate leases entered into in support of the Company’s branch
operations. The Company’s lease agreements under which its branch locations are operated have all been designated as operating
leases. The Company does not lease equipment under operating leases, nor does it have leases designated as finance leases.
The Company determines if an arrangement is a lease at inception. Operating leases, with the exception of short-term leases, are
included in operating lease right-of-use (“ROU”) assets and operating lease liabilities in “Bank premises and equipment, net”
and “Accrued taxes and other liabilities”, respectively, in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. Operating lease ROU
assets represent the right to use an underlying asset for the lease term and operating lease liabilities represent the obligation to
make lease payments arising from the lease. Operating lease ROU assets and liabilities are recognized at the commencement
date based on the present value of lease payments over the lease term. As the Company’s leases do not provide an implicit rate,
the Company uses its incremental borrowing rate based on the information available at the commencement date in determining
the present value of lease payments. The operating lease ROU asset also includes any lease pre-payments made and excludes
lease incentives. The Company’s lease terms may include options to extend or terminate the lease. When it is reasonably certain
that the Company will exercise an option to extend a lease, the extension is included in the lease term when calculating the
present value of lease payments.
Lease expense for lease payments is recognized on a straight-line basis over the lease term. The Company has lease agreements
with lease and non-lease components, which the Company has elected to account for separately, as the non-lease component
amounts are readily determinable.
Quantitative information regarding the Company’s operating leases is presented below as of and for the years ended December
31, 2023 and 2022 (dollars in thousands).
Total operating lease cost
Weighted average remaining lease term (in years)
Weighted average discount rate
December 31,
2023
2022
$
441 $
6.8
3.2%
610
7.0
2.9%
At December 31, 2023 and 2022, the Company’s operating lease ROU assets were $2.1 million and $2.8 million, respectively,
and the Company’s related operating lease liabilities were $2.2 million and $2.9 million, respectively. The Company’s operating
leases have remaining terms ranging from 2 to 8 years, including extension options if the Company is reasonably certain they
will be exercised.
Future minimum lease payments due under non-cancelable operating leases at December 31, 2023 are presented below (dollars
in thousands).
2024
2025
2026
2027
2028
Thereafter
Total
$
$
381
388
339
341
341
671
2,461
At December 31, 2023, the Company had not entered into any material leases that have not yet commenced.
The Bank owns its corporate headquarters building, the first floor of which is occupied by multiple tenants. The Bank, as lessor,
also leases a portion of one of its branch locations. All tenant leases are operating leases. The Bank, as lessor, recognized rental
income of $0.4 million, $0.3 million and $0.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, respectively.
On January 27, 2023, the Bank completed the sale of certain assets, deposits and other liabilities associated with the Alice and
Victoria, Texas branch locations to First Community Bank. Upon the completion of the sale, the Bank recorded $0.3 million of
occupancy expense to terminate the remaining contractually obligated lease payments due under non-cancelable operating leases.
106
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
NOTE 7. GOODWILL AND OTHER INTANGIBLE ASSETS
The Company’s intangible assets consist of goodwill, core deposit intangible assets arising from acquisitions, and a trademark
intangible. At December 31, 2023 and 2022, “Goodwill and other intangible assets, net” in the accompanying consolidated
balance sheets totaled $42.3 million and $43.1 million, respectively, and included no accumulated impairment losses.
The carrying amount of goodwill at December 31, 2023 and 2022 was $40.1 million. The trademark intangible had a carrying
value of $0.1 million at December 31, 2023 and 2022.
In accordance with ASC Topic 350, “Intangibles – Goodwill and Other,” the Company reviews the carrying value of indefinite-
lived intangible assets at least annually, or more frequently if certain impairment indicators exist. The Company performed its
annual impairment testing on October 31, 2023 and determined that there was no impairment to its goodwill or trademark
intangible asset.
Core deposit intangibles have finite lives and are being amortized on an accelerated basis over their estimated useful lives, which
range from 10 to 15 years. The table below shows a summary of the core deposit intangible assets as of the dates presented
(dollars in thousands).
Core deposit intangibles
Gross carrying amount
Accumulated amortization
Net carrying amount
December 31,
2023
2022
$
$
7,486 $
(5,354)
2,132 $
7,486
(4,527)
2,959
Amortization expense for the core deposit intangible assets recorded in “Depreciation and amortization” in the accompanying
consolidated statements of income totaled approximately $0.8 million, $0.9 million, and $1.0 million for the years ended
December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, respectively.
The future amortization schedule for the Company’s core deposit intangible assets is displayed in the table below (dollars in
thousands). The weighted average amortization period remaining for core deposit intangibles is 5.4 years.
2024
2025
2026
2027
2028
Thereafter
NOTE 8. DEPOSITS
Deposits consisted of the following as of the dates presented (dollars in thousands).
Noninterest-bearing demand deposits
Interest-bearing demand deposits
Money market deposit accounts
Savings accounts
Brokered time deposits
Time deposits
Total deposits
107
624
512
398
278
161
159
2,132
$
December 31,
2023
2022
448,752 $
489,604
179,366
137,606
269,102
731,297
2,255,727 $
580,741
565,598
208,596
155,176
9,990
562,264
2,082,365
$
$
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
The approximate scheduled maturities of time deposits, including brokered time deposits, for each of the next five years are
shown below (dollars in thousands).
2024
2025
2026
2027
2028
$
$
762,456
197,355
29,803
2,374
8,411
1,000,399
At December 31, 2023 and 2022, time deposits greater than $250,000 were approximately $178.1 million, and $155.8 million,
respectively.
Public fund deposits as of December 31, 2023 and 2022 totaled approximately $134.8 million and $167.5 million, respectively.
The funds were secured by securities with a fair value of approximately $110.1 million and $165.5 million as of December 31,
2023 and 2022, respectively.
As of December 31, 2023 and 2022, total deposits outstanding to executive officers, principal shareholders, directors and to
companies in which they are principal owners amounted to approximately $20.1 million and $29.9 million, respectively.
NOTE 9. SECURITIES SOLD UNDER AGREEMENTS TO REPURCHASE
The Company utilizes securities sold under agreements to repurchase (“repurchase agreements”) to facilitate the needs of our
customers and to facilitate secured short-term funding needs. Repurchase agreements are stated at the amount of cash received
in connection with the transaction. The Company monitors collateral levels on a continuous basis and may be required to provide
additional collateral based on the fair value of the underlying securities. Securities pledged as collateral under repurchase
agreements are maintained with the Company’s safekeeping agents.
Repurchase agreements mature on a daily basis. At December 31, 2023, the total balance of repurchase agreements
was $8.6 million, and were secured by investment securities with a fair value of approximately $9.0 million. At December 31,
2022, the Company had no repurchase agreements. The weighted average interest rate on repurchase agreements was 0.13%
at December 31, 2023. The weighted average rate paid for repurchase agreements during the years ended December 31, 2023,
2022 and 2021 was 0.13%, 0.15% and 0.21%, respectively.
NOTE 10. SUBORDINATED DEBT SECURITIES
On April 6, 2022, the Company entered into a Subordinated Note Purchase Agreement with certain institutional accredited
investors and qualified institutional buyers (the “Purchasers”) under which the Company issued $20.0 million in aggregate
principal amount of its 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 2032 (the “2032 Notes”) to the Purchasers at a
price equal to 100% of the aggregate principal amount of the 2032 Notes. The 2032 Notes were issued under an indenture, dated
April 6, 2022 (the “Indenture”), by and among the Company and UMB Bank, National Association, as trustee.
The 2032 Notes have a stated maturity date of April 15, 2032 and will bear interest at a fixed rate of 5.125% per year from and
including April 6, 2022 to but excluding April 15, 2027 or earlier redemption date. From April 15, 2027 to but excluding the
stated maturity date or earlier redemption date, the 2032 Notes will bear interest a floating rate equal to the then current three-
month term secured overnight financing rate (“SOFR”), plus 277 basis points. As provided in the 2032 Notes, the interest rate on
the 2032 Notes during the applicable floating rate period may be determined based on a rate other than three-month term
SOFR. The 2032 Notes may be redeemed, in whole or in part, on or after April 15, 2027 or, in whole but not in part, under certain
other limited circumstances set forth in the Indenture. Any redemption we made would be at a redemption price equal to 100%
of the principal balance being redeemed, together with any accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption.
Principal and interest on the 2032 Notes are subject to acceleration only in limited circumstances in the case of certain bankruptcy
and insolvency-related events. The 2032 Notes are the unsecured, subordinated obligations of the Company and rank junior in
right of payment to our current and future senior indebtedness and to our obligations to our general creditors. The 2032 Notes are
intended to qualify as Tier 2 capital for regulatory purposes.
108
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
The Company used the majority of the net proceeds to redeem its 6.00% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 2027
(the “2027 Notes”) in June 2022 and utilized the remaining proceeds for share repurchases and for general corporate purposes.
On November 12, 2019, the Company issued and sold $25.0 million in aggregate principal amount of its 5.125% Fixed-to-
Floating Rate Subordinated Notes (the “2029 Notes”) due December 30, 2029. Beginning on December 30, 2024, the Company
may redeem the 2029 Notes, in whole or in part, at their principal amount plus any accrued and unpaid interest. The 2029 Notes
bear an interest rate of 5.125% per annum until December 30, 2024, on which date the interest rate will reset quarterly to an
annual interest rate equal to the then-current three-month LIBOR as calculated on each applicable date of determination, or an
alternative rate determined in accordance with the terms of the 2029 Notes if the three-month LIBOR cannot be determined, plus
349.0 basis points.
On March 24, 2017, the Company issued and sold $18.6 million in aggregate principal amount of its 2027 Notes due March 30,
2027. Beginning on March 30, 2022, the Company could redeem the 2027 Notes, in whole or in part, at their principal amount
plus any accrued and unpaid interest. The 2027 Notes had an interest rate of 6.00% per annum until March 30, 2022, on which
date the interest rate reset quarterly to an annual interest rate equal to the then-current LIBOR plus 394.5 basis points. In June
2022, the Company redeemed the 2027 Notes in full in accordance with their terms at a redemption price equal to 100% of the
outstanding principal balance plus accrued and unpaid interest up to but excluding the June 30, 2022 redemption date
(“Redemption Date”). The aggregate redemption price, excluding accrued interest, totaled $18.6 million. Interest on the 2027
Notes no longer accrued on or after the Redemption Date.
The carrying value of subordinated debt was $44.3 million and $44.2 million at December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively. The
subordinated debt securities were recorded net of issuance costs of $0.7 million and $0.8 million at December 31, 2023 and 2022,
respectively, which are being amortized using the straight-line method over the lives of the respective securities.
NOTE 11. OTHER BORROWED FUNDS
Federal Home Loan Bank Advances
FHLB advances and weighted average interest rates at the end of the period by contractual maturity are summarized as of the
dates presented (dollars in thousands).
Fixed rate advances maturing:
2023
2024
2033
Amount
Weighted Average Rate
December 31,
2023
December 31,
2022
December 31,
2023
December 31,
2022
$
$
— $
23,500
—
23,500 $
333,500
23,500
30,000
387,000
—%
1.81
—
1.81%
4.55%
1.81
1.88
4.18%
As of December 31, 2023, these advances are collateralized by a blanket pledge of certain loans totaling approximately
$975.4 million in accordance with the Advance Security and Collateral Agreement with the FHLB. As of December 31, 2023,
the Company had an additional $919.5 million available under its line of credit with the FHLB.
At December 31, 2022, the FHLB advances contractually maturing in 2033 were fixed rate, nonamortizing puttable advances.
Under the terms of these advances, the Bank sold the FHLB options to terminate the fixed rate advances at specified points in
time prior to the stated maturity dates. These advances were terminated during the year ended December 31, 2023.
Borrowings Under Bank Term Funding Program
On March 12, 2023, the Federal Reserve established the Bank Term Funding Program (“BTFP”). The BTFP is a one-year
program which provides additional liquidity through borrowings with a term of up to one year secured by the pledging of certain
qualifying securities and other assets, valued at par value. At December 31, 2023, outstanding borrowings under the BTFP
were $212.5 million, with a weighted average rate of 4.83%. At December 31, 2023, the Company’s remaining borrowing
capacity under the BTFP was $58.5 million based on the value of securities available to be used as collateral, valued at par value
109
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
as permitted under the program. During the fourth quarter of 2023, the Company refinanced all of its borrowings under the BTFP
with new loans under the BTFP with a one-year term due to more favorable rates.
Lines of Credit
The Company has outstanding unsecured lines of credit with its correspondent banks available to assist in the management of
short-term liquidity. Any balances drawn on these lines of credit mature daily. At December 31, 2023 and 2022, the available
balance on the unsecured lines of credit totaled approximately $60.0 million, with no outstanding balance reflected on the
consolidated balance sheets.
Junior Subordinated Debt
The following table provides a summary of the Company’s junior subordinated debentures (dollars in thousands).
First Community
Louisiana Statutory
Trust I
Face Value
Carrying
Value
Maturity
Date
Variable Interest Rate
3-month SOFR + Spread
$
3,609 $
3,609 June 2036
Adjustment of 0.26% + Margin of
1.77%
3-month SOFR + Spread
BOJ Bancshares
Statutory Trust I
3,093
2,504
December
2034
Adjustment of 0.26% + Margin of
1.90%
Cheaha Statutory Trust I
$
3,093
9,795 $
September
2035
2,517
8,630
3-month SOFR + Spread
Adjustment of 0.26% + Margin of
1.70%
Interest Rate at
December 31,
2023
7.42%
7.55%
7.35%
These debentures are unsecured obligations due to trusts that are unconsolidated subsidiaries. The debentures were issued in
conjunction with the trusts’ issuances of obligated capital securities. The trusts used the proceeds from the issuances of their
capital securities to buy floating rate junior subordinated deferrable interest debentures that bear the same interest rate and terms
as the capital securities. These debentures are the trusts’ only assets and the interest payments from the debentures finance the
distributions paid on the capital securities. These debentures rank junior and are subordinate in the right of payment to all other
debt of the Company.
As part of the purchase accounting adjustments made with the BOJ Bancshares Inc. acquisition on December 1, 2017, and with
the Cheaha Financial Group, Inc. acquisition on April 1, 2021, the Company adjusted the carrying value of the junior
subordinated debentures to fair value as of the respective acquisition date. The discounts on the debentures will continue to be
amortized through maturity and recognized as a component of interest expense.
The debentures may be called by the Company at par plus any accrued interest. Interest on the debentures is calculated quarterly.
The distribution rate payable on the capital securities is cumulative and payable quarterly in arrears. The Company has the right
to defer payments of interest on the debentures at any time by extending the interest payment period for a period not exceeding
20 consecutive quarters with respect to each deferral period, provided that no extension period may extend beyond the redemption
or maturity date of the debentures.
The debentures are included on the consolidated balance sheets as liabilities; however, for regulatory purposes, the carrying
values of these obligations are eligible for inclusion in Tier I regulatory capital, subject to certain limitations. The total carrying
values of $8.6 million and $8.5 million were allowed in the calculation of Tier I regulatory capital at December 31,
2023 and 2022, respectively.
110
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
NOTE 12. DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
As part of its liability management, the Company has historically utilized pay-fixed interest rate swaps to manage exposure
against the variability in the expected future cash flows (future interest payments) attributable to changes in the 1-month LIBOR
associated with the forecasted issuances of 1-month fixed rate debt arising from a rollover strategy. To mitigate credit risk,
securities were pledged to the Company by the counterparties in an amount greater than or equal to the gain position of the
derivative contracts. Conversely, securities were pledged to the counterparties by the Company in an amount greater than or equal
to the loss position of the derivative contracts, if applicable. The derivative contracts were between the Company
and two counterparties. At December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, the Company had no current or forward starting interest
rate swap agreements, other than interest rate swaps related to customer loans, described below. The interest rate swaps were
determined to be fully effective during the periods presented, and therefore, no amount of ineffectiveness has been included in
net income.
During the year ended December 31, 2022, the Company voluntarily terminated interest rate swap agreements with a total
notional amount of $115.0 million in response to market conditions. During the year ended December 31, 2021, the Company
voluntarily terminated interest rate swap agreements with a total notional amount of $150.0 million in response to market
conditions and as a result of excess liquidity. For years ended December 31, 2022 and December 31, 2021 unrealized gains
of $6.4 million and $1.4 million, respectively, net of tax expenses of $1.7 million and $0.4 million, respectively, were reclassified
from “Accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income” and recorded as “Swap termination fee income” in noninterest income
in the accompanying consolidated statements of income.
For the years ended December 31, 2022 and December 31, 2021 gains of $4.3 million and $5.3 million, respectively, net of tax
expenses of $1.2 million and $1.4 million, respectively, were recognized in “Other comprehensive income (loss)” in the
accompanying consolidated statements of comprehensive income (loss) for the change in fair value of the interest rate swap
contracts.
There were no assets or liabilities recorded in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets at December 31, 2023 or December
31, 2022 associated with the swap contracts, other than interest rate swaps related to customer loans, described below.
Customer Derivatives – Interest Rate Swaps
The Company enters into interest rate swaps that allow commercial loan customers to effectively convert a variable-rate
commercial loan agreement to a fixed-rate commercial loan agreement. Under these agreements, the Company enters into a
variable-rate loan agreement with a customer in addition to an interest rate swap agreement, which serves to effectively swap the
customer’s variable-rate loan into a fixed-rate loan. The Company then enters into a corresponding swap agreement with
a third party in order to economically hedge its exposure through the customer agreement. The interest rate swaps with both the
customers and third parties are not designated as hedges under FASB ASC Topic 815, “Derivatives and Hedging,” and are
marked to market through earnings. As the interest rate swaps are structured to offset each other, changes to the underlying
benchmark interest rates considered in the valuation of these instruments do not result in an impact to earnings; however,
there may be fair value adjustments related to credit quality variations between counterparties, which may impact earnings as
required by FASB ASC Topic 820, “Fair Value Measurement” (“ASC 820”). The Company did not recognize any gains or
losses in other operating income resulting from fair value adjustments of these swap agreements during the years ended December
31, 2023, 2022 and 2021. At December 31, 2023, the Company had notional amounts of $174.9 million in interest rate swap
contracts with customers and $174.9 million in offsetting interest rate swap contracts with other financial institutions. The fair
value of the swap contracts consisted of gross assets of $17.3 million and gross liabilities of $17.3 million recorded in “Other
assets” and “Accrued taxes and other liabilities”, respectively, in the accompanying consolidated balance sheet at December 31,
2023.
NOTE 13. STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
Preferred Stock
The Company’s Articles of Incorporation give the Company’s board of directors the authority to issue up to 5,000,000 shares of
preferred stock. At December 31, 2023, there were no preferred shares outstanding. The preferred shares are considered “blank
check” preferred stock. This type of preferred stock allows the board of directors to fix the designations, preferences and relative,
participating, optional or other special rights, and qualifications and limitations or restrictions of any series of preferred stock
without further shareholder approval.
111
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Common Stock
The Company’s Articles of Incorporation give the Company’s board of directors the authority to issue up to 40,000,000 shares
of common stock. At December 31, 2023, there were 9,748,067 common shares outstanding compared to 9,901,847 and
10,343,494 at December 31, 2022 and 2021, respectively.
In addition, the Company repurchased 222,448, 518,978, and 359,138 shares of its common stock through its stock repurchase
program at an average price of $13.47, $20.27, and $19.24 per share during the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021,
respectively.
Dividend Restrictions. In the ordinary course of business, the Company is dependent upon dividends from the Bank to provide
funds for the payment of dividends to shareholders and to provide for other cash requirements. Banking regulations may limit
the amount of dividends that may be paid to the Company. Approval by regulatory authorities is required if the effect of the
dividend would cause the regulatory capital of the Bank to fall below specified minimum levels. Approval is also required if
dividends declared exceed the net profits for that year combined with the retained net profits for the preceding two years. Further,
a national bank may not pay a dividend in excess of its undivided profits.
Under the terms of the junior subordinated debentures, assumed through acquisition, the Company has the right at any time
during the term of the debentures to defer the payment of interest. In the event that the Company elects to defer interest on the
debentures, it may not, with certain exceptions, declare or pay any dividends or distributions on its common stock or purchase
or acquire any of its common stock.
Under the terms of the Company’s 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 2029, the Company may not pay a
dividend if either the parent company or the Bank, both immediately prior to the declaration of the dividend and after giving
effect to the payment of the dividend, would not maintain regulatory capital ratios that are at “well capitalized” levels for
regulatory purposes (but with respect to the parent company, only if it is required to measure and report such ratios on a
consolidated basis under applicable law). The Company is also prohibited from paying dividends upon and during the
continuance of any Event of Default under such notes.
Under the terms of the Company’s 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 2032, the Company is prohibited
from paying dividends upon and during the continuance of any Event of Default under such notes.
These restrictions do not, and are not expected in the future to, materially limit the Company’s ability to pay dividends to its
shareholders in an amount consistent with the Company’s history of paying dividends.
112
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Accumulated Other Comprehensive (Loss) Income
Activity within the balances in accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income, net is shown in the tables below (dollars in
thousands).
Beginning
of Period
2023
Net
Change
For the years ended December 31,
2022
Net
Change
Beginning
of Period
End of
Period
End of
Period
Beginning
of Period
2021
Net
Change
End of
Period
$ (43,137 ) $ 3,510 $ (39,627) $
4,882 $ (48,019) $ (43,137) $
7,493 $ (2,611) $ 4,882
(5,777 )
256
(5,521)
(5,772)
(5)
(5,777)
(3,939 ) (1,833)
(5,772)
1 —
1
2
(1)
1
3
(1)
2
7,830 —
7,830
3,501 4,329
7,830
(1,752 ) 5,253
3,501
(7,830 ) —
(7,830)
(1,450) (6,380)
(7,830)
— (1,450)
(1,450)
Unrealized (loss) gain,
available for sale, net
Reclassification of
realized (gain) loss,
available for sale, net
Unrealized gain (loss), transfer
from available for sale to
held to maturity, net
Change in fair value of interest
rate swaps designated as
cash flow hedges, net
Reclassification of realized
gain, interest rate swap
termination, net
Accumulated other
comprehensive (loss)
income
$ (48,913 ) $ 3,766 $ (45,147) $
1,163 $ (50,076) $ (48,913) $
1,805 $
(642) $ 1,163
NOTE 14. STOCK-BASED COMPENSATION
Equity Incentive Plan. The Company’s Amended and Restated 2017 Long-Term Incentive Compensation Plan (the “Plan”)
authorizes the grant of various types of equity awards, such as restricted stock, restricted stock units, stock options and stock
appreciation rights to eligible participants, which include all of the Company’s employees, non-employee directors, and
consultants. The Plan has reserved a total of 1,200,000 shares of common stock, 600,000 of which were authorized in 2021, for
issuance to eligible participants pursuant to equity awards under the Plan. The Plan is administered by the Compensation
Committee of the Company’s board of directors, which determines, within the provisions of the Plan, those eligible employees
to whom, and the times at which, equity awards will be granted. The Compensation Committee, in its discretion, may delegate
its authority and duties under the Plan to specified officers; however, only the Compensation Committee may approve the terms
of equity awards to the Company’s executive officers and directors. At December 31, 2023, approximately 450,058 shares remain
available for grant.
Stock Options
During the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, the Company granted 34,497, 34,379, and 38,450 stock options,
respectively, to key personnel that vest in one-fifth increments on each of the first five anniversaries of the grant date.
113
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
The table below summarizes the Company’s stock option activity for the periods indicated.
Shares
Average Price
Weighted
Outstanding at December 31, 2020
Granted
Forfeited
Exercised
Outstanding at December 31, 2021
Granted
Forfeited
Exercised
Outstanding at December 31, 2022
Granted
Forfeited
Exercised
Outstanding at December 31, 2023
Exercisable at December 31, 2023
408,288 $
38,450
(30,869)
(47,388)
368,481
34,379
(42,930)
(9,500)
350,430
34,497
(50,822)
(7,500)
326,605
244,847 $
17.66
20.72
19.56
15.44
18.10
18.92
21.36
14.00
17.89
13.96
19.47
14.00
17.32
17.17
Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Term (Years)
5.57
5.05
4.19
3.84
2.44
The aggregate intrinsic value of stock options is calculated as the aggregate difference between the exercise price of the stock
options and the fair market value of the Company’s common stock for those stock options having an exercise price lower than
the fair market value of the Company’s common stock. At December 31, 2023, the shares underlying outstanding and exercisable
stock options both had an intrinsic value of $0.1 million.
The Company uses a Black-Scholes option pricing model to estimate the fair value of stock-based awards. The Black-Scholes
option pricing model incorporates various subjective assumptions, including expected term and expected volatility. Expected
volatility was determined based on the historical volatilities of the Company. Stock option expense of $0.2 million is included
in “Salaries and employee benefits” in the accompanying consolidated statements of income for each of the years
ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021. At December 31, 2023, there was $0.3 million of unrecognized compensation cost
related to stock options that is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 3.2 years.
The table below shows the assumptions used for the stock options granted during the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022.
Dividend yield
Expected volatility
Risk-free interest rate
Expected term (in years)
Weighted average grant date fair value
Restricted Stock and Restricted Stock Units
2023
2022
2.72%
38.31%
3.56%
6.5
4.58 $
1.70%
38.74%
2.50%
6.5
6.69
$
Under the Plan, the Company may grant restricted stock, restricted stock units, and other stock-based awards to Plan participants,
subject to forfeiture upon the occurrence of certain events until the dates specified in the participant’s award agreement. While
restricted stock is subject to forfeiture, holders of restricted stock may exercise full voting rights and will receive all dividends
paid with respect to the restricted shares. Restricted stock units (“RSUs”) do not have voting rights and do not receive dividends
or dividend equivalents. The restricted stock and RSUs granted under the Plan are typically subject to a vesting period.
Compensation expense for restricted stock and RSUs is determined based on the market price of the Company’s common stock
at the grant date and is applied to the total number of shares or units granted and is recognized on a straight-line basis over the
requisite service period of generally five years for employees and two years for non-employee directors. Upon vesting of
restricted stock and RSUs, the benefit of tax deductions in excess of recognized compensation expense is reflected as an income
tax benefit in the consolidated statements of income.
114
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Historically, the Company has granted restricted stock awards to Plan participants. Beginning in 2019, the Company granted
time vested RSUs to its non-employee directors and certain officers of the Company with vesting terms ranging from two years
to five years.
The Company granted a total of 172,736 RSUs to employees and directors for the year ended December 31, 2023. Of the RSUs
granted in 2023, 153,467 shares vest over five years and 19,269 shares vest over two years.
The Company granted a total of 134,524 RSUs to employees and directors for the year ended December 31, 2022. Of the RSUs
granted in 2022, 114,554 shares vest over five years and 19,970 shares vest over two years.
The Company granted a total of 129,082 RSUs to employees and directors for the year ended December 31, 2021. Of the RSUs
granted in 2021, 105,294 shares vest over five years and 23,788 shares vest over two years.
Compensation expense related to restricted stock and RSUs included in the accompanying consolidated statements of income for
the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 was $1.8 million, $2.0 million and $1.6 million, respectively. The unearned
compensation related to these awards is amortized to compensation expense over the vesting period. As of December 31, 2023,
unearned stock-based compensation cost associated with these awards totaled approximately $4.3 million and is expected to be
recognized over a weighted average period of 3.2 years.
The following table summarizes the restricted stock and RSU activity for the years ended December 31, 2023 and December 31,
2022.
December 31,
2023
2022
Balance, beginning of period
Granted
Forfeited
Earned and issued
Balance, end of period
NOTE 15. EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS
253,488 $
172,736
(7,008)
(82,467)
336,749 $
20.19
14.82
20.53
20.42
17.37
Weighted
Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
Shares
Shares
Weighted
Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
21.16
19.09
20.34
21.14
20.19
241,070 $
134,524
(30,169)
(91,937)
253,488 $
The Company maintains a 401(k) defined contribution plan (the “401(k) Plan”), which covers employees over the age of 21 who
have completed three months of credited service, as defined by the 401(k) Plan. The 401(k) Plan allows employees to defer a
percentage of their salaries subject to certain limits based on federal tax laws. The Company makes matching contributions up
to 4% of the employee’s annual salary (subject to certain maximum compensation amounts as prescribed in Internal Revenue
Service guidance). Contributions by the Company and participants are immediately vested. Employer matching contributions to
the 401(k) Plan for each of the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 were approximately $1.0 million, and are included
in “Salaries and employee benefits” in the accompanying consolidated statements of income.
The 401(k) Plan also allows for discretionary Company contributions in the form of cash or Company stock. Contributions in
the form of Company stock are held in a portion of the 401(k) Plan that qualifies as an employee stock ownership plan. The
Company made Company stock contributions of $0.1 million in the year ended December 31, 2022. The discretionary
components vest in increments of 20% annually over a period of five years based on the employees’ years of service, beginning
upon completion of two years of service (such that an employee with six years of service will be 100% vested).
The Bank has entered into Salary Continuation Agreements (“SCA”) with certain officers of the Company. The SCAs represent
unfunded, non-qualified deferred compensation arrangements under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended. The SCAs
between the Bank and each officer, as supplemented if applicable, provide that the officer shall receive annual payments of a
fixed amount upon attaining the age of 65, with such payments payable monthly over a period of 120 months (10 years). Each
officer is also entitled to certain reduced payments following a termination of employment prior to attaining age 65 (other than
a termination due to death or with cause), which payments shall be made on the same schedule mentioned above.
115
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
The Company maintains a deferred compensation plan for a former employee of Citizens Bank (“Citizens”), a liability assumed
in the Citizens acquisition in 2017. Under the deferred compensation agreement, the former employee will receive monthly
payments of $2,000 through May of 2030. The Company also maintains a deferred compensation plan for certain former
employees of Cheaha, and associated liabilities of $1.7 million were assumed in the acquisition on April 1, 2021. The deferred
compensation plan provides for payments for a period of 15 years following specified retirement dates, which range from 2018
through 2032. On November 4, 2022, the Company’s then-current Chief Financial Officer separated from the Company, and the
Company’s board of directors approved the continuation of his Split-Dollar Life Insurance Agreement following his separation
date. Accordingly, in the fourth quarter of 2022, the Company recorded deferred compensation expense and associated liability of
$0.2 million. At December 31, 2023 and 2022, the Company had a liability of $5.3 million and $5.2 million, respectively,
included in “Accrued taxes and other liabilities” on the accompanying consolidated balance sheets related to these deferred
compensation plans. Deferred compensation expenses related to these plans recognized for the years ended December 31, 2023,
2022, and 2021 were approximately $0.2 million, $1.0 million and $0.7 million, respectively, and are included in “Salaries and
employee benefits” in the accompanying consolidated statements of income.
NOTE 16. INCOME TAXES
Income tax expense is displayed in the table below for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 (dollars in thousands).
Current federal income tax expense
Current state income tax expense
Deferred federal income tax expense
Total income tax expense
2023
December 31,
2022
2021
$
$
3,971 $
129
(350)
3,750 $
9,075 $
219
(655)
8,639 $
2,315
141
(547)
1,909
The provision for federal income taxes differs from that computed by applying the federal statutory rate of 21% as indicated in
the following analysis for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 (dollars in thousands).
Tax based on statutory rate
(Decrease) increase resulting from:
Effect of tax-exempt income
Acquisition costs
Historical tax credits
State taxes
Other
Total income tax expense
Effective rate
2023
December 31,
2022
2021
$
4,290 $
9,313 $
2,081
(830)
—
—
129
161
3,750 $
18.4%
(873)
—
—
219
(20)
8,639 $
19.5%
(348)
72
(54)
141
17
1,909
19.3%
$
The Company records deferred income tax on the tax effect of changes in timing differences.
116
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
The net deferred tax asset was comprised of the following items as of the dates indicated (dollars in thousands).
Deferred tax liabilities:
Depreciation
FHLB stock dividend
Basis difference in acquired assets and liabilities
Operating lease right-of-use asset
Other
Gross deferred tax liability
Deferred tax assets:
Allowance for credit losses
Unrealized loss on available for sale securities
Net operating loss carryforward
Deferred compensation
Basis difference in acquired assets and liabilities
Employee and director stock awards
Operating lease liability
Unearned loan fees
Other
Gross deferred tax asset
Net deferred tax asset
December 31,
2023
2022
$
$
(3,072) $
(88)
(1,018)
(443)
(55)
(4,676)
6,474
12,216
69
1,117
270
580
463
227
170
21,586
16,910 $
(3,441)
(103)
(1,129)
(598)
(46)
(5,317)
5,180
13,235
193
1,099
440
576
619
269
144
21,755
16,438
The Company acquired net operating loss (“NOL”) carryforwards through tax free acquisitions. As of December 31, 2023 and
December 31, 2022, the Company’s gross NOL carryforwards were approximately $0.3 million and $0.9 million, respectively.
As of December 31, 2023, approximately $4,000 and $0.3 million of the NOL carryforwards expire in 2033 and 2039,
respectively. All available NOL carryforwards are expected to be fully utilized by 2024, therefore the Company did not record
a valuation allowance against the NOL carryforwards for the year ended December 31, 2023.
The Company files income tax returns under U.S. federal jurisdiction and the states of Alabama, Florida, Texas and Louisiana,
although the state of Louisiana does not assess an income tax on income resulting from banking operations. The Company is
open to examination in the U.S. and the states of Louisiana, Alabama, and Florida for tax years ended December 31, 2020 through
December 31, 2023; and Texas for tax years ended December 31, 2019 through December 31, 2023.
NOTE 17. FAIR VALUES OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
In accordance with ASC 820, disclosure of fair value information about financial instruments, whether or not recognized in the
balance sheet, is required. The fair value of a financial instrument is the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to
transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date under current market conditions.
Fair value is best determined based upon quoted market prices or exit prices. In cases where quoted market prices
are not available, fair values are based on estimates using present value or other valuation techniques. Those techniques are
significantly affected by the assumptions used, including the discount rate and estimates of future cash flows, and the fair value
estimates may not be realized in an immediate settlement of the instruments. Accordingly, the aggregate fair value amounts
presented do not represent the underlying value of the Company.
If there has been a significant decrease in the volume and level of activity for the asset or liability, a change in valuation technique
or the use of multiple valuation techniques may be appropriate. In such instances, determining the price at which willing market
participants would transact at the measurement date under current market conditions depends on the facts and circumstances and
requires use of significant judgment. The fair value is a reasonable point within the range that is most representative of fair value
under current market conditions.
117
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
The Company also holds Small Business Investment Company qualified funds and other investment funds that do not have a
readily determinable fair value. In accordance with ASC 820, these investments are measured at fair value using the net asset
value practical expedient and are not required to be classified in the fair value hierarchy. At December 31, 2023 and December
31, 2022, the fair values of these investments were $3.4 million and $2.8 million, respectively, and are included in “Other assets”
in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets.
Fair Value Hierarchy
In accordance with ASC 820, the Company groups its financial assets and financial liabilities measured at fair value
in three levels, based on the markets in which the assets and liabilities are traded, and the reliability of the assumptions used to
determine fair value.
Level 1 – Valuation is based upon quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities traded in active markets.
Level 2 – Valuation is based upon observable inputs other than quoted prices included in level 1, such as quoted prices for similar
assets and liabilities in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar assets or liabilities in markets that are not active, or
other inputs that are observable or can be corroborated by observable market data.
Level 3 – Valuation is based upon unobservable inputs that are supported by little or no market activity and that are significant
to the fair value of the assets or liabilities. This includes certain pricing models, discounted cash flow methodologies, and similar
techniques that use significant unobservable inputs.
A financial instrument’s categorization within the valuation hierarchy is based upon the lowest level of input that is significant
to the fair value measurement.
Fair Value of Assets and Liabilities Measured on a Recurring Basis
The following methods and assumptions were used by the Company in estimating the fair value of assets and liabilities valued
on a recurring basis:
AFS Investment Securities and Exchange-Traded Equity Securities – Where quoted prices are available in an active market, the
Company classifies the securities within level 1 of the valuation hierarchy. Securities are defined as both long and short positions.
Level 1 securities include exchange-traded equity securities.
If quoted market prices are not available, the Company estimates fair values using pricing models and discounted cash flows that
consider standard input factors such as observable market data, benchmark yields, interest rate volatilities, broker/dealer quotes,
and credit spreads. Examples of such instruments, which would generally be classified within level 2 of the valuation hierarchy
if observable inputs are available, include obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agencies and corporations,
obligations of state and political subdivisions, corporate bonds, residential mortgage-backed securities, and commercial
mortgage-backed securities. In certain cases where there is limited activity or less transparency around inputs to the valuation,
the Company classifies those securities in level 3.
Management monitors the current placement of securities in the fair value hierarchy to determine whether transfers between
levels may be warranted based on market reference data, which may include reported trades; bids, offers or broker/dealer quotes;
benchmark yields and spreads; as well as other reference data. At December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, the majority of
the Company’s level 3 investments were obligations of state and political subdivisions. The Company estimated the fair value of
these level 3 investments using discounted cash flow models, the key inputs of which are the coupon rate, current spreads to the
yield curves, and expected repayment dates, adjusted for illiquidity of the local municipal market and sinking funds, if applicable.
Option-adjusted models may be used for structured or callable notes, as appropriate.
Derivative Financial Instruments – The fair value for interest rate swap agreements is based upon the amounts required to settle
the contracts. These derivative instruments are classified in level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.
118
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis are summarized in the table below as of the dates indicated
(dollars in thousands).
Quoted Prices
in Active
Markets for
Fair Value
Identical
Assets
(Level 1)
Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
December 31, 2023
Assets:
Obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S. government
agencies and corporations
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
Corporate bonds
Residential mortgage-backed securities
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
Equity securities
Interest rate swaps - gross assets
Total assets
Liabilities:
Interest rate swaps - gross liabilities
December 31, 2022
Assets:
Obligations of the U.S. Treasury and U.S. government
agencies and corporations
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
Corporate bonds
Residential mortgage-backed securities
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
Equity securities
Total assets
$
$
$
$
20,043 $
16,703
26,356
232,045
66,771
1,180
17,325
380,423 $
— $
—
—
—
—
1,180
—
1,180 $
20,043 $
11,453
25,893
232,045
66,771
—
17,325
373,530 $
—
5,250
463
—
—
—
—
5,713
17,325 $
— $
17,325 $
—
29,805 $
18,378
29,942
251,851
75,191
1,245
406,412 $
— $
—
—
—
—
1,245
1,245 $
29,805 $
12,413
29,463
251,851
75,191
—
398,723 $
—
5,965
479
—
—
—
6,444
119
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
The Company reviews fair value hierarchy classifications on a quarterly basis. Changes in the Company’s ability to observe
inputs to the valuation may cause reclassification of certain assets or liabilities within the fair value hierarchy. The table below
provides a reconciliation for assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis using significant unobservable inputs, or level 3
inputs (dollars in thousands).
Obligations of
State and
Political
Subdivisions
Corporate
Bonds
Total
Balance at December 31, 2021
Realized gains (losses) included in net income
Unrealized losses included in other comprehensive loss
Purchases
Sales
Maturities, prepayments, and calls
Transfers into Level 3
Transfers out of Level 3
Balance at December 31, 2022
Realized gains (losses) included in net income
Unrealized losses included in other comprehensive income
Purchases
Sales
Maturities, prepayments, and calls
Transfers into Level 3
Transfers out of Level 3
Balance at December 31, 2023
$
$
$
22,114 $
—
(1,474)
—
—
(4,840)
—
(9,835)
5,965 $
—
(689)
—
—
(26)
—
—
5,250 $
488 $
—
(9)
—
—
—
—
—
479 $
—
(16)
—
—
—
—
—
463 $
22,602
—
(1,483)
—
—
(4,840)
—
(9,835)
6,444
—
(705)
—
—
(26)
—
—
5,713
There were no liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis using level 3 inputs at December 31, 2023 and 2022. For the
years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, there were no gains or losses included in earnings related to the change in fair
value of the assets measured on a recurring basis using significant unobservable inputs held at the end of the period.
The following table provides quantitative information about significant unobservable inputs used in fair value measurements of
level 3 assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis at December 31, 2023 and 2022 (dollars in thousands).
Estimated
Fair Value
Valuation Technique
Unobservable
Inputs
Range of
Discounts
December 31, 2023
Obligations of state and
political subdivisions
$
Corporate bonds
December 31, 2022
Obligations of state and
political subdivisions
$
Corporate bonds
Option-adjusted discounted cash flow model;
present value of expected future cash flow
model
5,250
Option-adjusted discounted cash flow model;
present value of expected future cash flow
model
463
Bond appraisal
adjustment(1)
Bond appraisal
adjustment(1)
0% - 11%
8%
Option-adjusted discounted cash flow model;
present value of expected future cash flow
model
5,965
Option-adjusted discounted cash flow model;
present value of expected future cash flow
model
479
Bond appraisal
adjustment(1)
Bond appraisal
adjustment(1)
0% - 12%
4%
(1) Fair values determined through valuation analysis using coupon, yield (discount margin), liquidity and expected
repayment dates.
120
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Fair Value of Assets and Liabilities Measured on a Nonrecurring Basis
Certain financial assets and financial liabilities are measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis; that is, the instruments
are not measured at fair value on an ongoing basis but are subject to fair value adjustments in certain circumstances (for example,
when there is evidence of impairment).
The following methods and assumptions were used by the Company in estimating the fair value of assets and liabilities valued
on a nonrecurring basis:
Loans Individually Evaluated – For collateral dependent loans where the borrower is experiencing financial difficulty, the
expected credit loss is measured as the difference between the amortized cost basis of the loan and the fair value of the collateral,
which is based on third-party appraisals. Individually evaluated loans that are not collateral dependent are evaluated based on a
discounted cash flow methodology. Credits deemed uncollectible are charged to the allowance for credit losses. Since not all
valuation inputs are observable, these nonrecurring fair value determinations are classified as level 3.
Quantitative information about assets measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis based on significant unobservable inputs
(level 3) are summarized below as of the dates indicated; there were no liabilities measured on a nonrecurring basis at December
31, 2023 or 2022 (dollars in thousands).
Estimated
Fair Value Valuation Technique
Unobservable Inputs
Range of
Discounts
Weighted
Average
Discount(2)
Discounted cash flows,
underlying collateral
value
$
1,293
Collateral discounts and
estimated costs to sell
6% -
100%
29%
December 31, 2023
Loans individually
evaluated for
impairment(1)
December 31, 2022
Impaired loans
$
4,033
Discounted cash flows,
underlying collateral
value
Collateral discounts and
estimated costs to sell
4% -
100%
53%
(1) Loans individually evaluated that were re-measured during the period had a carrying value of $1.8 million and
$4.2 million at December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, respectively, with related allowance for credit losses of
$0.5 million and $0.2 million as of such dates.
(2) Weighted by relative fair value.
Financial Instruments
Accounting guidance requires the disclosure of estimated fair value information about certain on- and off-balance sheet financial
instruments, including those financial instruments that are not measured and reported at fair value on a recurring or nonrecurring
basis. The significant methods and assumptions used by the Company to estimate the fair value of financial instruments are
discussed below.
Cash and Due from Banks – For these short-term instruments, fair value is the carrying value. Cash and due from banks is
classified in level 1 of the fair value hierarchy.
Federal Funds Sold – The fair value is the carrying value. The Company classifies these assets in level 1 of the fair value
hierarchy.
Investment Securities and Equity Securities – The fair value measurement techniques and assumptions for AFS securities and
exchange-traded equity securities is discussed earlier in the note. The same measurement techniques and assumptions were
applied to the valuation of HTM securities and other equity securities including equity in correspondent banks.
121
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Loans – The fair value of portfolio loans, net is determined using an exit price methodology. The exit price methodology is based
on a discounted cash flow analysis, in which projected cash flows are based on contractual cash flows adjusted for prepayments
for certain loan types (e.g. residential mortgage loans and multifamily loans) and the use of a discount rate based on expected
relative risk of the cash flows. The discount rate selected considers loan type, maturity date, a liquidity premium, cost to service,
and cost of capital, which is a level 3 fair value estimate.
Loans held for sale are measured using quoted market prices when available. If quoted market prices are not available,
comparable market values or discounted cash flow analyses may be utilized. The Company classifies these assets in level 3 of
the fair value hierarchy.
Deposit Liabilities – The fair values disclosed for noninterest-bearing demand deposits are, by definition, equal to the amount
payable on demand at the reporting date (that is, their carrying amounts). These noninterest-bearing deposits are classified in
level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. All interest-bearing deposits are classified in level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. The carrying
amounts of variable-rate accounts (for example interest-bearing checking, savings, and money market accounts), fixed-term
money market accounts, and certificates of deposit approximate their fair values at the reporting date. Fair values for fixed-rate
certificates of deposit are estimated using a discounted cash flow calculation that applies market interest rates on comparable
instruments to a schedule of aggregated expected monthly maturities on time deposits.
Short-Term Borrowings – The carrying amounts of federal funds purchased, borrowings under repurchase agreements, and other
short-term borrowings approximate their fair values. The Company classifies these borrowings in level 2 of the fair value
hierarchy.
Long-Term Borrowings, including Junior Subordinated Debt Securities – The fair values of long-term borrowings are estimated
using discounted cash flow analyses based on the Company’s current incremental borrowing rates for similar types of borrowing
arrangements. The fair value of the Company’s long-term debt is therefore classified in level 3 in the fair value hierarchy.
Subordinated Debt Securities – The fair value of subordinated debt is estimated based on current market rates on similar debt in
the market. The Company classifies this debt in level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.
Derivative Financial Instruments – The fair value measurement techniques and assumptions for derivative financial instruments
is discussed earlier in the note.
The estimated fair values of the Company’s financial instruments at December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022 are shown
below (dollars in thousands).
December 31, 2023
Carrying
Amount
Estimated
Fair Value Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Financial assets:
Cash and due from banks
Investment securities
Equity securities
Loans, net of allowance
Interest rate swaps - gross assets
Financial liabilities:
Deposits, noninterest-bearing
Deposits, interest-bearing
Borrowings under BTFP and repurchase
agreements
FHLB long-term advances
Junior subordinated debt
Subordinated debt
Interest rate swaps - gross liabilities
$
32,009 $
382,390
14,597
32,009 $
382,431
14,597
2,180,079 2,020,924
17,325
17,325
32,009 $
—
1,180
—
—
— $
358,323
13,417
—
24,108
—
— 2,020,924
—
17,325
448,752 $
448,752 $
$
1,806,975 1,735,562
— $
—
448,752 $
—
— 1,735,562
221,133
23,500
8,630
45,000
17,325
221,133
22,945
8,630
44,544
17,325
—
—
—
—
—
221,133
—
—
44,544
17,325
—
22,945
8,630
—
—
122
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2022
Carrying
Amount
Estimated
Fair Value Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
$
40,066 $
193
413,472
27,254
40,066 $
193
413,089
27,254
2,080,403 1,997,287
40,066 $
193
—
1,245
—
— $
—
401,233
26,009
—
—
11,856
—
— 1,997,287
580,741 $
580,741 $
$
1,501,624 1,314,407
333,500
52,147
8,515
42,980
333,500
53,500
8,515
45,000
— $
—
—
—
—
—
580,741 $
—
— 1,314,407
—
52,147
8,515
—
333,500
—
—
42,980
Financial assets:
Cash and due from banks
Federal funds sold
Investment securities
Equity securities
Loans, net of allowance
Financial liabilities:
Deposits, noninterest-bearing
Deposits, interest-bearing
FHLB short-term advances
FHLB long-term advances
Junior subordinated debt
Subordinated debt
NOTE 18. REGULATORY MATTERS
The Company and Bank are subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by the federal banking agencies.
Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate certain mandatory and possibly additional discretionary actions by
regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines,
the Company and Bank must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of assets, liabilities, and certain
off-balance sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices. The capital amounts and classification are also
subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings, and other factors.
Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require the Company and Bank to maintain minimum
amounts and ratios (set forth in the table below) of total, Common Equity Tier 1, and Tier 1 capital (as defined in the regulations)
to risk-weighted assets (as defined) and Tier 1 capital to average assets (as defined).
As of December 31, 2023 and 2022, the Bank was considered well capitalized under the regulatory framework for prompt
corrective action. To be categorized as well capitalized, the Bank must maintain minimum risk-based and Tier 1 leverage capital
ratios as set forth in the table below and not be subject to a written agreement or order with regulators to maintain a specific
capital level for any capital measure. There are no conditions or events since the regulatory framework for prompt corrective
action was issued that management believes have changed the Bank’s category.
123
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
The Company’s and the Bank’s actual capital amounts and ratios as of December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022 are presented
in the tables below (dollars in thousands).
December 31, 2023
Tier 1 leverage capital
Investar Holding Corporation
Investar Bank
Actual
Amount Ratio
Capital Adequacy* Well Capitalized
Amount Ratio
Amount Ratio
$ 239,095
280,687
8.35% $ 114,563
9.81 114,468
NA
4.00%
4.00 143,085
NA
5.00
Common Equity Tier 1 risk-based capital
Investar Holding Corporation
Investar Bank
229,595
280,687
9.51 169,031
11.64 168,867
NA
7.00
7.00 156,805
NA
6.50
Tier 1 risk-based capital
Investar Holding Corporation
Investar Bank
Total risk-based capital
Investar Holding Corporation
Investar Bank
December 31, 2022
Tier 1 leverage capital
Investar Holding Corporation
Investar Bank
239,095
280,687
9.90 205,251
11.64 205,052
8.50
NA
8.50 192,990
NA
8.00
313,574
310,846
12.99 253,546
12.89 253,300
10.50
NA
10.50 241,238
NA
10.00
$ 231,048
267,603
8.53% $ 108,405
9.89 108,275
NA
4.00%
4.00 135,344
NA
5.00
Common Equity Tier 1 risk-based capital
Investar Holding Corporation
Investar Bank
221,548
267,603
9.79 158,457
11.83 158,355
7.00
NA
7.00 147,044
NA
6.50
Tier 1 risk-based capital
Investar Holding Corporation
Investar Bank
Total risk-based capital
Investar Holding Corporation
Investar Bank
231,048
267,603
10.21 192,412
11.83 192,288
8.50
NA
8.50 180,977
NA
8.00
300,009
292,339
13.25 237,685
12.92 237,532
10.50
NA
10.50 226,221
NA
10.00
*The minimum ratios and amounts under the column for Capital Adequacy for December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022
reflect the minimum regulatory capital ratios imposed under Basel III plus the fully phased-in capital conservation buffer of
2.5%.
Applicable Federal statutes, regulations, and guidance impose restrictions on the amounts of dividends that may be declared by
the Company and the Bank. In addition to the formal statutes, regulations, and guidance, regulatory authorities also consider the
adequacy of the Company’s and the Bank’s total capital in relation to its assets, deposits, risk profile, and other such items and,
as a result, capital adequacy considerations could further limit the availability of dividends from the Company and the Bank. The
Company is also subject to dividend restrictions under the terms of its 2029 Notes, 2032 Notes, and junior subordinated
debentures. See “Common Stock – Dividend Restrictions” in Note 13. Stockholders’ Equity, for more information.
124
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
NOTE 19. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
Unfunded Commitments
The Company is a party to financial instruments with off-balance sheet risk entered into in the normal course of business to meet
the financing needs of its customers. These financial instruments include commitments to extend credit consisting of loan
commitments and standby letters of credit, which are not included in the accompanying financial statements. Such financial
instruments are recorded in the financial statements when they become payable. The credit risk associated with these
commitments is evaluated in a manner similar to the allowance for credit losses on loans. At December 31, 2023 and 2022, the
reserve for unfunded loan commitments was $0.3 million and $0.4 million, respectively, and is included in “Accrued taxes and
other liabilities” in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets.
Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend money with fixed expiration dates or termination clauses. The Company
applies the same credit standards used in the lending process when extending these commitments, and periodically reassesses the
customer’s creditworthiness through ongoing credit reviews. Since some commitments are expected to expire without being
drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements. Collateral is obtained based
on the Company’s assessment of the transaction. Substantially all standby letters of credit issued have expiration dates within
one year.
The table below shows the amounts of the Company’s commitments to extend credit as of the dates presented (dollars in
thousands).
Loan commitments
Standby letters of credit
December 31,
2023
December 31,
2022
$
413,019 $
17,844
333,040
11,379
Additionally, at December 31, 2023, the Company had unfunded commitments of $1.3 million for its investment in Small
Business Investment Company qualified funds.
Insurance
The Company is obligated for certain costs associated with its insurance program for employee health. The Company is self-
insured for a substantial portion of its potential claims. The Company recognizes its obligation associated with these costs, up to
specified deductible limits, in the period in which a claim is incurred, including with respect to both reported claims and claims
incurred but not reported. The claims costs are estimated based on historical claims experience. The reserves for insurance claims
are reviewed and updated by management on a quarterly basis.
Employment Agreements
the Company entered
On August 1, 2020,
its Chief Executive Officer.
The agreement provides that the executive shall receive a minimum annual base salary $510,000, shall be eligible for annual
incentive compensation up to a certain percentage of the base salary, subject to the discretion and approval of the Company’s
board of directors, and shall be entitled to the payment of severance benefits upon termination under specified
circumstances. The employment agreement automatically renews for successive one-year periods unless written notice of non-
renewal is given by either party to the other at least ninety (90) days prior to the expiration of the then-current term.
into an employment agreement with
On August 1, 2020, the Company entered into an employment agreement with its then-current Chief Financial Officer.
The agreement provided that the executive would receive a minimum annual base salary $285,000, be eligible for annual
incentive compensation up to a certain percentage of the base salary, subject to the discretion and approval of the Company’s
board of directors and would be entitled to the payment of severance benefits upon termination under specified circumstances. On
November 4, 2022, the Company’s then-current Chief Financial Officer separated from the Company. The Company entered
into a separation and release agreement with him, which provided that he would receive compensation and benefits due in
connection with a termination due to “Disability” under the employment agreement and released the Company from any and all
claims arising on or before November 4, 2022.
125
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Legal Proceedings
The nature of the business of the Company’s banking and other subsidiaries ordinarily results in a certain amount of claims,
litigation, investigations, and legal and administrative cases and proceedings, which are considered incidental to the normal
conduct of business. Some of these claims are against entities which the Company acquired in business acquisitions. The
Company has asserted defenses to these claims and, with respect to such legal proceedings, intends to continue to defend itself,
litigating or settling cases according to management’s judgment as to what is in the best interest of the Company and its
shareholders.
The Company assesses its liabilities and contingencies in connection with outstanding legal proceedings utilizing the latest
information available. Where it is probable that the Company will incur a loss and the amount of the loss can be reasonably
estimated, the Company records a liability in its consolidated financial statements. These legal reserves may be increased or
decreased to reflect any relevant developments on a quarterly basis. Where a loss is not probable or the amount of loss is not
estimable, the Company does not accrue legal reserves. While the outcome of legal proceedings is inherently uncertain, based
on information currently available and available insurance coverage, the Company’s management believes that it has established
appropriate legal reserves. If an accrual is not made, and there is at least a reasonable possibility that a loss or additional loss may
have been incurred, the Company discloses the nature of the contingency and an estimate of the possible loss or range of loss or
a statement that such an estimate cannot be made. Any incremental liabilities arising from pending legal proceedings are not
expected to have a material adverse effect on the Company’s consolidated financial position, consolidated results of operations,
or consolidated cash flows. However, it is possible that the ultimate resolution of these matters, if unfavorable, may be material
to the Company’s consolidated financial position, consolidated results of operations, or consolidated cash flows.
As of the date of this filing, the Company believes the amount of losses associated with legal proceedings that it is reasonably
possible to incur is not material.
NOTE 20. TRANSACTIONS WITH RELATED PARTIES
The Bank has made and expects in the future to continue to make in the ordinary course of business, loans to directors and
executive officers of the Company and the Bank, their affiliated companies, and other related persons. In management’s opinion,
these loans were made in the ordinary course of business at normal credit terms, including interest rate and collateral
requirements, and do not represent more than normal credit risk. See Note 3. Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses, for more
information regarding lending transactions between the Bank and these related parties.
During 2023 and 2022, certain executive officers and directors of the Company and the Bank, including companies with which
they are affiliated and other related persons, were deposit customers of the Bank. See Note 8. Deposits, regarding total deposits
outstanding to these related parties.
The Company has participated in transactions with related parties for which the Company believes the terms and conditions are
comparable to terms that would have been available from a third party that was unaffiliated with the Company. The following
describes transactions since January 1, 2021, in addition to the ordinary banking relationships described above, in which the
Company has participated in which one or more of its directors, executive officers, their affiliated companies, or other related
persons had or will have a direct or indirect material interest.
The Company has engaged in a number of transactions with Joffrion Commercial Division, LLC (“JCD”), a commercial
construction company owned and managed by Gordon H. Joffrion, one of the Company’s directors. For each transaction, the
Company selected JCD through its public bidding process. The Company did not make any payments to JCD during the years
ended December 31, 2023 or December 31, 2022. The Company paid JCD approximately $0.1 million during the year ended
December 31, 2021.
126
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
NOTE 21. PARENT COMPANY ONLY FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
BALANCE SHEETS
(dollars in thousands)
ASSETS
Cash and due from banks
Equity securities
Due from bank subsidiary
Investment in bank subsidiary
Investment in trust
Trademark intangible
Other assets
Total assets
LIABILITIES
Subordinated debt, net of unamortized issuance costs
Junior subordinated debt
Accounts payable
Accrued interest payable
Dividend payable
Deferred tax liability
Total liabilities
STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
Common stock
Surplus
Retained earnings
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
Total stockholders’ equity
Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
STATEMENTS OF INCOME
(dollars in thousands)
REVENUE
Dividends received from bank subsidiary
Dividends on corporate stock
Change in the fair value of equity securities
Interest income from investment in trust
Other operating income
Total revenue
EXPENSE
Interest on borrowings
Management fees to bank subsidiary
Loss on early extinguishment of subordinated debt
Other expense
Total expense
(Loss) income before income tax expense and equity in undistributed income of
bank subsidiary
Equity in undistributed income of bank subsidiary
Income tax benefit
Net income
127
December 31,
2023
2022
840 $
752
1,141
277,760
295
100
864
281,752 $
44,320 $
8,630
228
571
975
260
54,984
9,748
145,456
116,711
(45,147)
226,768
281,752 $
6,153
823
937
261,737
295
100
518
270,563
44,225
8,515
253
567
941
280
54,781
9,902
146,587
108,206
(48,913)
215,782
270,563
For the years ended
December 31,
2023
2022
3,300 $
—
(71)
22
138
3,389
3,216
360
—
519
4,095
(706)
16,552
832
16,678 $
17,000
19
(35)
11
—
16,995
3,137
360
222
666
4,385
12,610
22,172
927
35,709
$
$
$
$
$
$
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
(dollars in thousands)
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES
For the years ended
December 31,
2023
2022
Net income
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:
Equity in undistributed earnings of bank subsidiary
Change in the fair value of equity securities
Amortization of subordinated debt issuance costs and purchase accounting
$
16,678 $
35,709
(16,552)
71
(22,172)
35
adjustments
Loss on early extinguishment of subordinated debt
Net change in:
Due from bank subsidiary
Other assets
Deferred tax liability
Accrued other liabilities
Net cash provided by operating activities
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES
Purchases of equity securities
Proceeds from the sale of equity securities
Purchases of other investments
Net cash (used in) provided by investing activities
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES
Cash dividends paid on common stock
Payments to repurchase common stock
Proceeds from stock options exercised
Proceeds from subordinated debt, net of issuance costs
Extinguishment of subordinated debt
Net cash used in financing activities
Net (decrease) increase in cash
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period
Cash and cash equivalents, end of period
210
—
(204)
(84)
(20)
1,638
1,737
—
—
(285)
(285)
(3,844)
(3,026)
105
—
—
(6,765)
(5,313)
6,153
840 $
197
222
31
5
(52)
1,746
15,721
(750)
1,225
(225)
250
(3,552)
(10,540)
133
19,548
(18,600)
(13,011)
2,960
3,193
6,153
$
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION:
Cash payments for:
Interest on borrowings
$
3,212 $
3,179
128
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
NOTE 22. EARNINGS PER SHARE
The following is a summary of the information used in the computation of basic and diluted earnings per common share for the
years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021 (in thousands, except share data).
Earnings per common share - basic
Net income
Less: income allocated to participating securities
Net income allocated to common shareholders
Weighted average basic shares outstanding
Basic earnings per common share
Earnings per common share - diluted
Net income allocated to common shareholders
Weighted average basic shares outstanding
Dilutive effect of securities
Total weighted average diluted shares outstanding
Diluted earnings per common share
2023
December 31,
2022
2021
16,678 $
(1)
16,677
9,839,258
1.69 $
35,709 $
(33)
35,676
10,085,758
3.54 $
8,000
(21)
7,979
10,416,145
0.77
16,677 $
9,839,258
2,583
9,841,841
1.69 $
35,676 $
10,085,758
94,951
10,180,709
3.50 $
7,979
10,416,145
84,157
10,500,302
0.76
$
$
$
$
The weighted average number of shares that have an antidilutive effect in the calculation of diluted earnings per common share
and have been excluded from the computations above are shown below.
Stock options
Restricted stock awards
Restricted stock units
2023
December 31,
2022
—
—
71,711
15,361
135
15,176
2021
869
431
20,828
129
Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
None.
Item 9A. Controls and Procedures
Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures
As of the end of the period covered by this Annual Report on Form 10-K, the Company carried out an evaluation under the
supervision and with the participation of its management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer (the
Company’s principal executive and financial officers), of the effectiveness of the design and operation of the Company’s
disclosure controls and procedures as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e). Based upon that evaluation, the
Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were
effective for ensuring that information the Company is required to disclose in reports that it files or submits under the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the
Securities and Exchange Commission’s rules and forms.
Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting
There were no changes to internal control over financial reporting during the fourth quarter of 2023 that have materially affected,
or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.
Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting
Management’s annual report on internal control over financial reporting and the report thereon of Horne LLP are included herein
under Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.
Item 9B. Other Information
Pursuant to Item 408(a) of Regulation S-K, none of our directors or executive officers adopted, terminated, or modified a Rule
10b5-1 trading arrangement or a non-Rule 10b5-1 trading arrangement during the quarter ended December 31, 2023.
Item 9C. Disclosure Regarding Foreign Jurisdictions that Prevent Inspections
Not applicable.
130
Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance
PART III
Except as provided below, the information required by Item 10 is incorporated by reference to the Company’s Definitive Proxy
Statement for its 2024 Annual Meeting of Shareholders (the “2024 Proxy Statement”).
Code of Conduct and Ethics
The Company has adopted a Code of Ethics for the Chief Executive Officer and Senior Financial Officers that applies to its Chief
Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer, Chief Accounting Officer and any other senior financial officers, and the Company
has also adopted a Code of Conduct that applies to all of the Company’s directors, officers and employees. The full text of the
Code of Ethics for the Chief Executive Officer and Senior Financial Officers and the Code of Conduct can be found by clicking
on “Corporate Governance” under the “Investor Relations” tab on the Company’s website, www.investarbank.com, and then by
clicking on “Code of Ethics for the Chief Executive Officer and Senior Financial Officers” or “Code of Conduct,” as
applicable. The Company intends to satisfy the disclosure requirement under Item 5.05(c) of Form 8-K regarding an amendment
to, or waiver from, a provision of the Company’s Code of Ethics for the Chief Executive Officer and Senior Financial Officers
by posting such information on its website, at the address specified above.
Item 11. Executive Compensation
The information required by Item 11 is incorporated by reference to the 2024 Proxy Statement.
Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters
Stock Ownership
Except as provided below, the information required by Item 12 is incorporated by reference to the 2024 Proxy Statement.
Securities Authorized for Issuance under Equity Compensation Plans
The following table presents certain information regarding our equity compensation plans as of December 31, 2023.
Plan category
Equity compensation plans approved by security holders(1)
Equity compensation plans not approved by security
holders(2)
Total
Number of
securities to be
issued upon
exercise of
outstanding
options, warrants
and rights(3)
Number of
securities
remaining
available for
future issuance
under equity
compensation
plans
Weighted-average
exercise price of
outstanding
options, warrants
and rights
484,340 $
19.94
450,058
179,014
663,354 $
15.16
17.32
—
450,058
(1) Represents shares available for issuance under the Company’s Amended and Restated 2017 Long-Term Incentive
Compensation Plan (the “Plan”). The Plan authorizes the grant of various types of equity grants and awards, such as
restricted stock, stock options and stock appreciation rights to eligible participants, which include all of the Company’s
employees, non-employee directors, and consultants.
(2) The Investar Holding Corporation 2014 Long-Term Incentive Compensation Plan (the “2014 Plan”) was adopted by
the Company’s board of directors on January 15, 2014 and was amended on March 13, 2014. Because the Company
was a private corporation at the time of the adoption of the 2014 Plan, shareholder approval of the 2014 Plan was not
required, nor was such approval obtained. A total of 600,000 shares of common stock was reserved for issuance
pursuant to awards under the 2014 Plan. Effective May 24, 2017, no future awards will be granted under the 2014 Plan,
although the terms and conditions of the 2014 Plan will continue to govern any outstanding awards thereunder.
(3)
Includes 336,749 shares issuable pursuant to outstanding restricted stock units, which do not have an exercise price.
131
Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Directors Independence
The information required by Item 13 is incorporated by reference to the 2024 Proxy Statement.
Item 14. Principal Accountant Fees and Services
The information required by Item 14 is incorporated by reference to the 2024 Proxy Statement.
Item 15. Exhibit and Financial Statement Schedules
(a) Documents Filed as Part of this Report.
PART IV
(1) The following financial statements are incorporated by reference from Item 8. Financial Statements and
Supplementary Data hereof:
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firms (PCAOB ID: 171)
Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2023 and 2022
Consolidated Statements of Income for the Years Ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive (Loss) Income for the Years Ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and
2021
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity for the Years Ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and
2021
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
(2) All schedules for which provision is made in the applicable accounting regulations of the SEC are omitted because
of the absence of conditions under which they are required or because the required information is included in the
consolidated financial statements and related notes thereto.
(3) The following exhibits are filed as part of this Form 10-K, and this list includes the Exhibit Index.
Description
Location
Exhibit
Number
2.1
3.1
3.2
Agreement and Plan of Reorganization
dated January 21, 2021 by and among
Investar Holding Corporation, Cheaha Financial
Group, Inc. and High Point Acquisition, Inc.
Restated Articles of Incorporation of Investar
Holding Corporation
Amended and Restated By-laws of Investar Holding
Corporation
4.1
Specimen Common Stock Certificate
Exhibit 2.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of
the Company filed January 25, 2021 and
incorporated herein by reference
Exhibit 3.1 to the Registration Statement on Form
S-1 of the Company filed May 16, 2014 and
incorporated herein by reference
Exhibit 3.2 to the Registration Statement on Form
S-4 of the Company filed October 10, 2017 and
incorporated herein by reference
Exhibit 4.1 to the Registration Statement on Form
S-1 of the Company filed May 16, 2014 and
incorporated herein by reference
4.2
Description of Registrant’s Securities Registered
under Section 12 of the Securities Exchange Act of
1934
Exhibit 4.2 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of
the Company filed March 9, 2022 and incorporated
herein by reference
132
4.3
4.4
4.5
10.1
10.2*
10.3*
10.4*
10.5*
10.6*
10.7*
10.8*
10.9*
10.10*
10.11*
Form of 5.125% Fixed to Floating Rate
Subordinated Note due 2029
Exhibit 4.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed
November 14, 2019 and incorporated herein by
reference
Indenture, dated April 6, 2022, by and among
Investar Holding Corporation and UMB Bank,
National Association, as trustee
Exhibit 4.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed
with the SEC on April 7, 2022 and incorporated
herein by reference.
Form of 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate
Subordinated Note due 2032
Form of the Director Support Agreement, dated
October 10, 2018, among Investar Holding
Corporation, Mainland Bank and all of the directors
of Mainland Bank parties thereto
Exhibit 4.2 to the Current Report on Form 8-K filed
with the SEC on April 7, 2022 and incorporated
herein by reference
Exhibit 10.3 to the Registration Statement on Form
S-4 of the Company filed November 30, 2018 and
incorporated herein by reference
Employment Agreement, dated August 1, 2020 by
and among Investar Holding Corporation, Investar
Bank, National Association, and John J. D’Angelo
Exhibit 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K
filed August 6, 2020 and incorporated herein by
reference
Employment Agreement, dated August 1, 2020 by
and among Investar Holding Corporation, Investar
Bank, National Association, and Christopher L.
Hufft
Exhibit 10.2 to the Current Report on Form 8-K
filed August 6, 2020 and incorporated herein by
reference
Amended and Restated Investar Holding
Corporation 2017 Long-Term Incentive
Compensation Plan
Exhibit 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K
filed May 20, 2021 and incorporated herein by
reference
Salary Continuation Agreement, dated as of
February 28, 2018, by and between Investar Bank
and John D’Angelo
Exhibit 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of
the Company filed March 1, 2018 and incorporated
herein by reference
Supplemental Salary Continuation Agreement,
dated May 22, 2019, by and between Investar Bank
and John D’Angelo
Exhibit 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of
the Company filed May 23, 2019 and incorporated
herein by reference
Salary Continuation Agreement, dated as of
February 28, 2018, by and between Investar Bank
and Christopher Hufft
Exhibit 10.2 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of
the Company filed March 1, 2018 and incorporated
herein by reference
Supplemental Salary Continuation Agreement,
dated May 22, 2019, by and between Investar Bank
and Christopher Hufft
Exhibit 10.2 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of
the Company filed May 23, 2019 and incorporated
herein by reference
Separation Agreement & Release with Christopher
Hufft, dated November 4, 2022
Exhibit 10.10 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K
of the Company filed March 8, 2023 and
incorporated herein by reference
Form of Split Dollar Agreement by and between
Investar Bank and each executive entering into a
Salary Continuation Agreement
Exhibit 10.4 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of
the Company filed March 1, 2018 and incorporated
herein by reference
Form of First Amendment to Split Dollar
Agreement by and between Investar Bank and each
executive entering into a Supplemental Salary
Continuation Agreement
Exhibit 10.3 to the Current Report on Form 8-K
filed May 23, 2019 and incorporated herein by
reference
133
10.12*
Investar Holding Corporation 2014 Long-Term
Incentive Compensation Plan, as amended by
Amendment No. 1 to Investar Holding Corporation
2014 Long Term Incentive Plan
Exhibit 10.1 to the Registration Statement on Form
S-1 of the Company filed May 16, 2014 and, as to
Amendment No.1, Exhibit 99.2 to the Registration
Statement on Form S-8 of the Company filed
October 30, 2014, each of which is incorporated
herein by reference
10.13*
Amendment to the Split Dollar Agreement between
Investar Bank and Christopher Hufft, dated
November 1, 2022
Exhibit 10.13 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K
of the Company filed March 8, 2023 and
incorporated herein by reference
10.14*
Form of Stock Option Grant Agreement
10.15*
Form of Restricted Stock Award Agreement for
Employees
10.16*
Form of Restricted Stock Award Agreement for
Non-Employee Directors
10.17*
Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement for
Employees
10.18*
Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement for Non-
Employee Directors
10.19*
Investar Holding Corporation 401(k) Plan, as
restated effective January 1, 2021
21.1
Subsidiaries of the Registrant
23.1
Consent of Horne LLP
Exhibit 10.2 to the Registration Statement on Form
S-1 of the Company filed May 16, 2014 and
incorporated herein by reference
Exhibit 10.3 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of
the Company filed March 11, 2016 and
incorporated herein by reference
Exhibit 10.4 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of
the Company filed March 11, 2016 and
incorporated herein by reference
Exhibit 10.15 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K
of the Company filed March 15, 2019 and
incorporated herein by reference
Exhibit 10.16 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K
of the Company filed March 15, 2019 and
incorporated herein by reference
Exhibit 10.20 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K
of the Company filed March 10, 2021 and
incorporated herein by reference
Exhibit 21 to the Registration Statement on Form S-
1 of the Company filed May 16, 2014 and
incorporated herein by reference
Filed herewith
Filed herewith
31.1
31.2
32.1
32.2
Rule 13a-14(a) Certification of Principal Executive
Officer of the Company in accordance with Section
302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
Rule 13a-14(a) Certification of Principal Financial
Officer of the Company in accordance with Section
302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
Filed herewith
Section 1350 Certification of Principal Executive
Officer of the Company in accordance with Section
906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
Filed herewith
Section 1350 Certification of Principal Financial
Officer of the Company in accordance with Section
906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
Filed herewith
97.1
Investar Holding Corporation Clawback Policy
Filed herewith
134
101.INS
101.SCH
101.CAL
Inline XBRL Instance Document - the instance
document does not appear in the Interactive Data
File because its XBRL tags are embedded within
the Inline XBRL document
Filed herewith
Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema
Document
Filed herewith
Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation
Linkbase Document
Filed herewith
101.DEF
Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition
Linkbase Document
Filed herewith
101.LAB
Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase
Document
Filed herewith
101.PRE
Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation
Linkbase Document
Filed herewith
104
Cover Page Interactive Data File (embedded within
the Inline XBRL Document and include in Exhibit
101)
Filed herewith
* Management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement.
Item 16. Form 10-K Summary
Not applicable.
135
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this
report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
SIGNATURES
Date:
March 7, 2024
INVESTAR HOLDING CORPORATION
by: /s/ John J. D’Angelo
John J. D’Angelo
President and
Chief Executive Officer
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons
on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the date indicated.
Date:
March 7, 2024
Date:
March 7, 2024
Date:
March 7, 2024
Date:
March 7, 2024
by: /s/ John J. D’Angelo
John J. D’Angelo
President, Chief Executive
Officer and Director
(Principal Executive Officer)
by: /s/ John R. Campbell
John R. Campbell
Executive Vice President and
Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial Officer)
by: /s/ Corey E. Moore
Corey E. Moore
Senior Vice President and
Chief Accounting Officer
(Principal Accounting Officer)
by: /s/ Anita M. Fontenot
Anita M. Fontenot
Director
136
Date:
March 7, 2024
Date:
March 7, 2024
Date:
March 7, 2024
Date:
March 7, 2024
Date:
March 7, 2024
Date:
March 7, 2024
Date:
March 7, 2024
Date:
March 7, 2024
Date:
March 7, 2024
by: /s/ William H. Hidalgo, Sr.
William H. Hidalgo, Sr.
Chairman of the Board
by: /s/ Rose J. Hudson
Rose J. Hudson
Director
by: /s/ Gordon H. Joffrion, III
Gordon H. Joffrion, III
Director
by: /s/ Robert C. Jordan
Robert C. Jordan
Director
by: /s/ Julio A. Melara
Julio A. Melara
Director
by: /s/ Suzanne O. Middleton
Suzanne O. Middleton
Director
by: /s/ Andrew C. Nelson, M.D.
Andrew C. Nelson, M.D.
Director
by: /s/ Frank L. Walker
Frank L. Walker
Director
by: /s/ James E. Yegge, M.D.
James E. Yegge, M.D.
Director
137
This page intentionally left blank
Investar Holding Corporation
10500 Coursey Boulevard
Baton Rouge, Louisiana 70816
(225) 227-2222
www.investarbank.com